Beruflich Dokumente
Kultur Dokumente
CodeCharge Studio 4
Component Reference
8275 S. Eastern Ave. Suite 200 Las Vegas, NV 89123 USA Telephone: + 1 (888) 241-7338 Fax: + 1 (866) 312-8049 info@yessoftware.com http://www.yessoftware.com
Copyright 2000-2008 YesSoftware, Inc. All rights reserved. This manual, as well as the software described in it, is furnished under license and may be used or copied only in accordance with the terms of such license. The content of this manual is furnished for informational use only, is subject to change without notice, and should not be construed as a commitment by YesSoftware, Inc. YesSoftware, Inc assumes no responsibility or liability for any errors or inaccuracies that may appear in this documentation. Except as permitted by such license, no part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of YesSoftware, Inc. Reproduction or translation of any part of this work beyond that permitted by Sections 107 and 108 of the 1976 United States Copyright Act without the permission of the copyright owner is unlawful. Requests for permission or further information should be addressed to YesSoftware Inc., 8275 S. Eastern Ave. Suite 200 Las Vegas, NV 89123 USA. YesSoftware, the YesSoftware logo, CodeCharge and the CodeCharge Logo are either registered trademarks or trademarks of YesSoftware, Inc in the United States and/or other countries. ASP, IIS, Microsoft, Windows and Windows NT are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. JavaScript and JSP are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc. in the United States and other countries. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Component Reference .................................................................................................. 16 Components .............................................................................................................. 16 Referencing Objects............................................................................................... 16 Button Control Reference....................................................................................... 20 Calendar Reference ............................................................................................... 21 Calendar Navigator Reference............................................................................... 25 Checkbox Control Reference ................................................................................. 26 CheckBox List Control Reference .......................................................................... 28 Connection Reference ........................................................................................... 32 Date Picker Component Reference........................................................................ 35 Directory Form Reference...................................................................................... 36 Editable Grid Form Reference ............................................................................... 41 File Upload Component Reference ........................................................................ 49 Grid Form Reference ............................................................................................. 53 Hidden Control Reference...................................................................................... 58 Image Control Reference ....................................................................................... 60 Image Link Reference ............................................................................................ 62 Include Page Reference......................................................................................... 64 Label Reference..................................................................................................... 65 Link Reference ....................................................................................................... 67 List Box .................................................................................................................. 69 Navigator Reference .............................................................................................. 73 Page Reference ..................................................................................................... 74 Panel Reference .................................................................................................... 78 Path Reference ...................................................................................................... 80 Project Reference .................................................................................................. 83 Radio Button Reference......................................................................................... 85 Record Form Reference......................................................................................... 88 Report Reference................................................................................................... 96 Report Label Reference ....................................................................................... 100 Report Section Reference.................................................................................... 103 Sorter Reference.................................................................................................. 104 Text Area Reference ............................................................................................ 105 Text Box Reference ............................................................................................. 108 Properties ................................................................................................................ 111 A - C..................................................................................................................... 111 .NET Debug Mode Property ............................................................................. 111 Access Denied Page Property.......................................................................... 111 Aliases Property ............................................................................................... 111 Allow Insert Property ........................................................................................ 111 Allow Update Property...................................................................................... 112 Allow Delete Property ....................................................................................... 112 Allowed File Masks Property ............................................................................ 112 Assemblies Property......................................................................................... 112 Bound Column Property ................................................................................... 113 Boolean Format Property ................................................................................. 113 Caption Property............................................................................................... 113 Catalog Property............................................................................................... 113 Category ID Field Property ............................................................................... 114 Charset Property .............................................................................................. 114 3
Checked Value Property................................................................................... 114 Class Path Property.......................................................................................... 114 Code Language Property ................................................................................. 115 Code Page Property ......................................................................................... 115 ColdFusion Server Property ............................................................................. 115 Connect Cached Property ................................................................................ 116 Connection Property......................................................................................... 116 Connection String Property............................................................................... 116 Connection Type Property ................................................................................ 117 Content Property .............................................................................................. 117 Context Path Property ...................................................................................... 117 Control Source Property ................................................................................... 118 Control Source Property (Report) ..................................................................... 118 Control Source Type Property .......................................................................... 119 Control Source Property (Report) ..................................................................... 120 Convert URL To Property ................................................................................. 120 Control Property ............................................................................................... 121 Control Properties............................................................................................. 121 Create IIS Application Property ........................................................................ 124 Custom Delete Property ................................................................................... 124 Custom Delete Type Property .......................................................................... 125 Custom Insert Property..................................................................................... 125 Custom Insert Type Property............................................................................ 127 Custom Update Property .................................................................................. 127 Custom Update Type Property ......................................................................... 129 D - I ...................................................................................................................... 130 Data Source Property ....................................................................................... 130 Data Source Type............................................................................................. 130 Data Type Property .......................................................................................... 130 Database URL Property ................................................................................... 131 Date DB Format Property ................................................................................. 131 Date Field Property........................................................................................... 131 Date Format Property ....................................................................................... 132 DBFormat Property........................................................................................... 132 Default Boolean Format Property ..................................................................... 132 Default Button Property .................................................................................... 132 Default Date Format Property........................................................................... 133 Default Value Property ..................................................................................... 133 Default View Mode Property ............................................................................. 133 Delete Control Property .................................................................................... 134 "Deploy webapp as" Property ........................................................................... 134 Design Database Type Property....................................................................... 134 Disallowed File Masks Property........................................................................ 135 Email Component Property............................................................................... 135 EmptyRows Property........................................................................................ 135 Empty Weeks Property..................................................................................... 135 Enable Print Mode Property.............................................................................. 136 Enable Validation Property ............................................................................... 136 Encoding Extension Property ........................................................................... 136 Error Control Property ...................................................................................... 136 File Folder Property .......................................................................................... 136 File Size Limit Property..................................................................................... 137 4
File Upload Component Property ..................................................................... 137 Format Property................................................................................................ 137 Number Format............................................................................................. 137 Using Date Format concept .......................................................................... 138 Date/Time Format ......................................................................................... 139 Date Formats Comparison ............................................................................ 140 Function Property ............................................................................................. 144 Groups Property ............................................................................................... 144 Height Property................................................................................................. 144 Hide Duplicates Property .................................................................................. 145 Home Page Property ........................................................................................ 145 Href Source Property........................................................................................ 145 Href Type Property ........................................................................................... 145 Includable Property........................................................................................... 146 #include type Property...................................................................................... 146 ID Field Property............................................................................................... 146 Improved HTTP Caching Property.................................................................... 146 Input Validation Property .................................................................................. 147 J - P...................................................................................................................... 147 JDBC Driver Property ....................................................................................... 147 Level of Logging Property................................................................................. 147 Library Prefix Property...................................................................................... 147 Lines Per Print Page Property .......................................................................... 148 Lines Per Web Page Property .......................................................................... 148 Locale Identifier Property.................................................................................. 148 Login Property .................................................................................................. 148 LongReadLen Property .................................................................................... 149 LongTruncOk Property ..................................................................................... 149 Manager login Property .................................................................................... 149 Manager password Property............................................................................. 149 Manager URL Property..................................................................................... 150 Max number of connections to DB Property ..................................................... 150 Name................................................................................................................ 150 Name Property ................................................................................................. 150 No of Columns Property ................................................................................... 151 No of Years Property ........................................................................................ 151 Number of Columns Property ........................................................................... 151 Number of Subcategories Property .................................................................. 151 Operation Property ........................................................................................... 152 Output File Format Property ............................................................................. 152 Page Property................................................................................................... 152 Page Links Property ......................................................................................... 153 Page Size Limit Property .................................................................................. 153 Parent field Property......................................................................................... 153 Password Property ........................................................................................... 153 Path to logfile Property ..................................................................................... 154 Percent Of Property.......................................................................................... 154 Perl Path Property ............................................................................................ 154 PHP Database Library Property ....................................................................... 154 PHP File Extension Property ............................................................................ 155 PHP Database Library Property ....................................................................... 155 PrintError Property............................................................................................ 155 5
Preserve Parameters Property ......................................................................... 155 Publishing Property .......................................................................................... 156 R - S..................................................................................................................... 156 RaiseError Property.......................................................................................... 156 Records Per Page Property.............................................................................. 156 References Property......................................................................................... 157 RegExp API Property ....................................................................................... 157 Remove Parameters Property .......................................................................... 157 Required Property ............................................................................................ 158 Reset At Property ............................................................................................. 158 Restricted Property........................................................................................... 158 Return Page Property....................................................................................... 158 Reverse Order Property ................................................................................... 159 Runtime libraries Property ................................................................................ 159 Secured Server URL Property .......................................................................... 159 Security Type Property ..................................................................................... 159 Server API Property.......................................................................................... 160 Server Connection String Property ................................................................... 160 Server Connection Type Property .................................................................... 160 Server DataBase/Connection Type Property.................................................... 160 Server Database Name Property...................................................................... 161 Server Database Type Property ....................................................................... 161 Server Host Property ........................................................................................ 161 Server Login Property....................................................................................... 161 Server Password Property................................................................................ 162 Server Path Property (Java) ............................................................................. 162 Server Path Property (Perl) .............................................................................. 162 Server Persistent Connection Property ............................................................ 162 Server Port Property......................................................................................... 162 Server Same As Design Property..................................................................... 163 Sessions Files Clean Rate Property ................................................................. 163 Session Files Path Property ............................................................................. 163 Session Timeout Property ................................................................................ 163 Schema Property.............................................................................................. 163 Show nearby days Property.............................................................................. 164 Site Language Property.................................................................................... 164 Sort Order Property .......................................................................................... 164 SSL Access Only Property ............................................................................... 165 Style Property ................................................................................................... 165 Subcategory ID Field Property.......................................................................... 165 Synonyms Property .......................................................................................... 165 System Tables Property ................................................................................... 165 System Views Property .................................................................................... 166 T - Z ..................................................................................................................... 166 Target Schema Property .................................................................................. 166 Target Server Property ..................................................................................... 166 Target Version Property ................................................................................... 166 Temporary Folder Property............................................................................... 166 Text Column Property....................................................................................... 167 Text Is Empty Property ..................................................................................... 167 Time DB Format Property................................................................................. 167 Time Field Property .......................................................................................... 167 6
Timeout of DB Connection Retrieval Property .................................................. 168 Type Property ................................................................................................... 168 Type Property ................................................................................................... 168 Unchecked Value Property ............................................................................... 169 Unique Property................................................................................................ 169 Use Data Source Extension Property ............................................................... 169 Use LIMIT/TOP Property .................................................................................. 169 Validation Rule Property................................................................................... 170 Validation Text Property ................................................................................... 171 Validate Request Property................................................................................ 171 Views Property ................................................................................................. 171 Visible Property ................................................................................................ 172 Events...................................................................................................................... 172 Client Side Events................................................................................................ 172 On Change event ............................................................................................. 172 On Click event .................................................................................................. 173 On Key Press ................................................................................................... 173 On Load event .................................................................................................. 174 On Unload event............................................................................................... 175 On Submit event............................................................................................... 175 Server Side Events .............................................................................................. 176 After Execute Delete Event .............................................................................. 176 After Execute Insert Event................................................................................ 176 After Execute Select Event ............................................................................... 176 After Execute Update Event ............................................................................. 176 After Delete Event ............................................................................................ 177 After Delete File Event...................................................................................... 177 After Initialize Event.......................................................................................... 177 After Insert Event.............................................................................................. 178 After Process File Event ................................................................................... 178 After Submit Event............................................................................................ 178 After Update Event ........................................................................................... 179 Before Build Delete Event ................................................................................ 179 Before Build Insert Event.................................................................................. 179 Before Build Select Event................................................................................. 179 Before Build Update Event ............................................................................... 180 Before Delete Event ......................................................................................... 180 Before Delete File Event................................................................................... 180 Before Execute Delete Event ........................................................................... 180 Before Execute Insert Event ............................................................................. 181 Before Execute Select Event ............................................................................ 181 Before Execute Update Event .......................................................................... 181 Before Insert Event........................................................................................... 181 Before Output Event ......................................................................................... 182 Before Process File Event ................................................................................ 182 Before Select Event.......................................................................................... 182 Before Show Event........................................................................................... 182 Before Show Category Event ........................................................................... 183 Before Show Row Event................................................................................... 183 Before Show Subcategory Event...................................................................... 183 Before Submit Event......................................................................................... 184 Before Unload Event ........................................................................................ 184 7
Before Update Event ........................................................................................ 184 On Cache Event ............................................................................................... 184 On Calculate Event........................................................................................... 185 On Click Event.................................................................................................. 185 On Initialized Event........................................................................................... 185 On Initialize View Event.................................................................................... 185 On Validate Event............................................................................................. 186 Actions..................................................................................................................... 186 Client Side Actions ............................................................................................... 186 Attach FCKeditor .............................................................................................. 186 Convert Page to PDF ....................................................................................... 187 Custom Code.................................................................................................... 188 Confirmation Message...................................................................................... 188 Regular Expression Validation.......................................................................... 188 Set Focus ......................................................................................................... 188 Submit Form ..................................................................................................... 188 Validate Entry ................................................................................................... 189 Validate Form ................................................................................................... 189 Validate Maximum Length ................................................................................ 189 Validate Maximum Value.................................................................................. 190 Validate Minimum Length ................................................................................. 190 Validate Minimum Value................................................................................... 190 Validate Required Value................................................................................... 190 Server Side Actions.............................................................................................. 191 Change Number Of Columns ........................................................................... 191 Convert Page to PDF ....................................................................................... 191 Custom Code.................................................................................................... 192 Declare Variable ............................................................................................... 192 DLookup ........................................................................................................... 192 Gallery Layout .................................................................................................. 193 Get Original Filename....................................................................................... 193 Hide-Show Component .................................................................................... 193 Login................................................................................................................. 193 Logout .............................................................................................................. 194 Print Text .......................................................................................................... 195 Regular Expression Validation.......................................................................... 195 Retrieve Active Page ........................................................................................ 195 Retrieve Number Of Pages .............................................................................. 195 Retrieve Number Of Records ........................................................................... 195 Retrieve Value for Control ................................................................................ 195 Retrieve Value For Variable.............................................................................. 196 Save Control Value........................................................................................... 196 Save Variable Value ......................................................................................... 196 Send Email ....................................................................................................... 197 Set Active Page ................................................................................................ 197 Set Image Download Folder ............................................................................. 197 Set Link Destination Folder............................................................................... 197 Set Number Of New Records ........................................................................... 198 Set Page Size................................................................................................... 198 Set Row Style ................................................................................................... 198 Set Tag............................................................................................................. 199 Validate Email................................................................................................... 199 8
Validate Maximum Length ................................................................................ 199 Validate Maximum Value.................................................................................. 200 Validate Minimum Length ................................................................................. 200 Validate Minimum Value................................................................................... 200 Validate Phone ................................................................................................. 200 Validate Required Value................................................................................... 201 Validate ZIP ...................................................................................................... 201 Programming Reference.......................................................................................... 201 ASP...................................................................................................................... 201 Functions.......................................................................................................... 201 CCAddParam Function (ASP)....................................................................... 201 CCDLookUp Function (ASP)......................................................................... 201 CCFormatDate Function (ASP)..................................................................... 203 CCGetFromGet Function (ASP).................................................................... 204 CCGetFromPost Function (ASP) .................................................................. 204 CCGetGroupID Function (ASP) .................................................................... 205 CCGetParam Function (ASP) ....................................................................... 205 CCGetUserID Function (ASP)....................................................................... 206 CCGetValue Function (ASP)......................................................................... 207 CCOpenRS Function (ASP).......................................................................... 207 CCParseDate Function (ASP)....................................................................... 208 CCProcessError Function (ASP)................................................................... 208 CCRemoveParam Function (ASP)................................................................ 208 IIf Function (ASP).......................................................................................... 209 Methods............................................................................................................ 209 AddComponents Run-Time Method (ASP) ................................................... 209 Close Method (ASP) ..................................................................................... 210 Execute Method (ASP) ................................................................................. 210 GetEvents Method (ASP).............................................................................. 211 GetOriginFileName Method (ASP)................................................................ 212 Open Method (ASP)...................................................................................... 212 SetEvent Method (ASP)................................................................................ 213 SetVar Methods (ASP).................................................................................. 213 ToSQL Method (ASP) ................................................................................... 213 Run-Time Properties ........................................................................................ 214 AllowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (ASP)................................................ 214 CalendarStyles Run-Time Property (ASP).................................................... 215 Components Run-Time Property (ASP)........................................................ 215 Connection Run-Time Property (ASP) .......................................................... 216 ConnectionString Run-Time Property (ASP)................................................. 216 CurrentDate Run-Time Property (ASP)......................................................... 217 CurrentProcessingDate Run-Time Property (ASP) ....................................... 217 CurrentStyle Run-Time Property (ASP) ........................................................ 218 DataSource Run-Time Property (ASP) ......................................................... 218 DataSource.CountSQL Run-Time Property (ASP)........................................ 219 DataSource.Order Run-Time Property (ASP) ............................................... 219 DataSource.SQL Run-Time Property (ASP) ................................................. 220 DataSource.Where Run-Time Property (ASP).............................................. 221 DeleteAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP) ..................................................... 221 DisallowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (ASP)........................................... 222 EditMode Run-Time Property (ASP) ............................................................. 223 EmptyRows Run-Time Property (ASP) ......................................................... 223 9
EmptyText Run-Time Property (ASP) ........................................................... 224 ErrorMessages Run-Time Property (ASP).................................................... 224 Errors Run-Time Property (ASP) .................................................................. 225 Events Run-Time Property (ASP) ................................................................. 226 FileFolder Run-Time Property (ASP) ............................................................ 227 FileName Run-Time Property (ASP)............................................................. 227 FileSize Run-Time Property (ASP) ............................................................... 228 FileSizeLimit Run-Time Property (ASP)........................................................ 228 Format Run-Time Property (ASP)................................................................. 229 FormSubmitted Run-Time Property (ASP).................................................... 229 Height Run-Time Property (ASP).................................................................. 230 InsertAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP)....................................................... 230 IsFormSubmitted Run-Time Property (ASP) ................................................. 230 IsPercent Run-Time Property (ASP) ............................................................. 231 IsUploaded Run-Time Property (ASP) .......................................................... 232 Link Run-Time Property (ASP)...................................................................... 232 NextProcessingDate Run-Time Property (ASP)............................................ 233 NumberOfColumns Run-Time Property (ASP).............................................. 234 NumberOfSubCategories Run-Time Property (ASP) .................................... 234 Password Run-Time Property (ASP) ............................................................ 235 PageNumber Run-Time Property (ASP) ....................................................... 235 PageSize Run-Time Property (ASP)............................................................. 236 PressedButton Run-Time Property (ASP)..................................................... 236 PrevProcessingDate Run-Time Property (ASP)............................................ 236 ReadAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP) ....................................................... 237 Recordset Run-Time Property (ASP)............................................................ 237 Recordset.RecordCount Run-Time Property (ASP)...................................... 238 RowNumber Run-Time Property (ASP) ........................................................ 239 State Run-Time Property (ASP).................................................................... 239 TemporaryFolder Run-Time Property (ASP)................................................. 239 TotalFunction Run-Time Property (ASP) ...................................................... 240 UpdateAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP) .................................................... 241 User Run-Time Property (ASP)..................................................................... 242 Value Run-Time Property (ASP) ................................................................... 242 ViewMode Run-Time Property (ASP) ........................................................... 243 Visible Run-Time Property (ASP).................................................................. 243 Variables .......................................................................................................... 244 DB<connectionname> Variable (ASP).......................................................... 244 FileName Variable (ASP) .............................................................................. 245 HTMLTemplate Variable (ASP)..................................................................... 246 PathToCurrentPage Variable (ASP) ............................................................. 246 PathToRoot Variable (ASP) .......................................................................... 247 Redirect Variable (ASP)................................................................................ 247 ScriptPath Variable (ASP)............................................................................. 248 TemplateFileName Variable (ASP) ............................................................... 248 Tpl Variable (ASP) ........................................................................................ 249 PHP...................................................................................................................... 249 Functions.......................................................................................................... 249 CCAddParam Function (PHP) ...................................................................... 249 CCDLookUp Function (PHP) ........................................................................ 249 CCFormatDate Function (PHP) .................................................................... 250 CCGetCookie Function (PHP) ...................................................................... 251 10
CCGetFromGet Function (PHP) ................................................................... 252 CCGetFromPost Function (PHP) .................................................................. 252 CCGetGroupID Function (PHP) .................................................................... 252 CCGetParam Function (PHP) ....................................................................... 253 CCGetQueryString Function (PHP) .............................................................. 253 CCGetSession Function (PHP)..................................................................... 254 CCGetUserID Function (PHP) ...................................................................... 254 CCGetUserLogin Function (PHP) ................................................................. 254 CCLoginUser Function (PHP) ....................................................................... 255 CCLogoutUser Function (PHP)..................................................................... 255 CCParseDate Function (PHP) ...................................................................... 255 CCRemoveParam Function (PHP) ............................................................... 256 CCSetCookie Function (PHP)....................................................................... 256 CCSetSession Function (PHP) ..................................................................... 257 Methods............................................................................................................ 257 connect Method (PHP).................................................................................. 257 f Method (PHP) ............................................................................................. 258 GetFileName Method (PHP) ......................................................................... 258 GetFileSize Method (PHP)............................................................................ 258 GetLink Method (PHP).................................................................................. 258 GetValue Method (PHP) ............................................................................... 259 next_record Method (PHP) ........................................................................... 259 num_rows Method (PHP).............................................................................. 259 query Method (PHP) ..................................................................................... 260 SetLink Method (PHP) .................................................................................. 260 SetValue Method (PHP)................................................................................ 261 ToSQL Method (PHP)................................................................................... 261 Run-Time Properties ........................................................................................ 262 AllowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (PHP) ............................................... 262 CalendarStyles Run-Time Property (PHP).................................................... 262 ComponentName Run-Time Property (PHP) ................................................ 262 Components Run-Time Property (PHP)........................................................ 263 ComponentType Run-Time Property (PHP).................................................. 263 CurrentDate Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................................ 263 CurrentProcessingDate Run-Time Property (PHP)....................................... 264 CurrentStyle Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................................ 264 DeleteAllowed Run-Time Property (PHP) ..................................................... 265 DisallowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (PHP)........................................... 266 ds Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................................................ 266 DataSource->CountSQL Run-Time Property (PHP) ..................................... 267 DataSource->Order Run-Time Property (PHP)............................................. 268 DataSource->RecordsCount Run-Time Property (PHP) ............................... 268 DataSource->SQL Run-Time Property (PHP)............................................... 269 DataSource->Where Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................... 270 EditMode Run-Time Property (PHP)............................................................. 270 EmptyRows Run-Time Property (PHP)......................................................... 271 EmptyText Run-Time Property (PHP)........................................................... 271 Events Run-Time Property (PHP) ................................................................. 272 Errors Run-Time Property (PHP) .................................................................. 272 FileFolder Run-Time Property (PHP) ............................................................ 273 FileSizeLimit Run-Time Property (PHP)........................................................ 273 FirstWeekDay Run-Time Property (PHP) ..................................................... 274 11
Format Run-Time Property (PHP)................................................................. 274 FormSubmitted Run-Time Property (PHP).................................................... 275 Height Run-Time Property (PHP).................................................................. 275 InsertAllowed Run-Time Property (PHP) ...................................................... 275 IsPercent Run-Time Property (PHP)............................................................. 276 NextProcessingDate Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................... 277 NumberOfColumns Run-Time Property (PHP) ............................................. 277 NumberOfSubcategories Run-Time Property (PHP)..................................... 277 Parent Run-Time Property (PHP) ................................................................. 278 PressedButton Run-Time Property (PHP) .................................................... 278 PrevProcessingDate Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................... 279 ReadAllowed Run-Time Property (PHP) ....................................................... 279 TemporaryFolder Run-Time Property (PHP)................................................. 279 TotalFunction Run-Time Property (PHP) ...................................................... 280 Update Allowed Run-Time Property (PHP) ................................................... 280 ViewMode Run-Time Property (PHP) ........................................................... 281 Visible Run-Time Property (PHP) ................................................................. 282 Variables .......................................................................................................... 282 DB<connectionname> Variable (PHP).......................................................... 282 FileName Variable (PHP).............................................................................. 283 PathToRoot Variable (PHP) .......................................................................... 283 Redirect Variable (PHP)................................................................................ 284 RelativePath Constant (PHP)........................................................................ 284 TemplateFileName Variable (PHP)............................................................... 285 Tpl Variable (PHP) ........................................................................................ 285 Perl....................................................................................................................... 286 Fuctions............................................................................................................ 286 CCAddParam Function (Perl) ....................................................................... 286 CCDLookUp Function (Perl) ......................................................................... 286 CCFormatDate Function (Perl) ..................................................................... 287 CCGetCookie Function (Perl) ....................................................................... 288 CCGetFromGet Function (Perl) .................................................................... 288 CCGetFromPost Function (Perl) ................................................................... 289 CCGetGroupID Function (Perl) ..................................................................... 289 CCGetParam Function (Perl) ........................................................................ 289 CCGetQueryString Function (Perl) ............................................................... 290 CCGetSession Function (Perl)...................................................................... 290 CCGetUserID Function (Perl) ....................................................................... 291 CCGetUserLogin Function (Perl) .................................................................. 291 CCParseDate Function (Perl) ....................................................................... 291 CCRemoveParam Function (Perl) ................................................................ 292 CCSetCookie Function (Perl)........................................................................ 292 CCSetSession Function (Perl) ...................................................................... 293 ColdFusion........................................................................................................... 293 Variables .......................................................................................................... 293 <control>Item Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)............................................ 293 <control>Items Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .......................................... 293 <control name>Rows Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)................................ 294 arr_<control name> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .................................. 294 blnDeleteAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)........................... 294 blnEditMode<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .................................. 295 blnFormSubmitted<control name> Run-Time Property (ColdFusion) ........... 295 12
blnInsertAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ............................ 296 blnReadAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ............................ 296 blnUpdateAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion).......................... 296 CalendarEvents Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ........................................ 297 CalendarStyles Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ......................................... 297 CurrentDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .............................................. 298 CurrentProcessingDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ............................ 298 CurrentStyle Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion).............................................. 298 DB_<connection name>_DS Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .................... 299 DB_<connection name>_USER_PASSWORD; Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) DB_<connection name>_DB_TYPE; Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ........ 300 DB_<connection name>_USER_NAME Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ... 300 fld<control name> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ..................................... 300 fld<control>Link Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ........................................ 301 hide<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ............................................ 301 intEmptyRows Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)........................................... 302 intPage Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ..................................................... 302 intPageSize Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)............................................... 302 intShownRecords Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)...................................... 303 NextProcessingDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ................................. 303 NumberOfColumns Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ................................... 303 NumberOfSubCategories Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion).......................... 304 par<control name>.FileFolder Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)................... 304 par<control>.TemporaryFolder Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ................. 304 PathToCurrentPage Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion).................................. 305 PathToRoot Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)............................................... 305 PrevProcessingDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ................................. 306 query<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion).......................................... 306 FileName Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .................................................. 306 strErr<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion).............................................. 307 strOperation Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .............................................. 307 strOrder Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .................................................... 308 strOrder<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)...................................... 308 strPressedButton Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ...................................... 308 strRedirect Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ................................................ 309 strSQL Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ...................................................... 309 strSQL<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)........................................ 310 strSQL Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ...................................................... 310 strTemplateFileName Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ............................... 310 strWhere Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) ................................................... 311 strWhere<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) .................................... 311 ViewMode Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)................................................. 311 Java ..................................................................................................................... 312 Methods............................................................................................................ 312 A - G ............................................................................................................. 312 H - Z.............................................................................................................. 341 .NET..................................................................................................................... 360 Common Classes ............................................................................................. 360 BooleanParameter Class (.NET)................................................................... 360 DateParameter Class (.NET) ........................................................................ 361 FieldBase Class (.NET)................................................................................. 362 FloatParameter Class (.NET)........................................................................ 363 13
299
IntegerParameter Class (.NET)..................................................................... 363 public class ItemCollection:NameObjectCollectionBase, ICloneable (.NET) 364 public class LinkParameterCollection:NameObjectCollectionBase (.NET) ... 365 MemoParameter Class (.NET)...................................................................... 365 TextParameter Class (.NET)......................................................................... 366 Methods............................................................................................................ 367 CreateFromHttpRequest Method (.NET) ...................................................... 367 DataBind Method (.NET)............................................................................... 367 DeleteFile Method (.NET) ............................................................................. 368 DeleteItem Method (.NET) ............................................................................ 368 InsertItem Method (.NET).............................................................................. 368 FillItem Method (.NET).................................................................................. 369 GetResultSet Method (.NET) ........................................................................ 369 GetResultSet Method (.NET) ........................................................................ 369 Update Method (.NET).................................................................................. 369 UpdateItem Method (.NET) ........................................................................... 370 SaveFile Method (.NET)................................................................................ 370 Validate Method (.NET) ................................................................................ 370 ValidateFile Method (.NET)........................................................................... 371 Run-Time Properties ........................................................................................ 371 AllowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (.NET)............................................... 371 BoolFormat Run-Time Property (.NET)......................................................... 371 ConnectionCommands Run-Time Property (.NET)....................................... 372 Connection Run-Time Property (.NET) ......................................................... 372 ContentType Run-Time Property (.NET)....................................................... 373 CurrentDate Run-Time Property (.NET)........................................................ 374 CurrentDate Run-Time Property (.NET)........................................................ 374 DataSource Run-Time Property (.NET) ........................................................ 375 DataType Run-Time Property (.NET)............................................................ 375 DateFormat Run-Time Property (.NET) ........................................................ 375 Date Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................................... 376 Date Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................................... 376 DateLeftDelim Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................... 377 DateRightDelim Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................. 377 Day Run-Time Property (.NET)..................................................................... 378 Day Run-Time Property (.NET)..................................................................... 378 DisallowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (.NET).......................................... 379 EmptyText Run-Time Property (.NET) .......................................................... 379 errors Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................................. 380 Field Run-Time Property (.NET) ................................................................... 380 FileFolder Run-Time Property (.NET) ........................................................... 380 FileSizeLimit Run-Time Property (.NET)....................................................... 381 Format Run-Time Property (.NET)................................................................ 382 Function Run-Time Property (.NET) ............................................................. 382 Groups Run-Time Property (.NET) ............................................................... 383 Height Run-Time Property (.NET)................................................................. 383 IsDeleted Run-Time Property (.NET) ............................................................ 384 IsEmptyItem Run-Time Property (.NET) ....................................................... 384 IsNew Run-Time Property (.NET) ................................................................. 385 IsUpdated Run-Time Property (.NET)........................................................... 385 MaxPage Run-Time Property (.NET) ............................................................ 386 Mode Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................................. 386 14
Month Run-Time Property (.NET) ................................................................. 387 MonthsInRow Run-Time Property (.NET) ..................................................... 387 Name Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................................. 388 NumberOfColumns Run-Time Property (.NET)............................................. 388 NumberOfSubCategories Run-Time Property (.NET) ................................... 388 Order Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................................. 389 PageNumber Run-Time Property (.NET) ...................................................... 390 PagerSize Run-Time Property (.NET)........................................................... 390 PageSize Run-Time Property (.NET)............................................................ 391 PageSizeLimit Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................... 391 PageNumber Run-Time Property (.NET) ...................................................... 392 PercentOf Run-Time Property (.NET) ........................................................... 392 PreviewPageNumber Run-Time Property (.NET) ......................................... 393 Quarter Run-Time Property (.NET) ............................................................... 393 RecordPerPage Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................. 393 Required Run-Time Property (.NET)............................................................. 394 ResetAt Run-Time Property (.NET) .............................................................. 394 RowNumber Run-Time Property (.NET) ....................................................... 395 ShowOtherMonthsDays Run-Time Property (.NET) ..................................... 395 Source Run-Time Property (.NET)................................................................ 396 SourceType Run-Time Property (.NET)........................................................ 397 State Run-Time Property (.NET)................................................................... 397 Style Run-Time Property (.NET) ................................................................... 398 TemporaryFolder Run-Time Property (.NET)................................................ 398 Text Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................................... 399 Text Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................................... 399 TotalPages Run-Time Property (.NET) ......................................................... 400 Type Run-Time Property (.NET) ................................................................... 400 ViewMode Run-Time Property (.NET) .......................................................... 401 Visible Run-Time Property (.NET)................................................................. 401 WebPageSize Run-Time Property (.NET) .................................................... 402 Year Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................................... 402 Year Run-Time Property (.NET).................................................................... 403 YearsRange Run-Time Property (.NET) ....................................................... 403
15
Component Reference
Components
Referencing Objects
The objects in the Web applications generated by CodeCharge Studio can be referenced in a variety of ways. In many cases, to work with a specific object within a program you will need to know its position within the program hierarchy. For example, an object that is placed directly on the page may need to be addressed differently compared to an object placed within a form (which is also an object). ASP
Syntax
<form>.Visible = False EventCaller.Visible = False <form>.<control>.Value = "123" EventCaller.<control>.Value = "123" EventCaller.Value = "123" <control>.Value = "ABC" EventCaller.Value = "ABC" <page>.<control>.Visible = False EventCaller.<control>.Visible = False EventCaller.Visible = False <page>.<form>.Visible = False EventCaller.<form>.Visible = False EventCaller.Visible = False <page>.<form>.<control>.Visible = False EventCaller.<form>.<control>.Visible = False EventCaller.<control>.Visible = False EventCaller.Visible = False
Note: Using EventCaller is recommended when planning to reuse the event code since it doesn't require referring to objects by name. PHP 16
When using PHP you can address objects in a generic way as $Component to refer to the component raising the event, and $Container to refer to the host form of $Component. This method of referring to objects is recommended to make the event code reusable since it doesn't require referring to objects by name. You can also refer to objects using global variables, for example use $MyGrid to refer to 'MyGrid' grid.
Syntax
$Component->form->visible = false; $Component->Visible = false; $Component->form->control->SetValue($Component->form->PageNumber); $Component->control->SetValue($Component->PageNumber); $Component->SetValue($Container->PageNumber); $Component->control->SetValue("ABC"); $Component->SetValue("ABC"); $Component->page->control->Visible = false;
Includable $Component->control->Visible = false; Page Events Control Events $Component->Visible = false; $Component->page->form->Visible = false;
Includable $Component->form->Visible = false; Page Events Form Events $Component->Visible = false; $Component->page->form->control->Visible = false;
Syntax
$form->Visible = false; $form->control->SetValue("123"); $control->SetValue("ABC"); $page->control->Visible = false; $page->form->Visible = false; $page->form->control->Visible = false;
Syntax
$<form>->{Visible} = 0; $<form>->{<control>}->SetValue("123"); $<control>->SetValue("ABC"); $<page>->{<control>}->{Visible} = 0; $<page>->{<form>}->{Visible} = 0;
Control object placed in a form within an included $<page>->{<form>}->{<control>}->{Visible} = 0; page Assigning an object to a variable Java $<variable> = $<object>;
Syntax
Form object placed on a page Page e.getPage().getComponent("<form>").setVisible(false); Events Form e.getComponent().setVisible(false); Events
Control object placed within a Page e.getPage().getComponent("<form>").getControl("<control>").setVa form Events Form e.getComponent().getControl("<control>").setValue("123"); Events Control e.getControl().setValue("123"); Events Control object placed on a page Page e.getPage().getControl("<control>").setValue("ABC"); Events 18
Note: The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the same included page is the same as specified above. The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the including page is not supported. The syntax for accessing objects in the including page from events within the included page is also not supported. C#
Syntax
<form>Repeater.Visible = false; <form>Holder.Visible = false; <form>.Visible = false; <form><control>.Visible = false; <form><control>.Visible = false; Object reference should be retrieved from the FormControls collection. See the ItemDataBound Event MSDN example. <control>.Visible = false; <variable> = <object>;
Note: The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the same included page is the same as specified above. The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the including page is not supported. The syntax for accessing objects in the including page from events within the included page is also not supported. VB.Net
Syntax
<form>Repeater.Visible = False <form>Holder.Visible = False <form>.Visible = False <form><control>.Visible = False <form><control>.Visible = False Object reference should be retrieved from the FormControls collection. See the ItemDataBound Event MSDN example. <control>.Visible = False
<variable> = <object>
Note: The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the same included page is the same as specified above. The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the including page is not supported. The syntax for accessing objects in the including page from events within the included page is also not supported. ColdFusion
Syntax
<CFSET fld<control> = "abc">
Note: The syntax for accessing objects in an included page from events within the same included page is the same as specified above.
Description
The name of the control. The type of operation performed when the button is clicked [Insert, Update, Delete, Cancel or Search]. If the form does not have a Data Source, this property can be set to 'Insert' in which case the button will simply submit the form. Use this property to specify the page that should be viewed after the button has been clicked.
Return Page
Remove Parameters Specify a semicolon-separated list of parameters that should be removed from the query string Convert URL to Default Button Enable Validation Specify whether the URL should be converted to an absolute URL or a secure (https://) URL. If this property is set to 'Yes', pressing the enter key while on the page will be equivalent to clicking on this button. [Yes/No] Specify whether validation should be enabled when the button is clicked.
Events
Event
Server Side Events On Click Occurs after the button has been clicked and the form is submitted. If the button appears in a record or editable grid form, record operations such as insert, update and delete occur after this event has been processed. In cases where the form does not have a Data Source, this event is used to perform post-submission operations such as sending emails messages based on the submitted information. Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to influence the visibility or appearance of the control.
Description
20
On Click
Occurs immediately after the button has been clicked and before the form is submitted. This client event can be used to validate the contents of the form on the client side before the values are submitted to the server. Occurs after the control has been rendered to the page and before the user can perform any operations. This event can be used to bind validation rules to the control.
On Load
Description
This property controls the visibility of the control. If the property is set to false, the control will not be displayed.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property controls the visibility of the button. If the property is set to false, the button will not be displayed.
Description
This property controls the visibility of the button. If the property is set to false, the button will not be displayed.
Description
Whether this control should be shown. Specify whether this control or component should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
See also:
Button Overview
Calendar Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Connection
Description
The name of the form. The database connection to be used for information retrieval. 21
Data Source Type Data Source Restricted Type Date Field Date DB Format Time Field Time DB Format Show nearby days No of Columns Empty Weeks
The type of data source or the method used to retrieve the data. The database column, SQL Query or other expression the data is to be retrieved from. Allow access only to authenticated and authorized users. Type of the calendar, such as Annual, Quarterly, 3-Months, Monthly Database field containing the date of the calendar event. The database field format used with the date field. Database field containing the time of the calendar event, if time is stored in a different field than the date. The database field format used with the time field. Whether to show days of the surrounding months if the 1st or last week of the month includes days of other months. The number of calendar columns. Specifies if an empty 6th week row should be added to monthly snapshots for months that span only 5 weeks.
Description
Specify the current day. Retrieves the previous processing date. Retrieves the next processing date. Contains the calendar events. Contains the calendar styles. Specifies the style for the current processing block. Specifies whether the calendar should be shown.
Description
Specify the type of component. Have value "Calendar" for Calendar component. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. Specify the name of report. Specify first weekday for calendar. Specify the currently shown date. Previvous processing date. 22
Next processing date. Contains the calendar styles. Specifies the style for the current processing block. Contains the calendar events. Specifies whether the calendar should be shown.
Methods (ASP)
Method
SetEvent
Description
Adds new event.
Description
Specifies whether this control is to be shown. Specifies whether this control or component should be shown. Retrieves the parent component that contains this control or component. Returns the style (not style name) that will be applied to the current Calendar section. Specifies the style (not style name) that will be applied to the current Calendar section. The method is used identically in the events. Returns field name that points to the event's date. This field is required if datasource is defined and allows to link calendar days with events. Specifies the field name pointing to the Event Date. This field is required if the Data Source is defined and allows to link events to the Calendar days. Indicates if the next calendar item is available. This method can be used in the View mode only. Returns the next calendar item if it is available. This method can be used in the View mode only. Returns the current calendar item if it is available. Retrieves the number of the displayed months Specifies the number of the displayed months Returns the number of months in the calendar row for the yearly and quarterly calendars. If monthsInRows == 0 all months will be shown in one row. Specifies the number of months in the calendar row for the yearly and quarterly calendars. If monthsInRows == 0 all months will be shown in one row. Returns the field name pointing to the Event Time. If 'null,' the calendar will retrieve the Event Time from the dateField field. Specifies the field name pointing to the Event Time. If 'null,' the 23
setMonthsInRow
getTimeField setTimeField
calendar will retrieve the Event Time from the dateField field. getVisualStyles setVisualStyles getVisualStyle setVisualStyle getMonth getYear isShowOtherMonthsDays Returns the map containing Styles that represent days of months, weeks, etc. Specifies the map containing Styles that represent days of months, weeks, etc. Returns the style with the specified name. Specifies the style with specified name to be used. Returns the month number to be shown. If it is not defined, the current month will be used. Returns the year to be shown. If it is not defined, the current year is used. Returns 'true' if days of the neighbouring months should be shown, otherwise - 'false'.
Description
Specifies the current day. Retrieves the current processing date. Retrieves the previous processing date. Retrieves the next processing date. Contains the calendar events. Contains the calendar styles. Specifies the style for the current processing block. Specifies whether the calendar should be shown.
Property
CurrentDate DataSource Date Day Mode Month MonthsInRow Visible WeekDayFormat
Description
Gets or sets the current date. Gets or sets a reference to data source bound to the form. Gets or sets date active date for the current calendar. Gets or sets the day part of active date. Gets or sets the mode of the current calendar component. Gets or sets the month part of active date. Gets or sets the number of displaing months in one row. Specifies whether the calendar should be shown. Gets or sets the format for displaying name of week days. 24
ShowOtherMonthsDays Gets or sets the showing of dates from other monthes for current month.
Property
errors
Description
This property keeps a reference to the forms errors NameValueCollection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. For each control that is located within the form, a member property is created with the same name as the control.
<control name>
<field name>GroupField For each group of report, the member property is created. Calendar Data Provider
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to the parameter source type) and parameter name (according to the parameter source).
See also
Calendar Navigator Reference
Description
The name of the form.
Description
Indicates whether this control is to be shown.
25
setVisible
getYearsRange Returns the number of years to be displayed in the navigator. setYearsRange Specifies the number of years to be displayed in the navigator.
Property
Date Month Order Quarter Year
Description
Retrives the selected date. Retrives the month part of selected date. Retrives or specifies the order ow showing navigator parts. Retrives the quarter number that contain selected date. Retrives the year part of selected date.
See also
Calendar Reference
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Checked Value Unchecked Value Default Value Error Control Validation Rule Validation Text Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. The value submitted by a Checkbox Control when it is checked. The value submitted by a Checkbox Control when it is unchecked. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages pertaining to this control. Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not meet the validation rule.
Events
Event
Server Side Events 26
Description
This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. Used for binding Validation rules to the control.
Description
An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. Holds a value of the control. This property determines whether the control is to be shown (parsed into template) or not. Returns state of the object.
Description
An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the control is to be shown (parsed into template) or not.
Property
Visible Checked Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets a value that indicates whether a server control is rendered as UI on the page. Gets or sets a value indicating whether the CheckBox control is checked. See .NET Framework SDK reference.
Property
<control name> <control name>CheckedValue
Description
Contains current value of control. Contains checked value of control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the CheckBox control. Sets the value for the CheckBox control.
Method
getPage setValue hasErrors addError getErrorsAsString isVisible setVisible getParent
Description
Get the page that contains this control. This method sets the value for the control. Whether the control has (validation) errors. Add error description to errors collection. Get all errors formatted as String, separated by <br> elements. Whether this control should be shown. Specify whether this control or component should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
Description
Holds the value of the control.
hide<control name> This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.
See also
Checkbox Overview
Description
The name of the control. The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Connection List Source Type List Data Source Bound Column Text Column Data Type Default Value Content Required Specify the source of data for the control. The database connection from where data will be retrieved. Specify the type of data source for the list of values to be shown in the control. Specify the actual data source for the list of values to appear in the control. The value entered here depends on the List Source Type property. When using database columns as the data source, specify the column containing the values that will be submitted. When using database columns as the data source, specify the column containing the values that will be displayed. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. Specify whether the data source content is plain text or HTML code. [Yes/No] Select Yes if a value must be entered for the control in order for 28
the form to be submitted successfully. Unique Error Control [Yes/No] Select Yes if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages pertaining to the control. If this value is not specified, all error messages are displayed at the top of the form in which the control is contained. Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not satisfy the validation rule.
Events
Event
Server Side Events On Validate This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values. This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. This event occurs before the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database is put together. This event can be used to modify the different clauses that make up the query such as the WHERE clause or the ORDER BY clause.
Description
Before Execute Select This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. This event can be used to modify the entire query before it is executed. After Execute Select Client Side Events On Click Occurs immediately after the control has been clicked. This event can be used to provide interactive behavior when the control is clicked. This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset containing the results is returned.
Description
A Data Source object created for the purpose of retrieving and holding the IDs and values to be displayed in the control. This property keeps a reference to the objects error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. This property stores the first selected checkbox value. This property controls the visibility of the control. If the property is set to false, the control will not be displayed.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the 29
records displayed within the control . In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. DataSource.Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. A Data Source object created for the purpose of retrieving and holding the IDs and values to be displayed in the control. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property controls the visibility of the control. If the property is set to false, the control will not be displayed.
Visible
Property
DataSource->SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource->Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the CheckBox List control. Only the first element of the array of values is retrieved. Sets the value of the CheckBox List control.
Property
Items SelectedIndex
Description
Gets the collection of items in the list control. See the .NET Framework SDK reference. Gets or sets the lowest ordinal index of the selected items in the list. See the 30
.NET Framework SDK reference. SelectedItem Visible Model Layer Gets the selected item with the lowest index in the list control. See the .NET Framework SDK reference. This property controls the visibility of the control. If the property is set to false, the control will not be displayed.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Description
Holds the value of the control. This variable can contain a semicolon separated list of values This variable controls the visibility of the control. If the variable is set to true, the control will not be displayed. This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL<control name> property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL<control name> property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This variable contains the query object associated with the control.
arr_<owner name><control name> This variable contains the array of items in the control.
strSQL<control name>
strWhere<control name>
query<control name>
Description
In the case where the CheckBox List allows for the selection of multiple values, this function is used to add a value to the list of selected values. Set the list of selected values from an enumeration of Strings. Set the list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from a String. 31
getOptions setOptions
Get the options list in the form of an enumeration of Strings. Set the list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from a String.
getFormattedOptions Prepare list collection for output. This method marks those list values that were selected by request. getPage getFormattedValue setFormattedValue hasErrors addError getErrorsAsString isVisible setVisible getParent Get the page that contains this control. Get the value formatted according to the control format. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether this control should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Checkbox List Overview
Connection Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Design Database Type Connection String Connection Type Login Password Server Database Type Date Format Boolean Format Catalog Schema
Description
The name of the connection. Has to be unique. The type of database being accessed during design time. If your database type is not listed, select the ANSI SQL-92 option. Depending on the type of connection, this can be either an ODBC DSN or a connection string. The type of connection. ODBC or Connection String. The user login name needed to access the database. The user password needed to access the database. The type of database being accessed during the server (live) execution. If your database type is not listed, select the ANSI SQL-92 option. The format in which date values should be entered into the database. The format in which Boolean values should be entered into the database. Specify a database catalog from which to display objects during design time. Specify a database schema from which to display objects during design time.
32
Views Synonyms System Tables System Views Aliases Use LIMIT/TOP Server Same As Design
[Yes/No] Select 'Yes' to enable the display of database views during design time. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' to enable the display of database Synonyms during design time. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' to enable the display of database System Tables during design time. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' to enable the display of database System Views during design time. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' to enable the display of database aliases during design time. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' to enable the usage of LIMIT or TOP clause to limit the size of SQL result sets. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' if the same connection will be used for design time as well as on the server.
Server Connection Type If the server connection is different from the design connection, specify whether the server connection will use an ODBC DSN or connection string. Server Connection String If the server connection is different from the design connection, specify the ODBC DSN or connection string to be used. Server Login Server Password If the server connection is different from the design connection, enter the user login name needed to access the server database. If the server connection is different from the design connection, enter the user password needed to access the server database.
Description
Retrieves the Connection object used to access data for a given item. Since a project can have several connections, this property stores the connection used for a particular data bound object. The Connection object can be used to perform various basic operations such as execution of an SQL query against the database. This property contains the connection string used to establish the database connection. This string includes the connection type, user credentials, database name or path and some other parameters. The connection string is passed to an ADO connection object when a new connection is being made. This is a collection of errors pertaining to the object. Any errors which occur during the course of the objects execution are registered in this collection. This property contains the password used to establish a connection to the database. In some cases, the user name and password are included within ConnectionString property. This property contains the user name used to establish a connection to the database. In some cases, the user name and password are included within ConnectionString property.
ConnectionString
Errors Password
User
Property
Errors
Description
This is a collection of errors pertaining to the object. Any errors which occur during the course of the objects execution are registered in this collection.
Property
Connection
Description
The connection string that includes the database name, and other parameters needed to establish the initial connection. The default value is an empty string. The type of .NET Managed Provider which will be used for the connection
Type
ConnectionCommands The collection of commands which will be executed when the connection is opened. DateFormat BoolFormat DateLeftDelim DateRightDelim Mask for formatting and parsing DateTime values. Mask for formatting and parsing Boolean values. Left delimeter for date values in an SQL command (for example '#' for MS Access). Right delimeter for date values in an SQL command (for example '#' for MS Access).
Methods (ASP)
Method
Close Execute Open ToSQL
Description
Closes the database connection. Executes an SQL query against the database connection. This method returns a recordset object containing the query results. Opens a database connection. Transforms values into SQL compatible format depending on the specified data type.
Methods (PHP)
Method
connect f next_record num_rows query
Description
Establishes a database connection. Retrieves the value of a field within a recordset. Moves the recordset pointer to the next row. Retrieves the number of rows returned by the last executed query. Executes an SQL query and returns a recordset if applicable. In the recordset, the row pointer is located before the first row so the next_record method has to be used to move the pointer to the first row before it can be read. Transforms values into SQL compatible format depending on the specified data type.
ToSQL
34
Method
Description
Method
getPoolName setLocale hasErrors getErrorsAsString getConnection
Description
Get the name of the connection pool. This name corresponds to the Connection name configured within the CodeCharge Studio IDE. Set the Locale. The locale is used to determine how to format data before it is inserted, updated and when it is selected. Indicates whether the connection has registered any errors or not. Returns a single string with all the errors that have been registered. This method is used to obtain a connection from the pool of connections. A new connection is created only if there are no other free connections, otherwise existing connections are reused. You should call the closeConnection method when done with a connection so as to return the connection to the pool. Returns a connection to the pool. This method doesn't really close the connection but returns it to the connection pool to be reused in the future.
closeConnection
createCallableStatement Create a CallableStatement by preparing a procedure call provided by the callString parameter. createPreparedStatement Create a PreparedStatement from the sql indicated by the sql parameter. A PreparedStatement differs from an ordinary Statement in that you can use question marks in place of query parameters. createStatement closeStatement executeUpdate execute toSql getRows getOneRow Create a Statement. The Statement object can then be used to query the database with SQL (executeQuery). Free a Statement object when it is no longer needed. Execute an INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE SQL-query. Execute a Stored Procedure. Transforms values into SQL compatible format depending on the specified data type. Returns an Enumeration of DbRows representing the records within a ResultSet. Get one row from a SQL query result.
Description
The name of the control. Specify the css style to be applied to the Date Picker. Specify the control to which the selected date value will be automatically 35
entered.
Description
This property controls the visibility of the control. If the property is set to false, the control will not be displayed.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property controls the visibility of the control. If the property is set to false, the control will not be displayed.
Description
Returns a value indicating whether this control is currently visible or not. Specify whether this control should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Date Picker Overview
Description
A unique name for the directory form. The database connection used by the form. The type of database resource that provides the data for the form. The table, SQL query or stored procedure that provides the data for the form. The database field which contains the IDs of the categories displayed in the Path 36
Subcategory ID Field The database field which contains the ID of the subcategories. This is essentially the same as the Category ID field but the field comes from an alias table. No. of Columns The directory form displays categories in columns. Use this property to set the number of columns to be used.
No. of Subcategories Each category in the directory form can have a number of subcategories. This property limits the number of subcategories that could be displayed. A link is provided to access extra columns if they are more than the limit. Restricted Specifies whether a user has to be authenticated in order to view the form.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Select Before Show This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to select records from the database. Occurs before the form is displayed and after the data for the form has been retrieved from the database and saved to control variables. This event can be used to populate custom template variables defined within directory HTML block. Occurs before each category in the form is shown. This event can be used to alter category values or performing other operations using the values of the categories.
Description
Before Show Subcategory Occurs before each subcategory in the form is shown. This event can be used to alter subcategory values or performing other operations using the values of the subcategories. Before Build Select This event occurs before the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database is put together. This event can be used to modify the different clauses that make up the query such as the WHERE clause or the ORDER BY clause. This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. This event can be used to modify the entire query before it is executed. This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset containing the results is returned.
Description
This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the specified object. The data source handles all data retrieval operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property keeps a reference to the form's error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the forms execution. Number of columns over which the categories in the directory form are spread. 37
Errors NumberOfColumns
NumberOfSubCategories Maximum number of subcategories to display per category. Recordset Visible Data Source properties This property contains the forms recordset which contains the data used to populate the form. This property determines whether the form will be shown or not.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control . In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource.Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. Number of columns over which the categories in the directory form are spread. This property stores a reference to data source bound to the form. Data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property keeps a reference to the forms error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the forms execution. This property determines whether the component will be shown or not.
Errors
NumberOfSubcategories Maximum number of subcategories to display per category. Visible Data Source properties
Property
DataSource->SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control . In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource->Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Property
DataSource NumberOfColumns
Description
This property stores a reference to data source bound to the form. Number of columns over which the categories in the directory form are spread. This property determines whether the component will be shown or not.
NumberOfSubCategories Maximum number of subcategories to display per category. Visible Model Layer
Property
errors <control name>
Description
This property keeps a reference to the objects errors collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution.
For each control that is located within a form, a member property is created with the same name as the control. Directory Data Provider
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to parameter source type) and parameter name (according to parameter source).
Methods (.NET)
Interface
Method
DataBind Data Provider
Description
Binds a data source to the invoked server control and all its child controls.
Method
GetResultSet
Description
Executes an SQL command and returns results in an Items array.
Description
Number of columns over which the categories in the directory form are spread. This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not. This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control . In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. This variable contains the query object associated with the control. 39
strSQL
strWhere
query<control name>
Description
Get the category ID of the currently selected category. Get the total number of records at the current directory level. Returns a value indicating whether the categories list is empty. Get the number of categories. Get the number of subcategories shown for each category. Specify the number of subcategories to be shown for each category. Get the order number of the current category. Get the number of columns which should be shown in the Directory form. Set the number of columns which should be shown in the Directory form.
children controls. getDatePicker isVisible setVisible getParent Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the form should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains the form.
See also
Directory Form Overview
Description
The name of the form. The database connection from where information will be retrieved. The type of data source or the method used to retrieve the data. The database column, SQL Query or other expression from where the data will be retrieved. The page to which the user is directed to after the form has been submitted successfully.
Remove Parameters Specify a semicolon-separated list of parameters that should be removed from the hyperlink. Convert URL To Records Per Page Page Size Limit Specify whether URLs should be automatically converted to absolute URLs or secure URLs for the SSL protocol (https://). The number of records to be displayed per page by default. The maximum number of records a user may opt to display per page if using a search form that allows control over the number of records displayed. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Number of empty rows. Specify whether the form can be used to insert new data. Specify whether the form can be used to update existing data. Specify whether the form can be used to delete existing data. Specifies the control value used as a deletion indicator for the rows of the Editable Grid. If you wish to override the default insert mechanism, select the type of method to be used to perform the insert operation. Specify the procedure to be used to insert data.
Restricted Empty Row Allow Insert Allow Update Allow Delete Delete Control
Preserve Parameters Specify whether Get or Post parameters should be preserved. Custom Insert Type Custom Insert
41
Custom Update Type If you wish to override the default update mechanism, select the type of method to be used to perform the update operation. Custom Update Specify the procedure to be used to update data. Custom Delete Type If you wish to override the default delete mechanism, select the type of method to be used to perform the delete operation. Custom Delete Specify the procedure to be used to delete data.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Select Before Show Before Show Row Before Build Select This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to select records from the database. This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. This event occurs before each row in the form is displayed. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database.
Description
Before Execute Select This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Select On Validate This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset for the result is returned. This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values. This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to submit a database record. This event occurs after submitting an existing row in the data source. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to insert a new record into the database. This event occurs immediately before a row insertion query is executed but after the query has been composed. This event occurs after new row insert query has been executed. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to update database content.
Before Submit After Submit Before Build Insert Before Execute Insert After Execute Insert Before Build Update
Before Execute Update This event occurs immediately before a row update query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Update Before Build Delete This event occurs after a row update query has been executed. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to deleted a database record.
Before Execute Delete This event occurs immediately before a row deletion query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Delete Client Side Events 42 This event occurs after a row deletion query has been executed.
On Load On Submit
Used for binding Validation rules to the control. Occurs on the client side when the user submits the form, before the data is sent to the server from the form.
Description
This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the form. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event. This property specifies the mode in which a form currently is in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode. This property specifies the number of empty rows to be displayed for inserting new data. This property contains any error messages pertaining to each of the rows in the Editable Grid. This property contains any error messages pertaining to the entire form as a whole. This property determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not.
DeleteAllowed
IsFormSubmitted This property determines how a form is processed based on whether the form is being shown for the first time or has been submitted for postback. In the initial display, the form fields are assigned data values before being displayed. Otherwise if the form has been submitted for postback, the submitted data is processed based on the operation that was initiated upon submission. PressedButton ReadAllowed Recordset UpdateAllowed This property contains the name of the form submit button which was clicked to initiate postback. This property determines whether the data read operation can proceed or not. This property contains a recordset in which are all the records that will be shown in the form. This is a boolean property whose value determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event. This property determines whether the form is to be shown or not.
Visible
Property
DataSource.CountSQL
Description
This property contains the SQL query which is executed to determine the total number of browseable rows in the Editable Grid form. The 43
number retrieved as a result of executing this query is used during the creation of the navigation controls for the form. DataSource.SQL This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form. This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
DataSource.Where
DataSource.Order
DataSource.CmdExecution This property determines whether or not the Insert, Update or Delete operation should proceed depending on the used BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete event. Recordset.RecordCount This property contains a count of all the records that have been retrieved for the form.
Description
Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the specified object. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event. This property specifies the mode in which a form currently is in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode. This property specifies the number of empty rows to be displayed for inserting new data. This property contains any error messages generated during execution of the form. This property determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not. This property contains the name of the form submit button which was clicked to 44
DeleteAllowed
initiate postback. ReadAllowed UpdateAllowed This property determines whether data read operation can proceed or not. This is a boolean property whose value determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Visible
Property
DataSource->CountSQL
Description
This property contains the SQL query which is executed to determine the total number of browseable rows in the Editable Grid form. The number retrieved as a result of executing this query is used during the creation of the navigation controls for the form. This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form. This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
DataSource->SQL
DataSource->Where
DataSource->Order
DataSource->CmdExecution This property determines whether or not the Insert, Update or Delete operation should proceed depending on the used BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete event. DataSource->RecordsCount This property contains a count of all the records that have been retrieved for the form.
Description
This variable determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this variable is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event. This variable specifies the mode in which a form currently is 45
blnEditMode<control name>
in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode. blnFormSubmitted<control_name> This variable determines how a form is processed based on whether the form is being shown for the first time or has been submitted for postback. In the initial display, the form fields are assigned data values before being displayed. Otherwise if the form has been submitted for postback, the submitted data is processed based on the operation that was initiated upon submission. blnInsertAllowed<control name> blnReadAllowed<control_name> blnUpdateAllowed<control_name> This variable determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not. This variable determines whether data read operation can proceed or not. This is a boolean variable whose value determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. The value of this variable is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event. This variable contains an array of structures identified for each grid's row. The structure has some keys such as Error,Operation. This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not. This variable specifies the number of empty rows to be displayed for inserting new data. This variable contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL variable to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This variable contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This variable contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL variable to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form. This variable contains any error messages generated during execution of the form. This variable contains the name of the form submit button which was clicked to initiate postback. 46
<control name>Rows
strSQL
strWhere
This variable contains the query object associated with the form. This property determines whether or not the Insert, Update or Delete operation should proceed depending on the used BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete event.
Description
setNumberEmptyRows Specify the number of empty rows to be displayed for inserting new data.
currentRow getChild getChildren getControl getFileUpload getButton getListBox getRadioButton getCheckBoxList getLink getDatePicker isVisible setVisible isCmdExecution setCmdExecution getParent
Returns the current row. Specify a name to find a child control among the collection of children controls. Return all children controls of a collection. Specify a name to find a Control among the collection of controls. Specify a name to find a FileUpload control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Button control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Listbox control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Radiobutton control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Checkbox List control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Link control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the form should be shown or not. Returns a value indicating whether the operation should proceed or not. Specify whether the operation should be performed or not. Get the parent component that contains the form.
Property
System.Web.UI.WebControls.Repeater <control name>Repeater. System.Collections.Specialized.NameValueCollection <control name>Errors. <control name>DataProvider <control name>Data Editable Grid Model Layer
Description
The Repeater object which holds all Editable Grid controls. See the .NET Framework SDK reference The collection of global critical errors, such as DataProvider errors. See the .NET Framework SDK reference. The Data Source Provider for the Editable Grid.
Property
errors
Description
This property keeps a reference to the objects errors NameValueCollection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution.
<control name> For each control that is located within the form, a member property is created with the same name as the control. 48
This property indicates if an item created based on an insert row. This property indicates if an item contains any data. This property indicates if the Delete checkbox is checked for an item This property indicates if an item has been successfully updated by the Data Provider.
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to parameter source type) and parameter name (according to parameter source). SortField PageNumber RecordsPerPage CmdExecution Gets or sets the sort column for the Select command. Gets or sets the page number for the Select command. Gets or sets the page size for the Select command. This property altered in BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete events determines whether the Insert, Update or Delete operation (respectively) for the current row should proceed.
Methods (.NET)
Editable Grid Model Layer
Method Description
Validate Performs the item validation and returns true if validation is successful, otherwise false. Editable Grid Data Provider
Method
Update
Description
Performs update operations for each item in the items array.
GetResultSet Execute a query against the database and return the items array.
See also
Editable Grid Form Overview
Description
A unique name used to identify the instance of the control. You can use this property to set a name that will be used to refer to the control within error messages. If a value is not specified for this property, the value of the Name property above is used by default. Since control names are often cryptic by nature, it is advisable to set a more readable caption which will better help the user understand what the error message is referring to. The type of data source from which the control gets its value. This can be one of the following: 49
Database Column The control value will come from a column within a database table. Code Expression The control value will be derived from an expression specific to the particular programming language being used. This could be a function that returns a value, a pre-existing variable or any other valid language construct that will evaluate to a definite value.
Typically, the control source is a database column where the names of the uploaded files are stored. Control Source This property depends on the value specified in the Control Source Type property above. If the Control Source Type is a Database Column, use this property to specify the database table column that will be used to furnish the control value. Respectively, if the Control Source Type is a Database Expression or a Code Expression, enter the expression to be used to furnish the control value. This property can be left blank if the control does not use a data source. [Yes/No] This property specifies whether the control must submit a file when the form is submitted. If the control does not submit a file, the form will not be processed to completion but instead an error message will be displayed. Usually, error messages corresponding to a control are displayed at the top of the form as plain text. However, you might want this error text to be displayed within another existing control, for instance, in a Label field placed adjacent to the control. Use this property to specify the name of a control where you want the error message for the current control to be displayed. Specify a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the upload component can temporarily place files while they are being processed. The path specified can be an absolute path e.g. c:\Inetpub\files\temp or a relative path e.g. .\files\temp Specify a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the final uploaded files should be stored. The path specified can be an absolute path e.g. c:\Inetpub\files\images or a relative path e.g. .\files\images Specify a semicolon separated list of file masks for files that the user is allowed to upload e.g. *.jpg; *.png; *.gif; *.txt. You can enter an asterisk (*) to allow all file types to be uploaded.
Required
Error Control
Temporary Folder
File Folder
Disallowed FIle Masks Specify a semicolon separated list of file masks for files that the user is not allowed to upload e.g. *.exe; *.dll; *.bat. File Size Limit Specify the size limit in bytes of the files that the user can upload. Files larger than the limit will not be uploaded.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Process File This event occurs after an uploaded file is saved to the temporary directory but before it is moved to the target folder. This event can be used to check 50
Description
additional conditions or to change the file location or name. After Process File Before Delete File After Delete File Before Show On Validate This event occurs after an uploaded file is moved to the target folder from the temporary folder. It can be used to perform post processing on the file. This event occurs before a file is deleted from the server. It can be used to check additional permissions or conditions before deleting the file. This event occurs after a file has been deleted from the server. It can be used to perform cleanup operations after removing the file. This event occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values.
Description
This property contains a list of file masks for files that the user is allowed to upload.
DisallowedFileMasks This property contains a list of file masks for files that the user is not allowed to upload. Errors FileFolder FileSize FileSizeLimit IsUploaded This property keeps a reference to the objects error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. This property specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the final uploaded files should be stored. This property contains the actual size on an uploaded file. This property specifies the size limit in bytes of the files that the user can upload. Files larger than the limit will not be uploaded. This property indicated the control's processing state. If true, the file has been uploaded and is waiting for processing. If false, no file was selected for uploading. This property specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the upload component can temporarily place files while they are being processed. This property contains the name of the uploaded file. This property determines whether the control is displayed or not. In order for this property to work, the extended HTML comments have to be defined for the control.
TemporaryFolder
Value Visible
Description
This property contains a list of file masks for files that the user is allowed to upload. Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form.
51
DisallowedFileMasks This property contains a list of file masks for files that the user is not allowed to upload. Errors FileSizeLimit FileFolder TemporaryFolder This property keeps a reference to the objects error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. This property specifies the size limit in bytes of the files that the user can upload. Files larger than the limit will not be uploaded. This property specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the final uploaded files should be stored. This property specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the upload component can temporarily place files while they are being processed. This property determines whether the control is displayed or not.
Visible
Description
This property contains the name of the uploaded file. This property contains a list of file masks for files that the user is allowed to upload.
DisallowedFileMasks This property contains a list of file masks for files that the user is not allowed to upload. FileSizeLimit FileFolder TemporaryFolder This property specifies the size limit in bytes of the files that the user can upload. Files larger than the limit will not be uploaded. This property specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the final uploaded files should be stored. This property specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the upload component can temporarily place files while they are being processed. This property indicates whether a value must be specified in the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. This property determines whether the control is displayed or not.
Required Visible
Methods (.NET)
Method
ValidateFile SaveFile DeleteFile
Description
Validate an uploaded file and if validation is successful, save the file to the TemporaryFolder. Save a file to the specified FileFolder. Delete a file from the server .
Methods (ASP)
Method Description
GetOriginFileName This method can be used to retrieve the original name of the uploaded file i.e. without the unique timestamp appended to the filename.
Methods (PHP)
52
Method
GetFileName GetFileSize GetValue SetValue
Description
This method can be used to retrieve the original name of the uploaded file i.e. without the unique timestamp appended to the filename. This method can be used to retrieve the size of the uploaded file. This method retrieves the name of the uploaded file. This method sets the name of the uploaded file.
Description
This variable contains the name of the uploaded file.
par<control name>.TemporaryFolder This variable specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the upload component can temporarily place files while they are being processed par<control name>.FileFolder This variable specifies a file system path to a folder on the web server machine where the final uploaded files should be stored. This variable determines whether the control is displayed or not.
hide<control name>
Description
Get the page that contains this control. Set the control value using a String. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
getFormattedValue Get the control value formatted according to the control format.
See also:
File Upload Overview
Description
The name of the form. The database connection from where information will be retrieved. The type of data source or the method used to retrieve the data. 53
The database column, SQL Query or other expression from where the data will be retrieved. Specify where users must be logged in before accessing the form. The numbers of records to be displayed per page by default. The maximum number of records a user may opt to display per page if using a search form that allows control over the number of records displayed.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Select Before Show Before Show Row Before Build Select Occurs before calling the select operation. Occurs before showing (populating template with data) page component or control. Occurs before showing (populating template with data) each grid's row. Occurs before processing parameters and building selecting query.
Description
Before Execute Select Occurs just before initializing recordset with query data and parameters and opening it for retrieving resulting rows. After Execute Select Occurs after data sources rows selection query has been executed and a recordset for the result is returned.
Description
This property stores a reference to data source bound to the form. The data source handles all data retrieval operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property keeps a reference to the forms error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. This property contains the forms recordset which contains the data used to populate the form. This property determines whether the form will be shown or not.
Property
Description
DataSource.CountSQL This property contains the SQL query which is executed to determine the total number of browseable rows in the Grid form. The number retrieved as a result of executing this query is used during the creation of the navigation controls for the form. DataSource.SQL This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control . In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is 54
DataSource.Where
appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. DataSource.Order This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Recordset.RecordCount This property contains a count of all the records that have been retrieved for the form.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the form. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property keeps a reference to the forms error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the forms execution. This property determines whether the component will be shown or not.
Errors Visible
Property
DataSource->CountSQL
Description
This property contains the SQL query which is executed to determine the total number of browseable rows in the Grid form. The number retrieved as a result of executing this query is used during the creation of the navigation controls for the form. This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form. This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. 55
DataSource->SQL
DataSource->Where
DataSource->Order
DataSource->RecordsCount This property contains a count of all the records that have been retrieved for the form.
Property
System.Web.UI.WebControls.Repeater <control name>Repeater.
Description
The Repeater object which holds all Grid controls. See the .NET Framework SDK reference.
<control name>DataProvider <control name>Data The Data Source Provider for the Grid. Grid Model Layer
Property
<control name>
Description
For each control that is located within the form, a member property is created with the same name as the control.
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to parameter source type) and parameter name (according to parameter source). SortField PageNumber RecordsPerPage Gets or sets the sort column for the Select command. Gets or sets the page number for the Select command. Gets or sets the page size for the Select command.
Methods (.NET)
Grid Data Provider
Method
GetResultSet
Description
Execute a query against the database and return the items array.
Description
This variable contains number of the shown records on the page. This variable contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL variable to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This variable contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This variable contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria 56
strSQL
strWhere
which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL variable to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form. hide<control name> This variable determines whether the form is to be shown or not.
Description
Get the current page being shown in the Grid. Set the page number to be shown in the Grid. Get the total number of rows in the Grid. Use a name to find the Navigator among the collection of children controls. Use a name to find a Sorter among the collection of children controls. Get number of records per page. Equivalent to getFetchSize. Set number of records per page. Equivalent to setFetchSize. Returns a value indicating whether the data read operation can proceed or not. Use to toggle the value which determines whether the data read operations can proceed or not. Returns a value indicating whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Get the page to which the component belongs. Indicates whether a component has been processed (the ccsForm parameter is equivalent to the name of the component). Returns true if there are more elements in a collection. Returns the next row. If row isn't available returns empty HashMap; never null. Returns the current row. Specify a name to find a child control among the collection of children controls. Return all children controls of a collection. Specify a name to find a Control among the collection of controls. Specify a name to find a FileUpload control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Button control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Listbox control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Radiobutton control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Checkbox List control among the collection of 57
children controls. getLink getDatePicker isVisible setVisible getParent Specify a name to find a Link control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the form should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains the form.
See also
Grid Form Overview
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not. The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Format Default Value Required Unique Input Validation Error Control Validation Rule Validation Text DBFormat Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. [Yes/No] Select Yes if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. [Yes/No] Select Yes if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. Select a regular expression to be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages pertaining to this control. Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not meet the validation rule. Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
58
Events
Event
Server Side Events On Validate This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values. Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. Occurs at the beginning of page processing and is used for binding Validation rules to the control.
Description
Description
An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. Holds the value of the control.
Value
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled.
Property
Visible Value Model Layer
Description
Indicates whether the control is rendered on the page or not. Gets or sets the value of the hidden control. See .NET Framework SDK reference.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the Hidden control. Sets the value for the Hidden control.
fld<control name>
Description
Get the page that contains this control. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
See also
Hidden Overview
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Format Default Value DBFormat Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
Events
Event
Server Side Events 60
Description
BeforeShow
Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. By placing code in this event, the user can alter the URL of the image or hide the control.
Description
Specifies the location of the image. Specifies whether the image is visible. Setting this property to false will prevent the object from being displayed (however the image icon will remain in the generated page)
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. Specifies whether the component is to be shown or not.
Property
Visible ImageUrl Model Layer
Description
Indicates whether the control is rendered on the page or not. Gets or sets a image url. See .NET Framework SDK reference.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains current value of control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the Image control (the URL of the image). Sets the value of the Image control (the URL of the image).
Description
Specifies the location of the image.
hide<control name> Specifies whether the image is visible. If the variable is not defined or its value is false then the components is visible, if the value is true then the component is not visible. By default this variable is not defined, i.e. the component is visible. Setting this variable to true will prevent the object from being displayed (however the image icon will remain in the generated page)
Description
Get the page that contains this control.
Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
See also
Image Overview
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Href Type Href Source Convert URL to Format Default Value Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. The type of source where the URL value will come from. The page path, database column or other expression containing the URL of the hyperlink. Specify whether the URL should be converted to an absolute URL or a secure (https://) URL. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified.
Remove Parameters Specify a semicolon-separated list of parameters that should be removed from the hyperlink. Preserve Parameters Specify whether GET or Post parameters should be preserved. DBFormat Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
62
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Show Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to change the URL of the ImageLink control or the path to the image displayed in the control.
Description
Description
Stores the URL to which the ImageLink links to. Retrieves or sets the value of the ImageLink control, in this case, the path to the image to be displayed.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue GetLink SetLink
Description
Retrieves the value of the ImageLink control, in this case, the path to the image to be displayed. Sets the value of the ImageLink control, in this case, the path to the image to be displayed. Retrieves the URL to which the ImageLink links to. Sets the URL to which the ImageLink links to.
Property
ImageUrl NavigateUrl Visible Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets the path to an image to display for the HyperLink control. See .NET Framework SDK reference. Gets or sets the URL to link to when the HyperLink control is clicked. See .NET Framework SDK reference. This property determines whether the control will be shown or not.
Property
<control name> <control name>Href
Description
Contains the current value of control. Contains the URL to link to when the HyperLink control is clicked.
<control name>HrefParameters Contains the URL parameters to be appended to the URL of the control.
Variable
fld<control name>
Description
Retrieves or sets the value of the ImageLink control, in this case, the path to the image to be displayed. This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.
fld<control name>Link This variable contains the URL to which the ImageLink links to. hide<control name>
Description
Add a parameter to the collection of parameters. Find a parameter from among the collection of parameters. Get the page that contains this control. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Image Link Overview
Description
The name of the control. The page that will be included.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This variable determines whether the include page is to be shown or not.
Property
Visible
Description
This variable determines whether the include page is to be shown or not.
Methods (Servlets)
Method
isVisible setVisible getParent
Description
Indicates whether the include page is to be shown or not. Specify whether the include page is to be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains the Include Page.
See also
Include Page Overview
Label Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name
Description
The name of the control.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Format Default Value Content DBFormat Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. Specify whether the content of the control is plain text or HTML code. Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Show Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to change the value of the control.
Description
Description
This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. 65
Value
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the control will be shown or not.
Property
Visible Text Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets a value that indicates whether the control will be rendered on the page. Gets or sets the text for the Label. See .NET Framework SDK reference.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the Label control. Sets the value of the Label control.
Description
Holds the value of the control.
hide<control name> This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.If the variable is set to true, the label will not be displayed.
Description
Get the page that contains this control. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags.
66
Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Label Overview
Link Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Visible
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Format Default Value Content Href Type Href Source Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. Specify whether the content of the control is plain text or HTML code. The type of source where the URL value will come from. This property opens the Href Source window where you can specify the page to be linked to as well as any parameters that should be transmitted via the URL. Specify whether the URL should be converted to an absolute URL or a secure (https://) URL.
Convert URL to
Remove Parameters Specify a semicolon-separated list of parameters that should be removed from the hyperlink. Preserve Parameters Specify whether GET or Post parameters should be preserved. DBFormat Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Show Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. By placing code in this event, the user can change the text or the URL of the Link control.
Description
This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. This property contains the URL that will be linked to. This property holds the text that will be displayed in the Link (this is the text that appears between the <a> and </a> tags in the HTML code).
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue GetLink SetLink
Description
Retrieves the value of the Link control, in this case, the text displayed in the Link. Sets the value of the Link control, in this case, the text displayed in the Link. Retrieves the URL to which the Link links to. Sets the URL to which the Link links to.
Property
InnerHtml InnerText HRef Visible Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets the content found between the opening and closing tags of the specified HTML server control. Gets or sets the text between the opening and closing tags of the specified HTML server control. Gets or sets the URL to link to when the HyperLink control is clicked. See .NET Framework SDK reference. This property determines whether the control is to be shown or not.
Property
<control name> <control name>Href
Description
Contains the current value of the control. Contains the URL to link to when the HyperLink control is clicked.
<control name>HrefParameters Contains the URL parameters to be appended to the URL of the control.
Description
This variable holds the text that will be displayed in the Link (this is the text that appears between the <a> and </a> tags in the HTML code).
fld<control name>Link This variable contains the URL that will be linked to. 68
hide<control name>
Description
Add a parameter to the collection of parameters. Find a parameter from among the collection of parameters. Get the page that contains this control. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Link Overview
List Box
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Visible Caption
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not. The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Connection Data Source Type Data Source Bound Column Text Column Data Type Specify the source of data for the control. The database connection from where information will be retrieved. Specify the type of source of data for the list of values to be shown in the control. Specify the actual source of data for the list of values depending on the List Source Type. Refers to the data source for the values that are submitted. Refers to the data source for the values that are displayed. The type of data that will be contained in the control. 69
Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. Yes/No] Select Yes if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. [Yes/No] Select Yes if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages pertaining to the control. If this value is not specified, all error messages are displayed at the top of the form in which the control is contained. Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not meet the validation rule.
Events
Event
Server Side Events On Validate This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values. This event occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event occurs before the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database is put together. This event can be used to modify the different clauses that make up the query such as the WHERE clause or the ORDER BY clause.
Description
Before Execute Select This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. This event can be used to modify the entire query before it is executed. After Execute Select Client Side Events On Change On Load Occurs on the client side whenever the control's value is changed and focus is lost. Used for binding Validation rules to control. A user can provide JavaScript code that will be executed by the browser. This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset containing the results is returned.
Description
A Data Source object created for the purpose of retrieving and holding the IDs and values to be displayed in the control. This property keeps a reference to the objects error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. This property contains objects recordset used to iterate rows in the data source result. 70
Value Visible
This property contains the value of the selected ListBox option. This property determines whether the control is visible or not.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource.Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. A Data Source object created for the purpose of retrieving the IDs and values to be displayed in the List Box control. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property determines whether the control is visible or not.
Visible
Property
DataSource->SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control . In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource->Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
Property
Items SelectedIndex
Description
Gets the collection of items in the list control. See the .NET Framework SDK reference. Gets or sets the lowest ordinal index of the selected items in the list. See .NET Framework SDK reference. 71
Value
Gets the value of the selected item in the HtmlSelect control or sets the SelectedIndex property of the control to the index of the first item in the list with the specified value. See .NET Framework SDK reference. This property determines whether the control is visible or not.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the List Box control. Sets the value of the List Box control.
Description
Holds the value of the List Box control. This variable can contain a semicolon separated list of values. This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not. This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL<control name> property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the control. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL<control name> property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This variable controls the visibility of the control. If the variable is set to true, the control will not be displayed.
arr_<owner name><control name> This variable contains the array of items in the list control.
strSQL<control name>
strWhere<control name>
hide<control name>
Description
Prepare HTML output for ListBox. The output consists of list of html option 72
elements ready for output. addValue setValues setListOfValues getOptions setOptions In the case where the ListBox allows for the selection of multiple values, this function is used to add a value to the list of selected values. Set the list of selected values from an enumeration of Strings. Set the list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from a String. Get the options list in the form of an enumeration of Strings. Set the list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from a String.
getFormattedOptions Prepare list collection for output. This method marks those list values that were selected by request. getPage getFormattedValue setFormattedValue hasErrors addError getErrorsAsString isVisible setVisible getParent Get the page that contains this control. Get the value formatted according to the control format. Set the control value from String. Value is taken as is, formatting will not be applied to this value. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether this control should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
List Box Overview
Navigator Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Page Links Type
Description
The name of the Navigator component. Specify the number of displayed page links (10 by default). Specify the type of links used in the Navigator.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Show Occurs before the component is rendered to the page.
Description
Description
This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. 73
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Property
Style PagerSize PageNumber MaxPage Visible
Description
Gets or sets the display style of the Navigator component. Gets or sets the number of pages that will be displayed by the Navigator. Gets or sets the current page number. Gets or sets the maximum number of pages. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Description
Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Navigator Overview
Page Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Restricted Convert URL To Includable SSL Access Only
Description
Specify if the Group Access authorization is used. Specify if the Access Denied URL should be converted to different format. Specify of the Page is included in other pages If the page is not accessed via SSL then the connection error occurs.
Access Denied Page Page used for redirection in case of denied access.
Events
Event
Server Side Events 74
Description
After Initialize
Occurs after all page components have been initialized, before processing submitted data or showing components. It can be used for defining code that should be executed before any other event code. It can be used on pages that don't contain any objects and are used only for processing data, without outputting the rendered template (e.g. for pages that should output binary data, like images or files). Another common application is conditional redirecting (using Redirect global variable). Occurs after handling submitted data and before loading templates for page showing. A common application is changing template filename to use different page templates conditionally. Occurs after the template object has been initialized with the template page contents and before showing (populating template with data) page components and controls. This event can be used for putting dynamic content into template variables (i.e. {var_name}, where var_name is the name of the variable). Occurs after page template is rendered and before output content to the client. Occurs before disposing pages components objects, after page output is completed. It can be used for defining code that should be executed just before the page execution is complete. Another application is closing additional database connections or freeing other custom resources. Used for binding Validation rules to control, initializing any JavaScript functions. It is invoked when the page loading is completed by the browser. It can be used to initialize some DHTML components like menus or trees placed on page. Invoked when the page is about to be closed, or the user navigates to another page. It can be used to detect unsubmitted changes or ask for page leaving confirmation.
On Initialize View
Before Show
On Unload
Redirect
This variable contains relative or absolute URL, or just page name to redirect. This redirection is made just before On Initialize View event, so it only makes sense to set variable's value in After Initialize event or some submit processing event in page sub components. This variable contains absolute filesystem path to current page's directory. This variable contains name of the template file. This file is loaded to retrieve page and components rendering HTML blocks. This variable holds a reference to root template block. It can be used to access template variables defined in HTML code.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form.
DB<connectionname> For each connection used by page's components a global variable is created to hold connection's functionality. Variable name consists of constant DB prefix and variable suffix dependent on the name of the connection. FileName This global variable holds the name of the page that is currently processed. This variable is useful to determine which page is currently being processed from within included page. This variable can be used to construct link on included pages too. This variable holds relative path to access site's root directory from page's parent directory. It is usually composed of number of .. parent paths (depending on page's level). This variable contains relative or absolute URL, or just page name to redirect. This redirection is made just before On Initialize View event, so it only makes sense to set variable's value in After Initialize event or some submit processing event in page sub components. This variable contains name of the template file. This file is loaded to retrieve page and components rendering HTML blocks. An object that contains CCS internal representation of the template HTML file used for the page's layout.
PathToRoot
Redirect
TemplateFileName Tpl
Description
This constant contains path from site's root directory to currently executed page's directory.
Description
Find Component in children collection by name. Find Grid in children collection by name. Find Record in children collection by name. 76
Find EditableGrid in children collection by name. Find Directory in children collection by name. Find Path in children collection by name. Returns redirection URL string. Specify URL string for redirect. This redirection is made just before On Initialize View event, so it only makes sense to set variable's value in After Initialize event or some submit processing event in page sub components. Returns the current request associated with this page. Returns the current response associated with this page. Returns the value of a request GET parameter as a String, or null if parameter does not exist.
getHttpPostParameter Returns the value of a request POST parameter as a String, or null if parameter does not exist. getParameter getFile getTemplate isRestricted setRestricted getChild getChildren getControl getFileUpload getButton getListBox getRadioButton getCheckBoxList getLink getDatePicker Returns the value of a request parameter as a String, or null if parameter does not exist. Returns a UploadedFile object that present a uploaded file, or null if file does not uploaded. Returns the Template object for the direct usage of the template library or null for JSP. Whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Specify a name to find a child control among the collection of children controls. Return all children controls of a collection. Specify a name to find a Control among the collection of controls. Specify a name to find a FileUpload control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Button control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Listbox control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Radiobutton control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Checkbox List control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Link control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. 77
Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
Description
For each connection a request scope variable is created to hold connection's functionality.This variable contains username value specified in the connection
DB_<connectionname>_USER_PASSWORD For each connection a request scope variable is created to hold connection's functionality.This variable contains password value specified in the connection DB_<connectionname>_DB_TYPE For each connection a request scope variable is created to hold connection's functionality.This variable contains database driver type value specified in the connection For each connection a request scope variable is created to hold connection's functionality.This variable contains name of the data source connection This variable holds the name of the page that is currently processed. This variable is useful to determine which page is currently being processed from within included page. This variable can be used to construct link on included pages too. This variable contains path from site's root directory to currently executed page's directory. This variable holds relative path to access site's root directory from page's parent directory. This variable contains relative or absolute URL, or just page name to redirect. This redirection is made just before On Initialize View event, so it only makes sense to set variable's value in After Initialize event or some submit processing event in page sub components. This variable contains name of the template file. This file is loaded to retrieve page and components rendering HTML blocks.
DB_<connectionname>_DB_DS
strFileName
Panel Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property Description
Name The identifier used in the generated code and HTML template. 78
Visible
Specify whether the panel should be shown on the page at run-time. If the value is "No" the Panel and included components will be not displayed. Note: this property specifies the default state of the panel, which can be changed dynamically using the custom code or actions.
Events
Event Description
Before Show This event occurs before panel component is rendered within the page.
Description
Determine whether the panel and included components should be shown.
Methods (ASP)
Method Description
AddComponents This method can be used to add an array of controls.
Description
The component collection included into the panel. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. Specify if the form will be shown or not.
Property Description
79
Visible
Retrieves or specifies the value indicating whether the control will be rendered on the page. Panel Control Placing an existing component within a new panel Restricting SQL Execution for Components Hidden Using a Panel Iterating Panel Controls Working with Panels
See also
Path Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Connection Data Source Type Data Source ID Field Parent Field
Description
Name of the control. Select one of the project database connection names. Specify the type of Data Source. Specify the actual source of data for the list of values depending on the Source Type. Specify the field containing the unique ID that identifies the categories. Specify the field with primary key values of the parent categories.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Select Before Show Before Build Select This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to select records from the database. This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database.
Description
Before Show Category This event occurs before each category in the Path is displayed.
Before Execute Select This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Select This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset for the result is returned.
Description
This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the component. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property contains any error messages pertaining to the entire form as a 80
Errors
whole. Recordset Visible This property contains a recordset in which are all the records that will be shown in the form. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the component. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource.Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the component. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the component.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the specified object. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property keeps the reference to the objects error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Errors Visible
Property
DataSource->SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the component. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource->Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the component. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the component.
Property
DataSource
Description
This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the component. 81
Property
errors <control name>
Description
This property keeps a reference to the objects error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. For each control that is located within a component, a member property is created with the same name as the control.
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to parameter source type) and parameter name (according to parameter source).
Methods (.NET)
Data Provider
Method
GetResultSet
Description
Executes an SQL command and returns results in an Items array.
Description
This variable contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL variable to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control. This variable contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the component. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This variable contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the component. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the strSQL variable to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the component. This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.
query<control name> This variable contains the query object associated with the component.
strSQL
strWhere
hide<control name>
Description
Indicates whether users must be logged in before accessing the component. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the component. Get the page to which the component belongs. Indicate whether the component has been processed. 82
hasNextRow nextRow currentRow getChild getChildren getControl getFileUpload getButton getListBox getRadioButton getCheckBoxList getLink getDatePicker isVisible setVisible getParent
Returns true if there are more elements in a collection Returns the next row. If the next row isn't available, this method returns an empty HashMap; This method never returns a null. Returns the current row. Specify a name to find a child control among the collection of children controls. Return all children controls of a collection. Specify a name to find a Control among the collection of controls. Specify a name to find a FileUpload control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Button control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Listbox control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Radiobutton control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Checkbox List control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Link control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether this component should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
See also
Path Overview
Project Reference
Properties
Property
Code Language Site Language Server URL: Secured Server URL
Description
Select the programming language in which the code will be generated. Specify the spoken language for the site. The HTTP URL to be used to access the published pages. Specify the SSL HTTP URL to be used to access the published pages. This option is only used if you want to access the pages over a SSL connection and the server you are using supports SSL. The file system path where the pages will be published. Specify whether the generated pages will be published to a local computer or network or whether they will be published to a remote 83
computer via FTP. FTP Server FTP Folder FTP Login FTP Password FTP Server URL FTP Passive Mode Default Date Format The address of the FTP host machine. The path to the folder in the FTP host machine where the pages will be uploaded. The login name required to access the FTP host machine. The password required to access the FTP host machine. The HTTP URL that maps to the location on the FTP host where the pages are uploaded. Whether or not the FTP session should use passive mode, for instance if connecting from behind a firewall. Select the format in which you want date values to be displayed in the project. If no selection is made, date values will be displayed in the default database format Specify the starting page for your project.
None: No site security is implemented Table: Security will be based on information contained in a database table Database: The inbuilt database security will be used for the site
Login Page Convert URL To User ID Stored As Security Connection User Table User ID Field User Login Field User Password Field Level/Group Field User ID Variable User Login Variable
Select the project page that will be used to enter authentication details by the users. Specify whether URLs should be automatically converted to absolute URLs or secure URLs for the SSL protocol (https://). Select the method to be used to store the User ID after a user logs in (Session, URL, Cookies). Select the connection from where security information will be retrieved. Select the database table containing user security information. Select the database table field containing the unique ID that identifies the users. Select the database table field containing the login usernames of the users. Select the database table field containing the login passwords of the users. If applicable, select the database table field containing the security level of the users. Enter a name to be used for the user ID variable for a logged in user. Enter a name to be used for the user login name variable for a logged in user.
User Password Variable Enter a name to be used for the user password variable for a logged in user. Group ID Variable Level Inclusion Enter a name to be used for the group ID variable for a logged in user. If this option is selected, users with a higher security level will be able to 84
access pages designated with a lower security level. Otherwise, an exact match will be needed in order to access any page. Character Set CodePage Set the value for the code page used for setting the body of the HTTP request. This can be necessary when sending data in the body using a character set other than the system default. Geographic Local LCID The LCID is a locale identifier that identifies the language in use.
Description
Name of the control. Name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Control Source Type Type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Connection Data Source Type Data Source Bound Column Text Column Data Type Default Value Content Required Unique Error Control Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The database connection from where information will be retrieved. Specify the type of source of data for the list of values to be shown in the control e.g. the name of a database column. Specify the actual source of data for the list of values depending on the List Source Type. The data source column containing the values that will be submitted. The data source column containing the values that will be displayed. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. The type of the content [Text or HTML]. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. Yes/No] Select 'Yes' if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages pertaining to the control. If this value is not specified, all error messages are displayed at the top of the form in which the control is contained.. Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not meet the validation rule.
Events
Event Description
85
Server Side Events On Validate Occurs after the control value have been submitted to the server and before the submitted value is used to update any database content. This event is meant to be used to specify any validation operations that should be run against the submitted value to ensure that the value is valid. The addErrors method of the form can be used to log an error if the validation check fails. Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to set template variables placed within the control's HTML block. For instance, the control can be disabled conditionally. Occurs before the query used to retrieve the data for the control is built. This event can be used to modify the data retrieval query e.g. set the value of the where or order by clause.
Before Show
Before Execute Select Occurs before the query used to retrieve the data for the control is executed. This event can be used to modify the entire query before it is executed. After Execute Select Client Side Events On Click Occurs immediately after the control has been clicked. This event can be used to provide interactive behavior when the control is clicked. Occurs after the query used to retrieve the data for the control has been executed and the results of the query have been returrned in a recordset.
Description
This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the radio button. The data source handles all data retrieval operations. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property contains a recordset with the data retrieved for the control. This property contains the value of the selected radio button. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. Components can only be hidden if they have Extended HTML generated. To hide the component this property has to be set to false in some parent component's Before Show event.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains SQL query used to retrieve records displayed with grid form.
DataSource.Where This property contains portion of SQL query containing expressions used to filter the grid rows (WHERE clause).
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the radio button. The data source handles all data retrieval operations. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. Components can only be hidden if they have Extended HTML generated. To hide the component this property has to be set to false in some parent component's Before Show event.
Visible
Property
DataSource->SQL
Description
This property contains SQL query used to retrieve records displayed with grid form.
DataSource->Where This property contains portion of SQL query containing expressions used to filter the grid rows (WHERE clause).
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Returns the value of the selected radio button. Sets the selected radio button based on its value.
Property
Items SelectedIndex SelectedItem Visible Model Layer
Description
Gets the collection of items in the list control. See .NET Framework SDK reference. Gets or sets the lowest ordinal index of the selected items in the list. See .NET Framework SDK reference. Gets the selected item with the lowest index in the list control. See .NET Framework SDK reference. This property determines whether the control is visible (parsed into template) or not.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains current value of control.
fld<control name> hide<control name> strOrder<control name> strSQL<control name> strWhere<control name> query<control name>
Holds a value of the control. This variable controls the visibility of the control. If the variable is set to true, the control will not be displayed. This variable contains the ORDER clause to be used with the SQL query to execute for a query object (cfquery tag). This variable contains the SQL query to execute for a query object (cfquery tag) for gets data. This variable contains the WHERE clause to be used with the SQL query to execute for a query object (cfquery tag). This variable contains query object.
Description
For Multiselect lists add value to selected values list. Set list selected values from Enumeration of Strings. Set list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from String. Get Options list in form of Enumeration of Strings. Set list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from String.
getFormattedOptions Prepare list collection for output. This method marks those list values that were selected by request. getPage getFormattedValue setFormattedValue hasErrors addError getErrorsAsString isVisible setVisible getParent Get the page that contains this control. Get the value formatted according to the control format. Set the control value from String. Value is taken as is, formatting will not be applied to this value. Whether the control has (validation) errors. Add error description to errors collection. Get all errors formatted as String, separated by <br> elements. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
See also
Radio Button Overview
Description
The name of the form. The database connection from which information will be retrieved. The type of data source or the method used to retrieve the data. 88
The database column, SQL Query or other expression from where the data will be retrieved. The page to which the user is directed to after the form has been submitted successfully.
Remove Parameters Specify a semicolon-separated list of parameters that should be removed from the hyperlink. Convert URL To Restricted Allow Insert Allow Update Allow Delete Custom Insert Type Custom Insert Specify whether URLs should be automatically converted to absolute URLs or secure URLs for the SSL protocol (https://). Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Specify whether the form can be used to insert new data. Specify whether the form can be used to update existing data. Specify whether the form can be used to delete existing data. If you wish to override the default insert mechanism, select the type of method to be used to perform the insert operation. Specify the procedure to be used to insert data.
Custom Update Type If you wish to override the default update mechanism, select the type of method to be used to perform the update operation. Custom Update Specify the procedure to be used to update data. Custom Delete Type If you wish to override the default delete mechanism, select the type of method to be used to perform the delete operation. Custom Delete Specify the procedure to be used to delete data.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Select Before Show Before Build Select This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to select records from the database. This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database.
Description
Before Execute Select This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Select On Validate This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset for the result is returned. This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values. This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to insert a new record into the database. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to 89
insert a new record into the database. Before Execute Insert After Execute Insert After Insert Before Update Before Build Update Occurs directly before executing new row insertion query, after all its components have been prepared. This event occurs after new row insert query has been executed. This event occurs after inserting a new row into data source, but before error processing. This event occurs before preparing to update an existing record. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to update database content.
Before Execute Update This event occurs immediately before a row update query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Update After Update Before Delete Before Build Delete This event occurs after a row update query has been executed. This event occurs after updating an existing row in the data source, but before error processing. This event occurs before preparing for a row deletion. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to deleted a database record.
Before Execute Delete This event occurs immediately before a row deletion query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Delete After Delete Client Side Events On Load On Submit Used for binding Validation rules to control. Occurs on the client side when the user submits the form, before the data are sent to the server from the form. This event occurs after a row deletion query has been executed. This event occurs after deleting a row from the data source, but before error processing.
Description
This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the form. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event. This property specifies the mode in which a form currently is in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode. This property keeps a reference to the form's error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the forms execution. 90
DeleteAllowed
EditMode Errors
FormSubmitted This property determines how a form is processed based on whether the form is being shown for the first time or has been submitted for postback. In the initial display, the form fields are assigned data values before being displayed. Otherwise if the form has been submitted for postback, the submitted data is processed based on the operation that was initiated upon submission. InsertAllowed PressedButton ReadAllowed Recordset This property determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not. This property contains the name of the form submit button which was clicked to initiate postback. This property determines whether the data read operation can proceed or not. This property contains a recordset in which is the database record that will be shown in the form.
UpdateAllowed This is a boolean property whose value determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event. Visible This property determines whether the form is to be shown or not.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form.
DataSource.Where
DataSource.CmdExecution This property determines whether or not the Insert, Update or Delete operation should proceed depending on the used BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete event.
Description
Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property stores a reference to the data source bound to the form. The data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure. This property determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value 91
DeleteAllowed
of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event. EditMode Errors FormSubmitted This property specifies the mode in which a form currently is in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode. This property keeps a reference to the form's error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the forms execution. This property determines how a form is processed based on whether the form is being shown for the first time or has been submitted for postback. In the initial display, the form fields are assigned data values before being displayed. Otherwise if the form has been submitted for postback, the submitted data is processed based on the operation that was initiated upon submission. This property determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not. This property contains the name of the form submit button which was clicked to initiate postback. This property determines whether the data read operation can proceed or not. This is a boolean property whose value determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event. This property determines whether the form is to be shown or not.
Visible
Property
DataSource->SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form.
DataSource->Where
DataSource->CmdExecution This property determines whether or not the Insert, Update or Delete operation should proceed depending on the used BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete event.
Description
This variable determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this variable is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event. 92
blnEditMode<control name>
This variable specifies the mode in which a form currently is in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode.
blnFormSubmitted<control_name> This variable determines how a form is processed based on whether the form is being shown for the first time or has been submitted for postback. In the initial display, the form fields are assigned data values before being displayed. Otherwise if the form has been submitted for postback, the submitted data is processed based on the operation that was initiated upon submission. blnInsertAllowed<control name> blnReadAllowed<control name> blnUpdateAllowed<control name> This variable determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not. This variable determines whether data read operation can proceed or not. This is a boolean variable whose value determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. The value of this variable is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event. This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not. This variable contains any error messages generated during execution of the form. This variable indicates the operation to be performed based on the value of the submit button that was clicked to initiate postback. This variable contains the name of the form submit button which was clicked to initiate postback. This variable contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This variable contains the ORDER BY clause to be used in the SQL query executed for a query object (cfquery tag). This variable contains the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query to be used for a query object (cfquery tag). This variable contains the WHERE clause of the SQL query to be used for a query object (cfquery tag). This variable contains the query object associated with the form. This property determines whether or not the Insert, Update or Delete operation should proceed depending on the used BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete event.
strPressedButton strSQL
strOrder<control name> strSQL<control name> strWhere<control name> query<control name> endOperation<control name>
Method
isEditMode isAllowRead setAllowRead isAllowInsert setAllowInsert isAllowUpdate setAllowUpdate isAllowDelete setAllowDelete setRestricted getPageModel hasNextRow nextRow currentRow getChild getChildren getControl getFileUpload getButton getListBox getRadioButton
Description
Returns a value indicating whether Record form is in Edit mode. Returns a value indicating whether the data read operation can proceed or not. Use to toggle the value which determines whether the data read operations can proceed or not. Returns a value indicating whether the insert operation can proceed or not. Use to toggle the value which determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not. Returns a value indicating whether the update operation should proceed or not. Used to toggle the value which determines whether the update operation should proceed or not. Returns a value indicating whether the delete operation should proceed or not. Used to toggle the value which determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Get the page to which the component belongs Returns true if there are more elements in a collection Returns the next row. If the next row isn't available, this method returns an empty HashMap; This method never returns a null. Returns the current row. Specify a name to find a child control among the collection of children controls. Return all children controls of a collection. Specify a name to find a Control among the collection of controls. Specify a name to find a FileUpload control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Button control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Listbox control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Radiobutton control among the collection of children controls.
getCheckBoxList Specify a name to find a Checkbox List control among the collection of children controls. getLink getDatePicker isVisible setVisible isCmdExecution Specify a name to find a Link control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the form should be shown or not. Returns a value indicating whether the operation should proceed or not.
getParent
Property
<form name><control name>
Description
For each control that is located within the form, a protected member property is created with corresponding name. The collection of global critical errors, such as DataProvider errors. See the .NET Framework SDK reference. The Data Source Provider for the Record form. PlaceHolder object which holds all Record controls. Refer to .NET Framework SDK reference for more information.
System.Collections.Specialized.NameValueCollection <control name>Errors <control name>DataProvider <control name>Data System.Web.UI.WebControls.PlaceHolder <control name>Holder
Property
errors
Description
This property keeps a reference to the forms errors NameValueCollection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution.
<control name> For each control that is located within the form, a member property is created with the same name as the control. IsNew IsDeleted This property indicates if an item created based on an insert row. This property indicates if a record has been submitted for deletion.
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to the parameter source type) and parameter name (according to the parameter source). CmdExecution This property altered in BeforeExecuteInsert, BeforeExecuteUpdate or BeforeExecuteDelete events determines whether the Insert, Update or Delete operation (respectively) for the current row should proceed.
Methods (.NET)
Record Model Layer
Method
Description
CreateFromHttpRequest Returns an instance of an item whereby the values are initialized from Http request values. Validate Performs the item validation and returns true if validation is successful, otherwise false. 95
Method
InsertItem DeleteItem FillItem
Description
Performs the insert operation for each item in the items array. Performs the update operation for each item in the items array. Execute a query against the database and return the results in an items array.
UpdateItem Performs the update operation for each item in the items array.
See also
Record Form Overview
Report Reference
Design-Time Properties
Property
Name Connection Data Source Type Data Source Groups Restricted Page Size Limit Enable Print Mode Default View Mode
Description
The name of the form. The database connection from which information will be retrieved. The type of data source or the method used to retrieve the data. The database column, SQL Query or other expression from where the data will be retrieved. Report groups that is used to manage repeating values and totals. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. The maximum number of lines per page for Web view mode. Specify whether print mode can be enabled in runtime. Specify the default view mode, which will be used for report.
Lines per Web Page The size of page in the Web show mode, measured in lines.
Lines per Print Page The size of page in the Print view mode, measured in lines.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Select Before Show Before Build Select This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to select records from the database. This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database.
Description
Before Execute Select This event occurs immediately before a row selection query is executed but after the query has been composed. After Execute Select This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset for the result is returned.
Specify the default view mode, which will be used for report. Specify the page size for the print mode of report. Gets the current row number of report. Gets the current page number of report.
Property
DataSource.SQL
Description
This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query.
DataSource.Where This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource.SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form.
Description
Specify the type of component. Have value "Report" for Report component. Specify the name of report. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the form is to be shown or not. Gets the current page number of report. Specify the page size for the print mode of report. Specify the default view mode, which will be used for report. This property keeps a reference to the form's error collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the form's execution. This property stores a reference to data source bound to the form. The data source handles all data retrieval operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database table, SQL query or stored procedure.
Property
DataSource->CountSQL
Description
This property contains the SQL query which is executed to determine the total number of browseable rows in the Grid form. The number retrieved as a result of executing this query is used during the creation of the navigation controls for the form. This property contains the main portion of the SQL query used to retrieve the records displayed within the form. In terms of SQL, this property defines the SELECT and FROM clauses of the SQL query. This property contains the WHERE clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the form. The WHERE clause provides the criteria which filters the records retrieved. The value of this 97
DataSource->SQL
DataSource->Where
property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the form. DataSource->Order This property contains the ORDER BY clause portion of the SQL query used to retrieve records for the control. The ORDER BY clause determines the order of appearance of the retrieved records. The value of this property is appended to the value of the DataSource->SQL property to create the final SQL query which is executed against the datasource to retrieve the records for the control.
DataSource->RecordsCount This property contains a count of all the records that have been retrieved for the form.
Property
DataSource Groups TotalPages PageSizeLimit PageSize RowNumber ViewMode WebPageSize Report Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets the data source that provides data for populating the report. Gets the collection of grouping fields. Gets the number of pages in current report. Gets or sets the page size limit for print mode of report. Gets or sets the page size for the print mode of report. Gets the current row number of report. Gets or sets the view mode of report. Gets or sets the page size for the web mode of report.
PreviewPageNumber Gets or sets the page number for the web mode.
Property
errors
Description
This property keeps a reference to the forms errors NameValueCollection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution. For each control that is located within the form, a member property is created with the same name as the control.
<control name>
<field name>GroupField For each group of report, the member property is created. Report Data Provider
Property
Description
<prefix><parameter name> For each unique parameter of the Data Source command, a member property is created with the prefix (according to the parameter source type) and parameter name (according to the parameter source).
Description
Specify the default view mode, which will be used for report. 98
<control name>Items Array contains report lines. Each array item contains structure with current report elements. <control name>Item intPageSize intPage Structure with current report elements. Structure include key for each report control. Specify the page size for the print mode of report. Specify the page size for the print mode of report.
Description
Returns Report view mode. If print view mode is disabled Report.SHOW_MODE_WEB will always be returned. Set Report view mode. Returns the next Report row. Returns the ReportLabel component with specified name. Returns the number of the Report lines or zero if the Report is not populated with data. Returns the current report row number. Starting with one. Returns number of the report pages Returns the height of Report page in print view mode Sets the height of Report page in print view mode Returns the height of Report page in web view mode Sets the height of Report page in web view mode Get current Report page number. Get current Report detail row. Returns true if the specified control belongs to Detail row (Detail section); otherwise - false Returns true if print view mode is enabled for report component; otherwise false Returns int value of page size limit if viewMode is Report.VIEW_MODE_WEB; otherwise returns zero. Zero means that all records should be displayed. PageSizeLimit is applied to web mode only. Sets maximal allowed size of the Report page in the web view mode Get section with given name. Get the current page being shown in the Report. Set the page number to be shown in the Report. Get the total number of rows in the Report. Use a name to find the Navigator among the collection of children controls. Use a name to find a Sorter among the collection of children controls. Get number of records per page. 99
setPageSize isAllowRead setAllowRead isRestricted setRestricted getPageModel isProcessed hasNextRow getChild getChildren getControl getFileUpload getButton getListBox getRadioButton getCheckBoxList getLink getDatePicker isVisible setVisible getParent
Set number of records per page. Returns a value indicating whether the data read operation can proceed or not. Use to toggle the value which determines whether the data read operations can proceed or not. Returns a value indicating whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form. Get the page to which the component belongs. Indicates whether a component has been processed (the ccsForm parameter is equivalent to the name of the component). Returns true if there are more elements in a collection. Specify a name to find a child control among the collection of children controls. Return all children controls of a collection. Specify a name to find a Control among the collection of controls. Specify a name to find a FileUpload control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Button control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Listbox control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Radiobutton control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Checkbox List control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Link control among the collection of children controls. Specify a name to find a Date Picker control among the collection of children controls. Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the form should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains the form.
See also
Report Form Report Section Report Section Reference Report Label Reference
Property
Name
Description
The name of the control.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression, Special Value. Control Source Data Type Format Text if Empty Content DBFormat Hide Duplicates Function Reset At Percent Of Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Text to display, when the label's value is empty Specify whether the content of the control is plain text or HTML code. Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database. Specify if the duplicated values will be shown. Function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated Specify the group name, where value of control should be reseted Specify the dispalying of value as percentage of total value
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Show Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to change the value of the control.
Description
Description
Specify function for auto-calculated labels. Indicate that displaying report value is percentage of total value. Specify an text that will be displayed in case the label value is empty.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the control will be shown or not. Specify function for auto-calculated labels. Indicate that displaying report value is percentage of total value. Specify an text that will be displayed in case the label value is empty.
Methods (PHP)
101
Method
GetValue SetValue Reset
Description
Retrieves the value of the Label control. Sets the value of the Label control. Reset value of the total function.
Property
Visible Text Function ContentType DataType EmptyText Format PercentOf ResetAt Source SourceType Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets a value that indicates whether the control will be rendered on the page. Gets or sets the text for the ReportLabel. Gets or sets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated. Gets or sets the content type for the ReportLabel. Gets or sets the data type of the ReportLabel. Gets or sets the text to display when the label's value is empty. Gets or sets the format to be used when display label value. Gets or sets the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated. Gets or sets the section, where value of control should be reseted. Gets or sets the data source (field name or code expression). Gets or sets the data source type for the ReportLabel.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Description
Holds the value of the control.
hide<control name> This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.If the variable is set to true, the label will not be displayed.
Description
Gets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated. Sets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated.
getComputeAtFunction Gets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated relative value of the another group. setComputeAtFunction Sets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated relative value of the another group. getEmptyText setEmptyText Gets the text to display when the label's value is empty. Sets the text to display when the label's value is empty. 102
getComputeAt setComputeAt getResetAt setResetAt isHideDuplicates setHideDuplicates getPage getFormattedValue setFormattedValue getValue setValue hasErrors addError getErrorsAsString isVisible setVisible getParent isHtmlEncode setHtmlEncode
Gets the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated. Sets the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated. Gets the section, where value of control should be reseted. Sets the section, where value of control should be reseted. Returns if the duplicated values will be shown. Specify if the duplicated values will be shown. Get the page that contains this control. Get the value formatted according to the control format. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown or not. Specify whether this control or component should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control. Whether to encode control value before it is shown (so that html tags it may contain will be shown as is). Set whether to encode control value before it is shown (so that html tags it may contain will be shown as is).
See also
Report Form Report Sections Report Section Reference
Events
Event
Server Side Events 103
Description
This event occurs at the initialization of section. This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. This event occurs after section component's values calculation is performed.
Description
Specify if the Section will be displayed on the report. If the value is set to False the Section is not shown. Specify the height of the section.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the control will be shown or not. Specify height of section.
Property Description
Name Height Visible Gets or sets the name of the section. Gets or sets the height of section in lines. Gets or sets a value that indicates whether a server control is rendered as UI on the page.
Description
Returns a value indicating whether this control should be displayed or not. Specify whether the form should be shown or not. Gets the height of section in lines. Sets the height of section in lines.
See also
Report Form Report Sections Report Label Reference
Sorter Reference
Design-Time Properties
Setting
Name
Description
The name of the form. 104
Specify the field to be used to sort by. Optionally specify a field to be used to sort in the reverse order. [Yes/No] Specify whether the sorter should be displayed or not.
Events
Event
Server Side Events Before Show Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to influence the appearance of the Sorter.
Description
Description
This property determines whether the control is visible or not.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. This property determines whether the control is visible or not.
Description
Gets or sets the state of the sorter control. Gets or sets the name of database field on which the Sorter will operate.
Description
Whether this control should be shown. Specify whether this control or component should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control or component.
See also
Sorter Overview
Description
The name of the control. 105
Visible Caption
Specify whether the control should be displayed or not. The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Format Default Value Required Unique Input Validation Error Control Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. [Yes/No] Select 'Yes' if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. Select a regular expression to be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages pertaining to the control. If this value is not specified, all error messages are displayed at the top of the form in which the control is contained. Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not meet the validation rule. Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
Events
Event
Server Side Events On Validate Occurs after the control value have been submitted to the server and before the submitted value is used to update any database content. This event is meant to be used to specify any validation operations that should be run against the submitted value to ensure that the value is valid. The addErrors method of the form can be used to log an error if the validation check fails. Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to influence the visibility or appearance of the control or alter the value of the control. Occurs when the user presses an alphanumeric key within the control. Occurs after the control has been rendered to the page and before the user can perform any operations. This event can be used to bind validation rules to the control. 106
Description
Before Show
On Change
Description
An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property specifies a format to be applied to the value of the control. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. Holds the value of the control.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property specifies a format to be applied to the value of the control. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Format Visible
Property
Visible Text Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets a value that indicates whether the server control is to be rendered as UI on the page. Gets or sets the text for the TextArea control. See .NET Framework SDK reference.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the control. Sets the value for the control.
Description
Holds the value of the control.
hide<control name> This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.
Method
getPage setFormattedValue getValue setValue hasErrors addError getErrorsAsString isVisible setVisible getParent
Description
Get the page that contains this control. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown. Specify whether this control should be shown or not. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Text Area Overview
Description
The name of the control. Specify whether the control should be displayed or not. The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Control Source Type The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column, Code Expression. Control Source Data Type Format Default Value Required Unique Input Validation Error Control Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column. The type of data that will be contained in the control. Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data that will be contained in the control. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. [Yes/No] Select Yes if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. [Yes/No] Select Yes if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. Select or enter a regular expression to be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error messages 108
pertaining to the control. If this value is not specified, all error messages are displayed at the top of the form in which the control is contained. Validation Rule Validation Text DBFormat Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not satisfy the validation rule. Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
Events
Event
Server Side Events On Validate Occurs after the control value has been submitted to the server and before the submitted value is used to update any database content. This event is meant to be used to specify any validation operations that should be run against the submitted value to ensure that the value is valid. The addErrors method of the form can be used to log an error if the validation check fails. Occurs before the control is rendered to the page. This event can be used to influence the visibility or appearance of the control or alter the value of the control. Occurs when the user presses an alphanumeric key within the control. Occurs after the control has been rendered to the page and before the user can perform any operations. This event can be used to bind validation rules to the control. Occurs when the value of the control is changed.
Description
Before Show
On Change
Description
An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. This property specifies a format to be applied to the value of the control. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not. Holds the value of the control.
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. An object that contains the error messages generated during script execution when submitted data fails verification or any other user defined condition is not fulfilled. 109
Format Visible
This property specifies a format to be applied to the value of the control. This property determines whether the component is to be shown or not.
Property
Visible Text Model Layer
Description
Gets or sets a value that indicates whether the server control is to be rendered as UI on the page. Gets or sets the text for the TextBox control. See .NET Framework SDK reference.
Property
<control name>
Description
Contains the current value of the control.
Methods (PHP)
Method
GetValue SetValue
Description
Retrieves the value of the Text Box control. Sets the value for the Text Box control.
Description
Holds the value of the control.
hide<control name> This variable determines whether the control is to be shown or not.
Description
Get the page that contains this control. Use a String to set the control value. The value is taken as is i.e. formatting will not be applied to this value. Retrieves the value of the control without any formatting applied to it. This method sets the value of the control. Indicates whether the control has (validation) errors. Add an error description to the errors collection. Return a single String with all the error messages separated by <br> tags. Indicates whether this control should be shown. Specify whether this control should be shown. Get the parent component that contains this control.
See also
Text Box Overview 110
Properties
A-C
.NET Debug Mode Property
Specify whether the debug option is added to the compiler.
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
This property can be used to specify whether the debug option should be added to the compiler. Valid values are as follows: Debug: Disables optimizations and enables attaching a debugger to the running program. Release: Enables optimizations and emits general debugging information.
Applies to
Page
Description
This property specifies the page used instead of Login Page for the unauthorized users. Important: The value of this property is applied only if the value of the Restricted property is set to 'Yes'.
See also
Restricted property
Aliases Property
Specify if the display of database aliases is enabled during the design time.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify if the display of database aliases is enabled during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
You can set this property value to 'No' to disallow the insertion of new records using the Record or Editable Grid. The value of this property is set to 'Yes', if the Record was created using the Record 111
Builder, and 'Allow Insert' checkbox was checked on the 'Define Record Option' page of the Record Builder.
See also
Allow Delete property, Allow Update property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
You can set this property value to 'No' to disallow update the records using the Record or Editable Grid. The value of this property is set to 'Yes', if the Record is placed on the page using the Record Builder, and 'Allow Update' box is checked on 'Define Record Option' page of the Record Builder.
See also
Allow Delete property, Allow Insert property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
You can set this property value to 'No' to disallow the deletion of records using the Record or Editable Grid. The value of this property if set to 'Yes', if the Record is place on page by clicking on the Record Builder, and 'Allow Delete' checkbox is checked on the 'Define Record Option' page of the Record Builder.
See also
Allow Insert property, Allow Update property
Applies to
File Upload
Description
The property contains the semicolon-separated list of file masks for files that the user is allowed to upload e.g. *.jpg; *.png; *.gif; *.txt. By default, this property contains the "*" mask, i.e. all files are allowed.
See also
Disallowed File Masks property
Assemblies Property
Specify the semicolon-separated list of the used assemblies.
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
112
You can use this property to specify the semicolon-separated list of the assemblies linked to the project.
Applies to
Checkbox List, List Box, Radio Button
Description
If the Source Type property is set to Table/View, Procedure or SQL, use this property to specify the database field that will provide the List Box or Radio Button values to be submitted.
See also
Text Column property, Data Source Type property, Data Source property
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the boolean format of the data as it will appear in the database.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, DBFormat property
Caption Property
The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Applies to
Hidden, List Box, Checkbox List, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
This property is present in all form controls that are capable of submitting form values. If after submission it is determined that the control submitted an invalid value, an error message is displayed to indicate the problem. You can use this property to set a name that will be used to refer to the control within the error message. If a value is not specified for this control, the value of the Name property above is used by default. However, since control names are often cryptic by nature, it is advisable to set a more readable caption which will better help the user understand what the error message is referring to.
Catalog Property
Specify the Catalog for the database object display during the design time.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the Catalog for the database object display during the design time. It is used for MSSQL databases.
See Also
113
Applies to
Directory
Description
Specify the data field that contains category id of the first level categories.
See also
Data Source property, Subcategory ID Field property
Charset Property
Specify the name of the character set.
Applies to
ASP, PHP Projects
Description
Charset project property is used to define the response encoding to be used by the programs. Charset is deprecated starting with CCS 2.3 and will be removed in the next product release. When possible, set Charset property to empty (blank) and Use the 'Default HTML Encoding' project setting and META declarations within HTML pages instead.
Applies to
Checkbox
Description
The default HTML checkbox always submits a value of 'on' when the checkbox is checked. This property allows you to specify a different value to be associated with the checked state of the checkbox.
Examples
The Checkbox can be linked to a database field of the "Text" type which stores "Yes" and "No" values. To do that set the DataType property to "Text", and enter "Yes" for the Checked Value Property and "No" for the Unchecked Value property obligatory in double quotes. The following are the possible applications:
See also
DataType property, Unchecked Value property
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the list of libraries required for the project compilation. By default, if this property is blank, the value of the %CLASSPATH% environment variable is used otherwise the value is added to the classpath for the compilation. Class Path requirements: JSP
Servlet 2.2 & JSP 1.1 API library JAXP 1.0 library SAX 2.0 parser (such as crimson or xerces) JDBC 2.0 extensions library if you use Data Sources Extension Jakarta ORO if you use regexp for validations
Servlets with Templates Servlet 2.2 API library JDBC 2.0 extensions library if you want to use Data Sources Extension Jakarta ORO if you use regexp for validations
See Also
Use Data Source Extension property
Applies to
Project
Description
You can use this property to specify the programming language in which the project will be generated. You can always select other programming language for your, and all the project code will be regenerated in the new programming language besides the custom code of the events or properties.
Applies to
ASP Projects
Description
CodePage project property is deprecated starting with CCS 2.3, and will be removed in the next product release. Use the 'File Encoding' project setting instead.
See Also
Locale Identifier property
Applies to
115
ColdFusion Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the type of the ColdFusion Server. This property can take the following values:
Value
CF 4.01 prior to CFMX CFMX
Description
Specify if the ColdFusion Server version 4.01 is to be used Specify if the used ColdFusion Server version is higher than 4.01 but lower than CFMX Specify if the ColdFusion MX Server is to be used
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the connection cached option. The Connection Cached option is similar to an ordinary Connection, except that the returned database handle is also stored in a hash associated with the given parameters. If another call is made to connect_cached (the cached connection) with the same parameter values, then the corresponding cached $dbh (database handle) will be returned if it is still valid. The cached database handle is replaced with a new connection if it has been disconnected or if the ping method fails.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Connection Property
The database connection from where information will be retrieved.
Applies to
Checkbox List, Directory, Editable Grid, Grid, List Box, Radio Button, Record, Report, Path
Description:
You can use this property to specify a connection for retrieving control's data. You should specify the value of this property even if only one connection is used in the project. A List Box and Radio Button control are capable of containing values that are based on any existing connections within the project. A connection can be from the Record's one. For this reason, this property allows you to select the connection from where the List Box values will be retrieved.
See also:
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases,
Applies to
Connection
Description
116
You can use this property to specify ADO connection string or ODBC Data Source Name used for the database connection.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, Connection Type property
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the connection type which will be used, "Connection string" or "ODBC Data Source".
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, Connection String property
Content Property
The type of the content.
Applies to
Checkbox List, Label, Label (Report), Link, Radio Button
Description
The following are the Data options of the Content Property:
Setting Description
Text The control value is composed of plain text. All HTML tags are converted into the (default) corresponding escape (ESC) sequences. For example, ">" is converted into ">". Important: If the sourse text contains the line break symbol then it is converted into the "<br>" HTML tag. HTML The control value is composed of HTML markup. The source text is displayed without converting. If the source text contains the HTML tags, then they are dispayed by the browser as normal HTML.
Examples:
This following is an example of the Label outputs:
Result in browser
<font color='Red'>First line Second Line</font> First Line Second Line
HTML
Applies to
Java Projects 117
Description
You can use this property to specify the context path (including the leading slash) of the web application you are dealing with. It is used only if the target server is Tomcat.
See Also
Target Server property
Applies to
Checkbox, Checkbox List, File Upload, Hidden, Image, Image Link, Label, Link, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
The usage of this property depends on the value specified in the Source Type property. If the Source Type is Database Column, specify the database table column that will be used to furnish the control value. If the Source Type is Code Expression, enter the exact code expression to be used to supply the control value. If the Source Type is Special Value (for Calendar controls), the control value should be one of the following: NextProcessingDate, CurrentProcessingDate, PrevProcessingDate.
When using Control Source property within Reports please refer to Control Source property (Report).
See Also
Control Source Type property, Control Source Type property (Report), Control Source property (Report)
Applies to
Label (Report)
Description
This property depends on the value specified in the Source Type property. If the Source Type is a Database Column, use this property to specify the database table column that will be used to furnish the control value. Respectively, if the Source Type is a Code Expression, enter the exact code expression to be used to furnish the control value.
118
Examples: 1 assigns the value "1" to the control. now() assigns the current date and time to the control value. Special Value The control value should be one of the following: CurrentPage, TotalPages, RowNumber, CurrentDate, CurrentTime, CurrentDateTime
See Also
Applies to
Checkbox, Checkbox List, File Upload, Hidden, Image, Image Link, Label, Link, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
The type of data source from which the control gets its value. This can be one of the following:
Setting
Description
Database Column The control value will come from a column within a database table. (default) Datasource Parameter Code Expression This setting is available if the Source Type of a form is Stored Procedure. The control value is retrieved from the Data Source of a form. The supported parameters have either the InputOutput or Output return type. The control value will be derived from an expression specific to the particular programming language being used. This could be a function that returns a value, a pre-existing variable or any other valid language construct that will evaluate to a definite value. This option is available only for controls located inside the Calendar or Report components. For Report the Special Value is available only for the Label control, please see Control Source Type property (Report). For Calendar the Special Value is available for the simple controls (Label, Link, ImageLink, Image). The value of the Control Source property should be one of the following: NextProcessingDate, CurrentProcessingDate, PrevProcessingDate. The value differs depending on the location in the Calendar blocks. For example, if a control is located inside the main block of the Year Calendar, then NextProcessingDate will be equal to January 1 of the next year, CurrentProcessingDate will be equal to January 1 of the displayed year and PrevProcessingDate will be equal to January 1 of the previous year. If a control is located inside the Month calendar then NextProcessingDate will be equal to the 1 day of the next to the displayed month, etc. If a control is located inside the Day block in any calendar then 119
Special Value
NextProcessingDate will be equal to the next date of the current month , CurrentProcessingDate will be equal to current date of the month, etc. This type is applicable to the controls used to display Date (if the Data Type property is equal to Date).
See Also
Control Source property, Control Source property (Report), Control Source Type property (Report), Data Source property, Data Type property
Applies to
Label (Report)
Description
This property depends on the value specified in the Source Type property. If the Source Type is a Database Column, use this property to specify the database table column that will be used to furnish the control value. Respectively, if the Source Type is a Code Expression, enter the exact code expression to be used to furnish the control value.
See Also
Applies to
Button, Editable Grid, Image Link, Link, Record
Description
The following are the possible value: 120
Setting Description
None The URL is not converted. (default) Absolute The URL is converted into the absolute URL based on 'Server URL' set in the Project Settings. SSL The URL is converted into the SSL based on 'Server URL' set in the Project Settings.
Example
For example, the page has a name name = 'my_page.asp', and 'Server URL' is set as 'www.domain.com/my_project/'.
Control Property
Specify the name of a control to be used for return of the selected date.
Applies to
Date Picker
Description
Specify the name of a control, usually the Text Box in which the selected date of the Date picker is returned. The date for this control will be returned in the format set in the Format property. If the Format property is not defined then the date is returned in the format set in the Default Date Format property for the project. Important: The Text Box used as a control should be obligatory placed inside the Record or Editable Grid, in which the Date Picker is located.
See Also
Format property, Default Date Format property
Control Properties
This section examines the properties for the various controls found under the Control tab of the Toolbox. Many of the Controls share similar properties and the tale below presents all the possible properties in alphabetic order. The third column indicates the controls that possess the property.
Property
Bound Column
Description
Each option in a ListBox or RadioButton control is represented by a pair of values whereby one value is displayed to the user and another is submitted. Bound Column refers to the data source for the values that are submitted. The name used to refer to the control in an error message.
Applicable Controls
ListBox, RadioButton
Caption
121
RadioButton, Hidden Checked Value Column Connection Control Source The value submitted by a Checkbox Control when it is checked. For a Sorter control, this specifies the Grid column that the sorter applies. Checkbox Sorter
The database connection from where information will be retrieved. ListBox, RadioButton Specify the source of data for the control e.g. the name of a database column TextBox, TextArea, ListBox, Checkbox, RadioButton, Label, Image, Hidden, Link, ImageLink
Convert URL Specify whether the URL should be converted to an absolute URL Button, To or a secure (https://) URL. ImageLink, Link Data Type The type of data that will be contained in the control: Text Integer Float Date Boolean Memo Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database e.g. the user may enter a date value in one format but you want it to be entered into the database in a different format. [Yes/No] If you select Yes' the button will be the default button on the form so that clicking on the Enter key will be equivalent to clicking on the button. Specify a default value to be used for the control if no value is otherwise specified. TextBox, TextArea, Checkbox, RadioButton, ListBox, Label, Hidden, Link, ImageLink TextBox, TextArea, Label, Hidden Button
DBFormat
TextBox, TextArea, Checkbox, RadioButton, ListBox, Label, Image, Hidden, Link, ImageLink Button
Enable
Validation
button is clicked.
Error Control Specify the name of a control that will be used to display any error TextBox, messages pertaining to the TextArea, Checkbox, RadioButton, ListBox, Hidden Format Depending on the Data Type property, select the format of the data to be contained in the control. TextBox, TextArea, Label, Hidden, Link, ImageLink ImageLink ImageLink, Link
The page path, database column or other expression containing the URL of the hyperlink. The type of source where the URL value will come from. [Text/HTML] If 'Text' is selected, All HTML tags are converted into the corresponding escape (ESC) sequences. For example, ">" is converted into ">".
Checkbox List, Label, Link, If 'HTML' is selected, the control value will not be converted to text Radio Button before being displayed. As such, if the value is HTML markup, it will be appear as regular HTML markup on the page. Select a regular expression to be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control. Specify the actual source of data for the list of values depending on the List Source Type. TextBox, Hidden ListBox, RadioButton
Input Verification List Data Source List Source Type Name Operation Page Links Preserve Parameters Remove Parameters Required
Specify the type of source of data for the list of values to be shown ListBox, in the control e.g. the name of a database column. RadioButton The name of the control. ALL The type of operation performed when the button is clicked [Insert, Button Update, Delete, Cancel or Search] Specify the number of page links to be shown on the Navigator. The default is 10. Specify whether GET or Post parameters should be preserved. Specify a semicolon-separated list of parameters that should be removed from the hyperlink. [Yes/No] Select Yes' if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully. Navigator ImageLink, Link ImageLink, Link TextBox, TextArea, RadioButton, ListBox Button
Return Page
Specify the page where the user should be directed after the button operation has been performed. 123
Source Type
The type of data source that will provide data for the control: Database Column Code Expression
TextBox, TextArea, ListBox, Checkbox, RadioButton, Label, Image, Hidden, Link, ImageLink Link
Href Source
This opens the Href Source window where you can specify the page to be linked to as well as any parameters that should be transmitted via the URL.
Text Column
Each option in a ListBox or RadioButton control is represented by Listbox, a pair of values whereby one value is displayed to the user and RadioButton another is submitted. Text Column refers to the data source for the values that are displayed. Select the type of page links to be shown in the Navigator control. Navigator The value submitted by a Checkbox Control when it is unchecked. Checkbox [Yes/No] Select Yes' if you want a check to be made to ensure that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database. TextBox, TextArea, RadioButton, ListBox, Hidden TextBox, TextArea, Checkbox, RadioButton, ListBox, Hidden TextBox, TextArea, Checkbox, RadioButton, ListBox, Hidden
Validation Rule
Specify an expression that will be used to check the validity of the data entered in the control.
Validation Text
Specify the text that will be displayed if the data entered in the control does not meet the validation rule.
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
Specify whether CCS will automatically create IIS Application during publishing.
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
Clicking on this property opens the Custom Delete window where you can specify the table, enter the procedure with required parameters or SQL statement based on the Custom Delete Type property used to perform the Delete operation.
See Also
Custom Delete Type property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
If you wish to override the default delete mechanism, you can specify the type of method to be used to perform the delete operation. The list of available types: Table Procedure SQL Important: If you set any value in this property you should specify the Custom Delete property, otherwise the Delete operation will not be performed.
See Also
Custom Delete property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
This property opens a dialog where you can specify the table, procedure or SQL statement to be used for inserting data submitted via the form. This method can be used when the standard insert functionality based on the form's data source is insufficient. For example you may not want to insert all fields, or replace field values submitted by the form. The main part of the Custom Insert dialog is the Parameters section where you configure parameters that construct the SQL query statement, or variables used in custom SQL statement, or Stored Procedure parameters. To open the parameter configuration dialog click the plus button ([+]) or double click an existing parameter. Parameter configuration for Table based custom insert: When using Table type custom insert the following parameter dialog will appear:
125
Field
Name Type Format Provide the name of the data field you want to insert a value into. Select the type of the data field. Specify data field's format. Designate a parameter whose value will be assigned to the data field. Select parameter type. Specify parameter format. Parameter is considered empty when parameter source collection does not contain corresponding item. This may happen, for example, when the parameter is not submitted by the form or if the code expression it is based on returns a null value. Do not insert field Use value If parameter value is empty the corresponding field won't be inserted (won't be included into the SQL INSERT statement). If parameter value is empty the specified value will be used.
Parameter
Name Type Format
If parameter is empty
Parameter configuration for SQL based custom insert: When configuring custom insert property you may specify your own SQL INSERT statement to be executed after the form is submitted. The SQL statement can include variables in curly braces, such as {variable_name}, which will be replaced at run-time by the corresponding parameter that you must configure with the same name as each variable used in the SQL statement. For example if an SQL statement is INSERT INTO departments(department_name) VALUES('{name}') , then the corresponding name parameter must be created and configured. To open the parameter configuration dialog click the plus button ([+]) or double click an existing parameter. The following SQL parameter configuration values are available:
126
Field
Name Type Format Provide the name of the data field you want to insert a value into. Select the type of the data field. Specify data field format. Designate a parameter whose value will be assigned to the data field. Select parameter type. Specify parameter format.
Parameter
Name Type Format
Default Value The default value to be used if parameter value is empty. Parameter configuration for Stored Procedure based custom insert: Parameter configuration options are similar to the above SQL parameters except for additional properties, such as Data Size, Direction, Scale and Precision. Those additional options corresponds to the stored procedure parameters within your database.
See Also
Custom Insert Type property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
If you wish to override the default insert mechanism, you can specify the type of method to be used to perform the Insert operation. The list of available types: Table Procedure SQL Important: If you set any value for this property you should also set the Custom Insert property, otherwise the Insert operation will not be performed.
See Also
Custom Insert property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
This property opens a dialog where you can specify the table, procedure or SQL statement to be used for updating data submitted via the form. This method can be used when the standard update 127
functionality based on the form's data source is insufficient. For example you may not want to update all fields, or replace field values submitted by the form. The main section of the Custom Update dialog contains parameters that construct the SQL query statement, variables used in custom SQL statement, or Stored Procedure parameters. To open the parameter configuration dialog click the plus button ([+]) or double click an existing parameter.
Field
Name Type Format The name of the data field to be updated. The type of the data field. The format of the data field. Designate a parameter whose value will be assigned to the data field. Select parameter type. Specify parameter format. Parameter is considered empty when parameter source collection does not contain corresponding item. This may happen, for example, when the parameter is not submitted by the form or if the code expression it is based on returns a null value. Do not update field If parameter value is empty the corresponding field won't be included into the SQL UPDATE statement.
Parameter
Name Type Format
If parameter is empty
Use value If parameter value is empty the specified value will be used during update. Parameter configuration for SQL based custom update: When configuring custom update property you may specify your own SQL UPDATE statement to be executed after the form is submitted. The SQL statement can include variables in curly braces, such as {variable_name}, which will be replaced at run-time by the corresponding parameter that you must configure with the same name as each variable used in the SQL statement. For example if an SQL statement is UPDATE employees SET emp_name='{name}' , then the 128
corresponding name parameter must be created and configured. To open the parameter configuration dialog click the plus button ([+]) or double click an existing parameter. The following SQL update parameter configuration values are available:
Field
Name Type Format The name of the data field to be updated. The type of the data field. The format of the data field. Designate a parameter whose value will be assigned to the data field. Select parameter type. Specify parameter format. Parameter is considered empty when parameter source collection does not contain corresponding item. This may happen, for example, when the parameter is not submitted by the form or if the code expression it is based on returns a null value. Do not update field If parameter value is empty the corresponding field won't be included into the SQL UPDATE statement.
Parameter
Name Type Format
If parameter is empty
Use value If parameter value is empty the specified value will be used during update. Parameter configuration for Stored Procedure based custom update: Parameter configuration options are similar to the above SQL parameters except for additional properties, such as Data Size, Direction, Scale and Precision. Those additional options corresponds to the stored procedure parameters within your database.
See Also
Custom Update Type property
Applies to
Record, Editable Grid
Description
If you wish to override the default update mechanism, you can specify the type of method to be used to perform the Update operation for this property. The list of available types: Table Procedure SQL Important: If you set any value for this property the Custom Update property should be also set, otherwise the Update operation will not be performed. 129
See Also
Custom Update property
D-I
Data Source Property
Specify the actual source of data for the list of values depending on the Source Type.
Applies to
Checkbox List, Directory, Editable Grid, Grid, List Box, Record, Report, Path, Radio Button
Description
This property depends on the selection made in the Source Type property. If you selected a Table/View, use this property to specify the table or view from where the List Box values will be retrieved. If you selected a Procedure, specify the procedure to be used and likewise if you selected SQL, enter the SQL statement. Lastly, if you selected ListOfValues, enter the semicolon delimited list of pairs.
See Also
Data Source Type property, Text Column property, Bound Column property
Applies to
Checkbox List, Directory, Editable Grid, Grid, List Box, Record, Radio Button, Path
Description
The type of data source from which the control gets its value. This can be one of the following:
Setting
Table/View (default) Procedure
Description
This is the most common method whereby the values come from a database table. This option allows you to specify a procedure to be used to provide the values. Bear in mind that List Box values come in pairs.The first value is the value submitted by the control and the second is the value displayed to the user. With this option you can specify an SQL query to be used to provide the value. Again, bear in mind that List Box values come in pairs. This option allows you to specify a static set of values for the List Box. The values should be in a semicolon delimited list of the form. The first value is the value that would be submitted by the control while the second would be displayed e.g. 1;Yes;2;No;3;Neutral.
SQL ListOfValues (for the List Box and Radio Button only)
See Also
Data Type property, Data Source property, Text Column property, Bound Column property
Applies to
Checkbox, Checkbox List, Hidden, Image, Image Link, Label, Label(Report), Link, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box 130
Description
Specify the type of data that will be contained in the control: Text Integer Float Date Boolean Memo Since Text Area fields are often used in conjunction with database fields that contain large amounts of data such as MS Access Memo fields, the Data Type property is usually set to 'Memo' instead of 'Text' to accommodate the special requirements of dealing with large amounts of data.
See Also
Format property, DBFormat property
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the pointing URL to the database to which the connection is established (e.g., jdbc.odbc:intranet).
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Calendar
Description
You can use this property to specify the database format of the field containing event date.
See also
Applies to
Calendar
Description
You can use this property to specify the field containing event date. This field must contain valid date value and it cannot be NULL. Date can be full date (date and time) or only date. In the latter case you also need to specify the Time Field property).
See also
131
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the format of the data as it appears in the database for the whole project. Some databases such as MySQL and PostgreSQL are particular about the format used, so this property should be set to correspond to the format of the value as contained within the database. Note: You can redefine the date format for controls using the DBFormat property.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, Date/Time Format property, DBFormat property
DBFormat Property
Specify the format in which you want the control value to be entered into the database.
Applies to
Hidden, Image, Image Link, Label, Label (Report), Link, Text Area, Text Box
Description
This property specifies the format of the data as it appears in the database. The DBFormat property determines the format that will be used to extract as well as place the control value into the database. Some databases such as MySQL and PostgreSQL are particular about the format used so this property should be set to correspond to the format of the value as contained within the database. Note: The Format property can be used to display the control value in a format different from the database format. See also: Data Type property, Format property
Applies to
Project
Description
You can use this property to select the format in which you want boolean values to be displayed in the project.
Applies to
Button 132
Description
If you select 'Yes' the button will be the default button on the form so that clicking on the Enter key will be equivalent to clicking on the button. This property is applicable if you use the Microsoft Internet Explorer and if there is only one field on the form that could be associated with the Enter key hit. This property can be also used if the form is submitted by the DHTML method form.submit().
Applies to
Project
Description
You can use this property to select the format in which you want date values to be displayed in the project. If the Default Date Format is not specified, the standard mechanism of the programming language is applied to convert the date to string. The results can differ depending on the used language pattern and local settings.
Applies to
Checkbox Checkbox List, Hidden, Image, Label, Link, Image Link, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
If specified, the default value will be assigned to the control in case the Control Source property does not yield any value. The default property can be a literal such as a string e.g. "Default Value" or it could be a numeral as an integer or it could be a language function e.g. functionName(). The Default Value is a Code Expression returning a value of the corresponding type (Text -> String, Integer -> Int, Long, etc.) or being brought to a certain type. Important: If the value of the Data Type property is set to "Text" or "Memo" the value of Default Value property should be entered in double quotes, besides the cases of using the language function. The following are the possible values:
See Also
Control Source property, Data Type property
Specify the default view mode, which will be used for report
Applies to
Report
Description
The Report component supports two display modes: Print and Web. In Web mode the report contains navigation links or buttons that users can click to navigate through multiple report pages. In Print mode all report pages are shown at once in the Web browser, however, report pages are separated by invisible page break tags that result in page breaks between printed pages when a user prints the report.
Applies to
Editable Grid
Description
You can use this property to specify the control value used as a deletion indicator for the rows of the Editable Grid. When the Editable Grid is submitted all rows for which the control value is not empty will be deleted. Checkbox or hidden can be used as the Delete control. This property is not required. If the value of this property is not set, the DELETE operation is not performed. The Delete Control is shown only if rows with records exist.
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify how the application will published to the folder. It has the following two options: "as war file" - the standard WAR will be generated. This options works almost with all modern application servers and handy with auto-deployment feature of several servers (see deployment scenarios below). "unpacked" - the application will be published to folder unpacked. This option is helpful for changes in one JSP page and its quick publish (when only one page is published). Some older servers (that do not support WAR archive files) may need this options too.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the type of a database which is being accessed during design time. If your database type is not listed, you may select the 'ANSI SQL-92' option.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
134
Applies to
File Upload
Description
The property contains the semicolon-separated list of file masks for files that the user is not allowed to upload e.g. *.exe; *.dll; *.bat. The validation of the disallowed file masks is applied if the file contains any of the allowed file masks.
See also
Allowed File Masks property
Applies to
ASP Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the COM based components used by the Send Email action. The CDONTS.NewMail supports only local SMTP servers. It is also no longer shipped with Windows XP or Windows Server 2003. For Windows 2000 or above you can use CDO.Message. Unlike CDONTS.NewMail it can be configured for a remote SMTP server.
See Also
Send Email action
EmptyRows Property
Specify the number of rows to be added on the Editable Grid.
Applies to
Editable Grid
Description
You can use this property to specify the number of rows to be added to the bottom of the Editable Grid table. This value is set to 3 by default. If the Allow Insert property is "No", the rows for the new records are not displayed.
See Also
Allow Insert property
Applies to
Calendar
Description
Enabling this feature provides more consistent layout for the multi-month calendar views since all months will be shown with 6 weekly rows.
135
Applies to
Report
Applies to
Button
Description
You can set this property to 'Yes' so that submitted values are check for validity, otherwise the form will not check to ensure that the submitted values conform to the validation rules assigned to them. By default this property is set to 'Yes' for the 'Insert' and 'Update' buttons and 'No' for the 'Cancel' and 'Delete' buttons. Important: If buttons are added by clicking on the button in the Forms tab of the Toolbox, the value of this property is set to 'Yes'.
Applies to
PHP Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify which of the PHP extension modules is to be used for encoding conversion. This property can take the following values:
Value Description
iconv mb Specify if the iconv function of the iconv Extension should be used Specify if the mb_convert_encoding function of the Multibyte string module should be used
Applies to
Checkbox, Checkbox List, Hidden, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
Usually, error messages corresponding to a control are displayed at the top of the form as plain text. However, you might want this error text to be displayed within another existing control, for instance, in a Label field placed adjacent to the control. Use this property to specify the name of a control where you want the error message for the current control to be displayed. Important: The Label used as an Error control should be obligatory placed inside the Record or Editable Grid form. This Property is applied only if the control is located inside the Record or Editable Grid form.
Specifies the target path used for storing uploaded file after processing.
Applies to
File Upload
Description
The property specifies the full path or the relative path to the target folder beginning from the current page folder. If the property value starts with "%", the environment variable specifies the path to the temporary folder. If the language doesn't have functions for loading the environment variable content, the following error message is shown: Invalid value of the File Folder property.
Applies to
File Upload
Description
The property contains the numeric value of the maximum allowed file size in bytes for uploading.
Applies to
ASP Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the COM based components used by the File Upload control.
See Also
File Upload control
Format Property
Number Format
Sign
0 # . , % \c ;
Description
Digit placeholder with fixed length
Example
Number
Result
(000) 000-00-00 121231212 (012) 123-12-12 123.1 123.1 1234.1 0.123 10.1 -1.45 100.01 123.10 123.10 1,234.10 12.3% #10 <font color="Red">1.45</font> <font color="Red">100.01</font>
Digit placeholder. Insignificant #.00 zeros are not displayed. Decimal separator. Group separator. Percent notation literal character "c" Section separator. #.00 #,###.00 #.#% \#0
[Color] Specifies the color that will be #.#;[Red]#.# used for output. {} Condition formatting. {$ > 10}[Red]#.#;#.# 137
Represent the name of the variable that will be used in the code. E.g. the condition {$ > 10} specifies that the current mask will be applied only when the amount is greater than 10.
Sections
The number formatting mask consists of four predefined sections.
positive number format;negative number format;zero number format;Null number format;decimal separator;group separator
The default values for decimal separator and for the group separator will be taken from the regional settigns in case the programming language supports the localized output of numbers. If the group separator was not presented in the mask then the number would not be devided at the groups. If the decimal separator not presented then will be displayed only the integer part of number.
Condition formatting
You may use the condition formatting if want to specify the exact format for the range. Use the {} in order to specify the condition that will be used for this mask. Note that in the condition you may use the language specific operators and functions and the condition is not language independed. If you have the masks with condition and without them then the first mask without condition is used for default formatting for positive numbers, second mask without condition is used for for default formatting of the negative numbers. If more than one mask can be applied then the leftmost mask with condition will be applied.
Examples
Mask Numbers Results
<font color="Red">10.01</font> 5 (20) {$ > 10}[Red]#.#;{0 =< $ < 10}#.#;{$ < 0}(#.#) 10.01 5 -20 Using Date Format concept You can use different languages, databases and platforms that return and require different date formats. Some of languages do not the have predefined functions that allow work with Date (e.g. PHP or Perl). For such languages CodeCharge supports the custom functions based on the language functionality (e.g. Java or C#). You can use the Date Format Compare table to see how CC converts formats. For example, Java does not support the short month name and uses the full name of the month. Date Format table shows CodeCharge formats. You do not need to support the Date functionality in your code, you should set the properties:
Property
DBDateFormat Field Format
Description
Specify the format in which the control value will be entered into the database. Set this property if you want to change default Date format
Later you can change the language, database or platform modifying the following parameters. You do not need to change the code. 138
See Also
Date Format, Date Format Compare Date/Time Format You can set the Format property using the predefined date and time formats or use the custom formats for the Date/Time data type setting.
Setting
GeneralDate
Description
This format depends from regional settings. If the value is a date only, no time is displayed; if the value is a time only, no date is displayed. This setting is a combination of the Short Date and Long Time settings. Examples: 4/3/93, 05:34:00 PM, and 4/3/93 05:34:00 PM.
LongDate
This format depends from regional settings. Example: Saturday, April 3, 1993.
ShortDate
This format depends from regional settings. Example: 4/3/93. Warning: The Short Date setting assumes that dates between 1/1/00 and 12/31/29 are twenty-first century dates (that is, the years are assumed to be 2000 to 2029). Dates between 1/1/30 and 12/31/99 are assumed to be twentieth century dates (that is, the years are assumed to be 1930 to 1999).
LongTime
ShortTime
Warning: Predefined Formats are valid only for languages which have the ability to formatting the date in corresponding of the current LCID (ASP, Java). In the other languages this formats will be equal to the standard US Date/Time formats.
Custom Formats
You can create custom date and time formats by using the following symbols.
Symbol
d dd ddd dddd w m mm mmm
Description
Day of the month in one or two numeric digits, as needed (1 to 31). Day of the month in two numeric digits (01 to 31). First three letters of the weekday (Sun to Sat). Full name of the weekday (Sunday to Saturday). Day of the week (1 to 7). Month of the year in one or two numeric digits, as needed (1 to 12). Month of the year in two numeric digits (01 to 12). First three letters of the month (Jan to Dec). 139
Full name of the month (January to December). Date displayed as the quarter of the year (1 to 4). This format is supported only in ASP, PHP and Perl. Last two digits of the year (01 to 99). Full year (0100 to 9999). 12-hour format without leading zeros (1 to 12). 12-hour format with leading zeros (01 to 12). Hour in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 23). Hour in two digits (0 to 23). Minute in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 59). Minute in two digits (00 to 59). Second in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 59). Second in two digits (00 to 59). Twelve-hour clock with the uppercase letters "AM" or "PM", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the lowercase letters "am" or "pm", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the uppercase letter "A" or "P", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the lowercase letter "a" or "p", as appropriate. Week of the year (1 to 53). The first week considered the week which has January 1. Note: This parameter is not supported in .NET.
Example
The following are examples of custom date/time formats.
Setting
mmmm dd, yyyy dddd
Display
June 02, 1997 Tuesday
See Also
Date Format Compare, Date format using concept Date Formats Comparison
CCS
PHP Description
General date predefined format Short Date predefined format. Long Date predefined format. Short Time predefined format. Long Time predefined format.
f F g B r, R m, M s u r
Full date and time predefined format (long date and short time) Full date and time predefined format (long date and long time) General date predefined format (short date and short time) Swatch Internet time RFC 1123(822) formatted date; i.e. "Thu, 21 Dec 2000 16:01:07 +0200" Month and Day predefined format Sortable Date and Time predefined format (ISO 8601) using local time Universal Sortable Date and Time predefined format (ISO 8601) using universal time Sortable date and time (long date and long time) using universal time Year and month predefined format (yyyy MMMM) j d D Day of the month in one or two numeric digits, as needed (1 to 31). Day of the month in two numeric digits (01 to 31). First three letters of the weekday (Sun to Sat). Full name of the weekday (Sunday to Saturday). w l Day of the week. (lowercase "L") Full name of the weekday (Sunday to Saturday). Day of the year (0 to 365) Month of the year in one or two numeric digits, as needed (1 to 12). Two numeric digits (01 to 12) of Month of the Year. First three letters of the month (Jan to Dec). Full name of the month (January to December).
U y, Y
Days
d dd ddd dddd w d dd ddd dddd w d dd EE d dd ddd d dd ddd dddd
EEEE dddd
z n m M
Months
m mm mmm mmmm m mm mmm mmmm
MMMM F
Years
141
yy yyyy
yy yyyy
yy yyyy
yy yyyy
yy yyyy y
y Y
Last two digits of the year (01 to 99). Full year (0100 to 9999). The two last digits of the year without the leading zero (1 to 99).
Hours
H HH h hh h hh H HH K KK n nn s ss m mm s ss S SS H HH h hh m mm s ss H HH h hh m mm s ss s i G H g h Hour in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 23). Hour in two digits (00 to 23). Hour in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 11). Hour in two digits (00 to 11). Minute in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 59). Minute in two digits (00 to 59). Second in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 59). Second in two digits (00 to 59). Milisecond in one or two digits, as needed (0 to 99). Milisecond in two digits (00 to 99). tt tt A Twelve-hour clock with the uppercase letters "AM" or "PM", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the lowercase letters "am" or "pm", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the uppercase letter "A" or "P", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the lowercase letter "a" or "p", as appropriate. Twelve-hour clock with the appropriate morning/afternoon designator based on current regional settings. z 142 The time zone offset (hour only).
Minutes
n nn
Seconds
s ss
Milliseconds
Other
AM/PM AM/PM h/k + a
am/pm
am/pm
A/P
A/P
a/p
a/p
AMPM
Single-digit hours will not have a leading zero. zz The time zone offset (hour only). Single-digit hours will have a leading zero. The full time zone offset (hour and minutes). Single-digit hours and minutes will have leading zeros. L t z T U Z boolean for whether it is a leap year; i.e. "0" or "1" number of days in the given month; i.e. "28" to "31" Timezone setting of this machine; i.e. "MDT" seconds since the epoch timezone offset in seconds (i.e. "43200" to "43200"). The offset for timezones west of UTC is always negative, and for those east of UTC is always positive. (capital i) 1 if Daylight Savings Time, "0" otherwise. English ordinal suffix, textual, 2 characters; i.e. "th", "nd" Escape for text (Delimiter), e.g. 'on' MMM dd means "on July 25" Time zone, full form e.g. "Pacific Standard Time" Week in month (1-4) Day of week in month e.g. 2 (2nd Wed in July) gg gg : / Era designator e.g. AD Time separator (taken from the Regional settings) Date separator (taken from the Regional settings) Week of the year (1 to 53). The first week considered the week which has January 1. Note: This parameter is not supported in .NET. Date displayed as the quarter of the year (1 to 4). This format is supported only in ASP, PHP and 143
zzz
CCS
PHP Description
See Also
Date Format, Date format using concept
Function Property
Specify the function for auto-calculated labels.
Applies to
ReportLabel
Description
This property is used to specify function for auto-calculated labels. This can be one of the following:
Setting Description
(none) Sum Count No function will be used. The report label value will be calculated as the sum of previous row values. If the Control Source is empty the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows. Otherwise the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows with nonempty values. The value will be calculated as the minimum of previous row values. The value will be calculated as the maximum of previous row values.
Min Max
Average The value will be calculated as the average of non-empty values from previous rows.
See Also
Reset At property Percent Of property
Groups Property
Report groups that is used to manage repeating values and totals
Applies to
Report
Description
The list of report groupings and sections. Click the [...] button to maintain the report groups or view its sections. When report groups are used, the data rows will be grouped into collections with the same value of the grouped field in each collection. Each group also has a unique name, associated group field, and the data sort order.
Height Property
The height of the section in abstract "line" units.
Applies to
Section 144
Description
The height can be equivalent to pixels or other units, as long as consistent units are used throughout the report. You can imagine that a line is 1 pixel high and specify the true pixel height, if known. In other cases you may decide to use data rows as a "line" and specify "1" as the section height. Refer to report properties for more information.
Applies to
ReportLabel
Description
This property can be used to hide report labels when their value is the same as in the preceding record.
Applies to
Project
Description
You can use this property to set starting page for your project.
Applies to
Link, Image Link
Description
The selection made in this property depends on the value of the Href Type property. If the Href Type is a page, use this property to select the page to be linked to. Alternatively, if the Href Type is a database column, use this property to select the database column that holds the URL of the page to be linked to. Clicking on this property opens the Href Source window where you can also specify Link Parameters that will be transmitted to the linked page. This is often used when linking a grid form to a record form and a parameter needs to be transferred to the record form to indicate the record that will be retrieved.
See Also
Href Type property, how to Create Mailto Hyperlink, how to Configure Hyperlink
Applies to
Image Link, Link
Description
Indicate whether the value of the page to be linked to will come from: 145
Setting
Page (default)
Description
One of the existing project pages
Database The URL of the page to be linked to is contained within a database column
See Also
Href Source property
Includable Property
Specify if the page is included into other pages.
Applies to
Page
Description
You can set this property to 'Yes' to specify that the page is not used separately, it is used only an includable to other pages. The following HTML tags are excluded from these pages: <HTML><HEAD><BODY>. This page cannot be accessed regularly, it can be only included into other pages. For Header and Footer pages this property is always set to 'Yes'.
See Also
Page property
Applies to
ASP Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the type of the path used to include the common files: relative or absolute (starting from the root) virtual path.
ID Field Property
Specify the field containing the unique ID that identifies the categories.
Applies to
Path
Description
Specify the field containing the unique ID that identifies the categories. This field must contain a unique value and the value cannot be NULL.
See also
Parent field property
Applies to
PHP Projects 146
Description
If this property is set to 'Yes' then all HTTP headers which disable browser caching will be removed.
Applies to
Hidden, Text Area, Text Box
Description
In this property, you can enter a Regular Expression that will be used to determine the validity of a submitted value. A submitted value that fails to comply with the regular expression will cause an error message to be displayed. Within the property, there are two regular expressions; one for validating email addresses and another for 5-digit zip codes. Besides these, you can type in your own regular expression. Important: The regular expressions should be set taking into consideration the programming language.
J-P
JDBC Driver Property
Specify the name of the driver to be used.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the name of the driver to be used, (e.g., sun.jdbc.odbc.JdbcOdbcDriver).
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the level of logging. The DEBUG will display all messages.
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can specify this property if you use mod_perl.
147
Setting this property will add the appropriate prefix to all classes/packages. For example, the record form's clsUsers class on Page1 will have the following full name: pagePrefix::Page1::clsUsers.
Server API
CGI mod_perl
Property Value
Specify the unique prefix for the server. If the prefix is not used leave this property blank. Specify the unique prefix for the server. If you leave this property blank the project's name will be used as the prefix.
Applies to
Report
Description
In Print mode the "Lines per Print page" value is used to determine where to end the page and show the page footer and the page break tag.
See also
Lines Per Web Page property
Applies to
Report
Description
In Web mode the "Lines per Web page" value is used to determine where to end the page and display the page footer and the navigator.
See also
Lines Per Print Page property
Applies to
ASP Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the locale ID. It determines the formatting of certain information, such as date and time values, currency, and so on. Each locale is identified by an integer value and its defined in the operating system.
See Also
Code Page property
Login Property
Specify the Login used to establish a database connection. 148
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify Login used to establish a database connection during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
LongReadLen Property
Specify the DBI LongReadLen attribute.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to control the maximum length of long fields ('blob', 'memo', etc.) which the driver will read from the database automatically when it fetches each row of data. The LongReadLen attribute only relates to fetching and reading long values; it is not involved in inserting or updating them.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, LongTruncOk property
LongTruncOk Property
Specify the DBI LongReadLen attribute.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to control the effect of fetching a long field value which has been truncated (typically because it's longer than the value of the LongReadLen attribute). For example, if LongTruncOk is set to "Yes" the over-long value will be silently truncated to the length specified by LongReadLen without an error.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, LongReadLen property
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the connection login for the Tomcat application manager. It is used only if the target server is Tomcat.
See Also
Target Server property
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the connection password for the Tomcat application manager. It is used only if the target server is Tomcat.
See Also
Target Server property
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the manager URL of the Tomcat application. It is used only if the target server is Tomcat.
See Also
Target Server property.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the maximum number of connections to the database. (0 unlimited).
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Name
The name of the control.
Applies to
Button, Checkbox, Checkbox List, Connection, Date Picker, Directory, Editable Grid, Grid, Hidden, Image, Image Link, Include Page, Label, Label(Report), Link, List Box, Navigator, Panel, Radio Button, Record, Report, Path, Sorter, Text Area, Text Box
Description
A unique name used to identify the instance of the control. It is used to specifically address the control for getting and/or changing control properties. Important: This is also the name used to reference the control within the programming code.
Name Property
The name of the control.
Applies to
Report Section 150
Description
A unique name used to identify the instance of the control. It is used to specifically address the control for retrieving or specifying control properties. It is read-only.
No of Columns Property
Specifies the number of Calendar columns.
Applies to
Calendar
Description
You can use this property to specify the number of Calendar columns. One cell is allocated for each month. The Annual Calendar can have from 1 to 12 columns, quarterly and 3-months Calendars - from 1 to 3 columns.
No of Years Property
Specifies the range of years shown in the Calendar Navigator.
Applies to
Calendar Navigator
Description
You can use this property to specify the range of years shown in the Calendar Navigator. The Calendar Navigator has the predefied layout with year counting. If the specified value equals to 1, three numbers will be displayed: the previous year, current year and next year.
Applies to
Directory
Description
You can use this property to specify the number of columns to output the list of the categories. By default the value of this property is equal to 1. The categories are output from up to down, from left to right. If the number of the categories is not divisible by the number of columns, then the bigger number of the categories will be output in the columns to the left. For example, you have 2 columns and 3 categories, then 2 categories will be output in the first column from the left and 1 in the second one.
See also
Number of Subcategories property
Applies to
Directory
Description
You can use this property to specify the number of subcategories displayed in one column. If the actual quantity of the subcategories is bigger then the value entered into this property, the number of subcategories to be displayed will be equal to the number set in this property value the contents of the 'SubcategoriesTail' template will be output below. 151
Note: If you want to see all subcategories the value of this property should be empty.
See Also
Number of Columns property
Operation Property
The type of operation performed when the button is clicked [Insert, Update, Delete, Cancel or Search].
Applies to
Button
Description
Specify the operation that will be performed after the button has been clicked. The list of available operations is provided by the parent component. Record Insert Update Delete Cancel Search Editable Grid Cancel Submit Important: If you select of Insert, Update or Delete setting, the appropriate operation of the Record form will not be automatically performed, the value of the appropriate Allow Delete, Allow Insert or Allow Update property should be set to 'Yes'.
See Also
Allow Delete property, Allow Insert property, Allow Update property
Applies to
PHP, Perl Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the line feed symbol used in the output file: one-byte for UNIX\Linux or two-byte for Windows.
See Also
Perl Path property
Page Property
Specify the page that will be included.
Applies to
Include Page
Description
152
This property is used to specify the page that will be is as includable. You can select the page as the 'Page to Include' in the dialog box which will be displayed after you click on the corresponding icon in the Forms Tab of the Toolbox. Important: If you select a page as the Include Page, the Includable property for this page should be obligatory set to 'Yes'.
See Also
Includable property
Applies to
Navigator
Description
Specify the number of page links to be shown on the Navigator. The default is 10. This property is applied only if the Type property has the 'Centered' or 'Moving' value.
See Also
Type property
Applies to
Grid, Editable Grid
Description
Specify the maximum number of records a user may opt to display per page if using a search form that allows control over the number of records displayed via URL. In combination with the Records Per Page property it is used to set different output options for data into the grid.
See Also
Records Per Page property
Applies to
Path
Description
Specify the field with values pointing at the parent ID subcategory.
See also
ID Field property
Password Property
Specify the Password used to establish a database connection.
Applies to
Connection
Description
153
You can use this property to specify Password used to establish a database connection during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the full path to the log file. It can have the following values: 'out' - System.out, 'err' - System.err.
Percent Of Property
Specify whether the report value should be output as percentage of the corresponding group's total value.
Applies to
ReportLabel
Description
This property is used to specify the name of the report group for which the percent value will be calculated.
See Also
Function property Reset At property
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the absolute path to the Perl executable. Basically, this line specifies the location of the Perl program and therefore the line changes based on whether a Windows or Linux/Unix machine is being used. An example path for windows would be#!c:\perl\bin\perl.exe while for Linux/Unix, a common path is #!/usr/local/bin/perl. In Linux/Unix, you can find out the location of the Perl executable by typing the command 'which perl' in the command prompt of a shell session. For windows, the command Perl -h should produce information about the program including its path.
See Also
Output File Format property
Applies to
Connection 154
Description
You can use this property to specify the PHP database library used for the database connection on the server side.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases,
Applies to
PHP Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the file extension of the generated code files. .php is set by default. Note: The value of this property should contain '.' - dot symbol in front of the extension.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the PHP database library used for the database connection on the server side.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases,
PrintError Property
Specify if the warnings are generated in addition to returning error codes in the normal way.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to force errors to generate warnings (using warn) in addition to returning error codes in the normal way. When set 'Yes', any method which results in an error occurring will cause the DBI to effectively do a warn('$class $method failed: $DBI::errstr') where $class is the driver class and $method is the name of the method which failed.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Image Link, Link, Record, Editable Grid
Description
Specify the types of parameters that should be preserved by the Link and propagated to the linked page. 155
Setting
None Post All
Description
No parameters will be propagated by the link. All received Post parameters will be appended to the link. All received Get and Post parameters will be appended to the link.
Get (default) All received Get parameters will be appended to the link.
For the Grid form you can set this property to 'Post' to transfer all parameters via URL not depending on "<form method=" value in the HTML file. For the Record form you can set this property to "Get" to return all URL parameters (e.g. the search parameters) on the grid, after the form is submitted. If you set the value of this property to "None" no parameters will be propagated by the link besides the ones entered with the link. For example, the ones specified using the Href Source property.
See Also
Remove Parameters property, Href Source property
Publishing Property
Specify whether the generated pages will be published to a local computer to a remote computer via FTP.
Applies to
Project
Description
Specify whether the generated pages will be published to a local computer or network or whether they will be published to a remote computer via FTP.
R-S
RaiseError Property
Specify if an error raises an exception rather than return the error code.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to force errors to raise exceptions rather than return error codes in the normal way. It is 'NO' by default. Otherwise any method which results in an error will cause the DBI to effectively do a die('$class $method failed: $DBI::errstr') where $class is the driver class and $method is the name of the method that failed.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Grid, Editable Grid 156
Description
You can use this property to specify the number of records to be displayed per page by default. The table below shows the datasource data in three modes depending on this property and the Page Size Limit property:
Modes
All records By-the-page, with the fixed page size. By-the-page, with the some page size, but not greater than set in the Page Size Limit property
Important: If the 'Record Per Page' property is not set, the page size is accepted as equal to the value entered in the Page Size Limit property.
See Also
Page Size Limit property
References Property
Specify the semicolon-separated list of the project references.
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the semicolon-separated list of the external .dlls linked to the project.
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the RegExp library used in the project.
Applies to
Editable Grid, Image Link, Link
Description
Use this property to specify names of incoming Post or Get parameters that should not be propagated via the link. If the Record form has the Preserve Parameters property set to 'Get', this parameter will be applied to the 'Add record' link on the Grid form.
Examples:
The following are the property results for the page URL with parameters
my_page?page_id=3&emp_name=joe&emp_email=email@ com.com&object_id=26:
Setting
page_id;object_id my_page.asp?emp_name=joe&emp_email=email@com.com
157
See Also
Preserve Parameters property
Required Property
Specify if a value must be entered for the control in order for the form to be submitted successfully.
Applies to
Checkbox List, Hidden, File Upload, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
You can set this property to 'Yes' to specify that the control must submit a value when the form is submitted. If the control does not submit a value, the form will not be processed to completion but instead an error message will be displayed.
Reset At Property
Specify when the value of auto-calculated label will be reset during calculations.
Applies to
ReportLabel
Description
This property is used to specify when the value of auto-calculated label should be reset. Possible values are "Report", "Page" or name of any defined report group.
See Also
Function property Percent Of property
Restricted Property
Specify whether users must be logged in before accessing the form.
Applies to
Page, Grid, Record, Report, Editable Grid, Directory
Description
The following is this property application to the Page and other controls:
Setting
Page
Description
If set to 'Yes', the login validation is performed, otherwise the users are redirected to the Login page set in the Security Tab of the Project Settings. You can also set the Security Groups for the page, and the unauthorized group users will be redirected to the Login page. Additionally, you can specify the redirection page for unauthorized users using the Access Denied Page property. If set to 'Yes' and the Security Groups are not specified, the control is not shown to the unauthorized users. If you specify the Security Groups you can additionally set the available options for each group.
Others controls
See Also
Access Denied Page property
Applies to
Button, Editable Grid, Record
Description
Use this property to specify the page that should be viewed after the button has been clicked, or the Record form has been submited. If the Record form was created using the Record Builder, this property will be empty for all buttons. The return page is used only for the Record form.
Applies to
Sorter
Description
This property is used to specify fields for the reverse sorting. If the value of this property is not specified than the reverse sorting is performed for the same field set in the Sort Order property. If you select several fields in the Sort Order property you should also select the necessary fields and set the sorting direction for this property. Otherwise, the sorting direction will be changed only for the last field specified in the Sort Order property (the DESC parameter will be added to the SQL statement).
See also
Sort Order property
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the semicolon separated file list of Runtime libraries. These files will be copied to the WEB-INF\lib directory of your application.
Applies to
Project
Description
This option is only used if you want to access the pages over a SSL connection and the server support SSL.
Applies to
Project
Description
The following are the possible values: 159
Setting Description
None No site security is implemented (default) Table Security will be based on information contained in a database table
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the type of the used Server API. It can take the following values:
Parameter
CGI
Description
Used by default
mod_perl version 1 Specify if mod_perl version 1 is used. mod_perl version 2 Specify if mod_perl version 1 is used. Please use the defaults if in doubt.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the ADO connection string or ODBC Data Source Name used for the database connection if the server connection is different from the design connection.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, Server Same As Design property
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the ADO connection string or ODBC Data Source Name used for the database connection if the server connection is different from the design connection.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases, Server Same As Design property
Applies to
Connection 160
Description
You can use this property to specify the type of database accessed during the server (live) execution. If your database type is not listed, you may select the 'ANSI SQL-92' option. This property is used to determine database specific SQL features during run-time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the server database name or DBI Data Source Name for Perl.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the type of database being accessed during the server (live) execution. If your database type is not listed, select the ANSI SQL-92 option. This property is used to determine database specific SQL features during Run-time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the IP address or hostname of the machine where the SQL server is located.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify Login used to access the server database.
See Also
161
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify Password used to access the server database.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the server path to the published files. It is used only if the target server is Tomcat.
See Also
Target Server property
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the absolute path to the root of web folder where scripts should be run. For example: /var/www/perl/Project1. Note: If the value of this property is not specified, FindBin(CGI) or Apache::request(mod_perl) modules will determine this value depending on the server's API.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify that opened connections are reused whenever available.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection 162
Description
You can use this property to specify the SQL server port. If the default port is used this property should be blank, for example the default port for MySQL is 3306.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify if the server connection matches the design connection.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can use this variable to specify how often the session files will be checked for expiration, and the expired files will be deleted. If 'Sessions Files Clean Rate' = 100, such check will be performed when each 100th page of your application will be called. If your site is stressed enough you might want to increase this value to improve the performance. And if you have only several visitors per day, you can decrease this value without significant impact for the overall performance.
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the absolute or relative path to the folder where the session variable information will be stored. This should be a folder with read/write access.
Applies to
Perl Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the time in minutes after which the session variables in an inactive session will be terminated.
Schema Property
163
Specify a database schema for the object display during the design time.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify a database schema for the object display during the design time. It is used for Oracle and MSSQL databases. The Schema is a collection of the related database objects, usually grouped by the database userid. The Schema Objects include tables, views, sequences, stored program units, synonyms, indexes, clusters, and database links.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Calendar
Description
You can use this property to specify whether to show days of the surrounding months if the 1st or last week of the month includes days of other months.
Applies to
Project
Description
Specify the spoken language for the project pages. You can select a language from the list and all the text of your site, i.e. the header, footer error messages, buttons etc., will be generated on this spoken language. Important: You will not be able to change the language on the earlier generated pages. Only the text for the record error messages will be changed.
Applies to
Sorter
Description
This property contains a field name (or comma-separated list of field names) used to sort data sources rows. Field names can be followed by 'ASC' or 'DESC' to alter sorting order. Note: If there are several fields selected or "DESC" used for one of the fields you should select the necessary fields and set the sorting direction in the Reverse Order property. Otherwise, the sorting direction of the last field will be changed in the Reverse Order property.
See also
Reverse Order property
164
Applies to
Page
Description
This property specifies that the SSL connection will be applied to the page. If the property value is set to 'Yes', the SSL connection validation is performed. If you view the page without using the secured connection, the following error message is displayed: "SSL connection error. This page
can be accessed only via secured connection."
Style Property
Specify the css style applied to the Date Picker/Selector.
Applies to
Date Picker
Description
You can use this property to specify the css style applied to the Date Picker/Selector.
Applies to
Directory
Description
Specify the data field that contains category id of the second level categories.
See Also
Data Source property, Category ID Field property
Synonyms Property
Specify if the display of database synonyms is enabled during the design time.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify if the display of database synonyms is enabled during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
165
You can use this property to specify if the display of database system tables is enabled during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify if the display of database system views is enabled during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
T-Z
Target Schema Property
Specify the target schema for ASPX pages.
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the target schema for ASPX pages.
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the host server where your application will be deployed.
See Also
Server Path property, Context Path property, Manager Password property, Manager Login property, Manager URL property
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify the target .NET framework version.
Applies to
File Upload
Description
The property specifies the full path or the relative path to the temporary folder beginning from the current page folder. If the property value starts with "%", the environment variable specifies the path to the temporary folder. If the language doesn't have functions for loading the environment variable content, the following error message is shown: Invalid value of the Temporary Folder property.
Applies to
Checkbox List, List Box, Radio Button
Description
If the Source Type property is set to Table/View, Procedure or SQL, this property is used to specify the database field that will provide the List Box values to be displayed.
See Also
Bound Column property, Data Source Type property, Data Source property
Applies to
ReportLabel
Description
This property is used to specify the text that will be displayed when the label value is empty.
Applies to
Calendar
Description
You can use this property to specify the database format of the field containing event time.
See also
Applies to
Calendar
Description
You can use this property to specify the field containing event time. You must use this property when event's date and time are stored in saparate fields.
See also
167
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify the duration of time after which an idle or unresponsive connection will be terminated (in milliseconds).
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Type Property
Specify the type of page links to be shown in the Navigator control.
Applies to
Navigator
Description
The following are the possible values:
Setting Description
Simple Only the current page and the Number of Pages are displayed in the Navigator. Centered The Number of Pages is shown as it is set in the Page Links property and the current page is displayed in the center of the Navigator. Moving The Number of Pages is shown as it is set in the Page Links property and the current page is displayed moving on the page list of the Navigator.
If you like to change the value of this property from 'Simple' to "Centered" or "Moving" the HTML should be modified.
See Also
Page Links property
Type Property
Specifies the Calendar type.
Applies to
Calendar
Description
The possible values are the following:
Setting Description
Annual Specifies that all 12 months of the year will be shown in the Calendar. Quarterly Specifies that quarter (three months) of the year will be shown in the Calendar. 3-Months Specifies that any of 3 months of the year will be shown. Monthly Specifies that one month Calendar will be shown. 168
Applies to
Checkbox
Description
In conjunction to the Checked Value property, this property allows you to specify a value to be associated with the unchecked state of the checkbox. Ordinarily, an unchecked HTML checkbox does not submit any value, this property can be used to associate a value with the unchecked state.
Examples
This control can be used to update a database field of the "Text" type, which stores the 'Yes' or 'No' value. In order to do that you can set the DataType property to 'Text', and enter "Yes" for the Checked Value property and "No" for the Unchecked Value Property. The value should be obligatory entered in double quotes. The following are the possible applications:
See Also
Checked Value property, DataType property
Unique Property
Specify if it is validated that any value entered in the control does not already exist in the database.
Applies to
Checkbox List, Hidden, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
Set "Yes" to ensure that a value submitted by the control does not match any other value that is already in the database. If a duplicate is encountered, form processing will terminate and an error message will be displayed stating the problem.
Applies to
Java Projects
Description
You can use this property to specify if the JDBC 2.0 Standart Extension will be used in the project.
See Also
Class Path property
Applies to
169
Connection
Description
Use this property to optimize the database performance by returning only the records that are used within the form. If set to "Yes", the changes will be applied to the Data Source of the Grid, Editable Grid and Record components when used with any of the following databases: MySQL, PostgreSQL, Microsoft SQL Server and Microsoft Access. The following table shows how the "Use LIMIT/TOP" property is utilized:
Component
Grid, Editable Grid
Database
MySQL
Description
When using Table or SQL data source, "LIMIT offset, row_count" is applied to the Select SQL at the end of the SQL statement. When using Table or SQL data source, "LIMIT row_count OFFSET offset" is applied to the Select SQL at the end of the SQL statement.
PgSQL
MS SQL Server, When using Table data source, "TOP row_count+offset" is MS Access applied automatically. When using SQL data source and the SQL begins with SELECT, "TOP row_count+offset" is applied after "SELECT" or "SELECT DISTINCT" or "SELECT ALL". However, "TOP" is not applied to the SQL data source if SQL already contains TOP or "UNION [ALL] SELECT" in the SQL body. Record MySQL, PgSQL LIMIT 1 is added to the Select SQL after ORDER BY. MS SQL Server, When using Table or SQL data source, "TOP 1" is applied to the MS Access Select SQL in the same manner as when using the Grid component. Notes: "row_count+offset" is a value calculated as the sum of starting row and the number of rows to be returned. the LIMIT/TOP clause is applied even when using custom code that alters the DataSource. to disable LIMIT/TOP in individual forms create an alternative database connection that doesn't utilize the "Use LIMIT/TOP" property.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
Applies to
Checkbox, Checkbox List, Hidden, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
This property presents you with the opportunity to enter a programming language specific condition that will be used to determine the validity of the submitted value. If the requirement is not satisfied the error message from Validation Text property is shown. 170
Important: If there is no text entered into the Validation Text property the message is not shown and the following warning message appears in the Messages Window: "Warning: TextBox DateFiled: The Validation Text property is empty." The property value depends on the programming language of the project.
Example
For instance, if using ASP and you have a control that submits date values, you can enter a simple condition to ensure that the date is later than the current date i.e. FieldName is the name of the control being validated.
FieldName.Value > Date()
See Also
Validation Text property
Applies to
Checkbox, Checkbox List, Hidden, List Box, Radio Button, Text Area, Text Box
Description
This property is related to the Validation Rule property and is used to specify an error message that will be displayed in case the validation rule is not satisfied. Important: If the Validation Rule property is not set, the property text is not shown and the following warning message is shown in the Message Window: "Warning: TextBox DateFiled: The
Validation Rule property is empty."
See Also
Validation Rule property
Applies to
.NET Projects
Description
Indicates whether request validation should occur. If true, request validation checks all input data against a hard-coded list of potentially dangerous values. If a match occurs, an HttpRequestValidationException exception is thrown. The default is true.
Views Property
Specify if the display of database views is enabled during the design time.
Applies to
Connection
Description
You can use this property to specify if the display of database views is enabled during the design time.
See Also
Connection Reference, Connecting to Databases
171
Visible Property
Specifies whether the control is visible.
Available values
Yes, No, Dynamic.
Applies to
Components, Report Section
Description
Setting this property to "No" prevents the object from being displayed, usually by excluding it from the HTML at runtime. When set to "Dynamic", the component is wrapped within a special HTML template that allows it to be hidden programmatically at runtime.
Events
Client Side Events
On Change event
Applies to
List Box, Text Area, Text Box
Description
This event occurs on the client side after the control's value is changed and focus is lost. It can be used to change values of other controls and for validation of input values.
Examples
The following is an example of a Celsius-to-Fahrenheit temperature converter. In a Record form called NewRecord1 with the text boxes TextBox1 and TextBox2, the Custom Code in the On Change event converts the Celsius value entered in Textbox1 to a Fahrenheit value which is displayed in Textbox2.
<script language="JavaScript"> function page_NewRecord1_TextBox1_OnChange() { var result; document.NewRecord1.TextBox2.value = ((9/5) * document.NewRecord1.TextBox1.value ) + 32; return result; } function bind_events() { check_and_bind('document.NewRecord1.TextBox1','onchange',page_NewRecord1_TextBo x1_OnChange); forms_onload();
172
On Click event
Applies to
Button, Check Box, Check Box List, Radio Button
Description
This event occurs when the user clicks the left mouse button on the object. Possible applications: Handling button clicking. Executing custom button actions.
Examples
The following is an example usage of the On Click event. In this case, a Confirmation Message action is added to the On Click event of a Delete button in a Record form called Record1. The following is the code generated for the action (CodeCharge Studio comments are removed):
<script language="JavaScript"> function page_NewRecord1_Delete_OnClick() { return confirm('Delete record?'); } function bind_events() { check_and_bind('document.NewRecord1.Delete','onclick', page_NewRecord1_Delete_OnClick); forms_onload(); } window.onload = bind_events; </script>
On Key Press
Applies to
Text Area, Text Box
Description
This event occurs when the user presses an alphanumeric key. It can be used to change the value of other controls.
Examples
The following example shows how the On Key Press event can be used to set the value of a Text Box called TextBox2 whenever a new value is entered in another Text Box called TextBox1.
<script language="JavaScript"> function page_NewRecord2_TextBox1_OnKeyPress() { var result; //Custom Code var maxlength = document.NewRecord2.TextBox1.value.length + 1;
173
document.NewRecord2.TextBox2.value = maxlength; //End Custom Code return true; } function bind_events() { check_and_bind('document.NewRecord2.TextBox1','onkeypress',page_NewRecord2_Text Box1_OnKeyPress); forms_onload(); } window.onload = bind_events; </script>
On Load event
Applies to
Button, Check Box, Editable Grid, Hidden, List Box, Page, Record, Text Area, Text Box
Description
Page This event occurs on the client side directly after the page is loaded into the browser. This event is often used to setup the mechanism for validating controls within the page. Button, Check Box, Editable Grid, Hidden, List Box, Record, Text Area, Text Box The On Load event does not apply directly to the above controls but is used to attach validation criteria to controls when the page loads. This is mostly done for controls that reside within Record or Editable Grid forms. For the above controls, On Load is not a native DHTML event but is wired through the page On Load event.
Examples
The following is an example of the minimum length validation for a Text Box called Textbox2 which is located within a Record form called NewRecord2. In this case, a Validate Entry action is added to the On Load event with the following settings: Validate Entry
Property
Required Minimum Length Maximum Length Input Mask Regular Expression Error Message Validation Function
Value
True 8
Minimum length: 8
As a result the generated code will be as follows (CodeCharge Studio comments are removed): 174
<script language="JavaScript"> function page_NewRecord2_TextBox2_OnLoad() { var result; this.ccsRequired = true; this.ccsMinLength = 8; this.ccsErrorMessage = "Minimum length is 8"; this.ccsCaption = ""; return result; } function bind_events() { check_and_bind('document.NewRecord2','onLoad',page_NewRecord2_TextBox2_OnLoad); forms_onload(); } window.onload = bind_events; </script>
On Unload event
Applies to
Page
Description
This event occurs immediately before the page is unloaded from the browser.
Examples
On Submit event
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Description
This event occurs on the client side when the user submits a form but before the data is sent to the server from the form. It can be used for the validation, to confirm the submission or alter control values.
Examples
In this example, a Confirmation Message action is added to the On Submit event of a Record form called Record1. The action causes a message ("Submit form?" ) to be displayed whenever the form is submitted.
<script language="JavaScript"> function page_NewRecord1_OnSubmit() { return confirm('Submit form?'); } function bind_events() { check_and_bind('document.NewRecord1','onsubmit',page_NewRecord1_OnSubmit); forms_onload();
175
Description
This event occurs after a row deletion query has been executed. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing query errors Changing parameters and re-executing the query Performing other transactions queries and closing the transaction
Description
This event occurs after new row insert query has been executed. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing query errors Changing parameters and re-executing the query Performing other transactions queries and closing the transaction
Description
This event occurs after the row selection query has been executed and a recordset for the result is returned. Possible applications: Processing query errors Retrieving recordsets state Changing parameters and re-executing the query
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Description
This event occurs after a row update query has been executed. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing query errors Changing parameters and re-executing the query Performing other transactions queries and closing transaction
Examples
Execute Custom SQL
Description
This event occurs after deleting a row from the data source. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing operation errors Altering returned error collection Performing cascading deletion of linked rows from other tables or updating item counters Modifying the redirect string
Examples
This example After Delete event shows how to perform a cascading delete of link records that are related to a user record that has been deleted.
Function members_AfterDelete() If members.DataSource.Errors.Count = 0 Then DBInternet.Execute ("DELETE FROM links WHERE user_id_add_by = " &_ DBInternet.ToSQL(members.DataSource.Parameters("urluser_id"),ccsInteger)) End If End Function
Description
This event is executed if user submits upload form with delete checkbox selected, after performing file delete operation. Possible applications: 177
removing any additional information kept about the file (database records) removing any other files related to the file
Description
This event occurs after all page components have been initialized but before dynamic database content is processed. Possible applications: Loading custom resources Setting session and application variables Altering component properties Preprocessing submitted data Creating custom objects and structures
Examples
Custom Error Message, Add URL Parameters to a Page
Description
This event occurs after inserting a new row into the data source. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing query errors Performing supplemental queries: updating item counters, propagating modification date Modifying the redirect string
Description
This event is executed after processing uploaded file (saving into target directory). Possible applications: inserting additional file information into some table record
Description
178
This event occurs after the data rows are modified. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing query errors Performing modification date propagation, logging user operation Modifying redirect string
Description
This event occurs after updating an existing row in the data source. Possible applications: Checking operation status Processing query errors Performing modification date propagation, logging user operation Modifying the redirect string
Description
This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to deleted a database record. Possible applications: Setting custom query parameters or changing existing ones.
Description
This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to insert a new record into the database. Possible applications: Setting custom query parameters or changing existing ones
Description
This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to retrieve records from the database. Possible applications: 179
Examples
Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox, Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause, Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement, Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause, Retrieve Values From a Multi-Select ListBox
Description
This event occurs before the creation of the query that will be used to update database content. Possible applications: Setting custom query parameters or changing existing ones
Description
This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to delete an existing record. Possible applications: Checking delete rights Preventing row deletion Setting query parameters
Description
This event is executed if user submits upload form with delete checkbox selected, before performing file delete operation. Possible applications: changing file name to delete backing up file for later undoing operation
Description
This event occurs after the query has been composed and immediately before a delete query is executed. 180
Possible applications: Altering query components Opening a transaction Performing transaction operations
Description
This event occurs after the query has been composed and immediately before a row update query is executed. Possible applications: Altering query components Opening a transaction Performing transaction operations
Description
This event occurs after the query has been composed and immediately before a row update query is executed. Possible applications: Altering query components
Description
This event occurs after the query has been composed and immediately before a row update query is executed. Possible applications: Altering query parameters Opening a transaction Performing transaction operations
Description
This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to insert a new record. Possible applications: 181
Checking insert rights Preventing row insertion Setting custom query parameters Modifying the data to be inserted
Examples
Replace Control Value Before Inserting
Description
This event occurs after the current page is rendered and before the output is sent to the client (Web browser). Possible applications: Modify the HTTP entity body before transmission.
Description
This event is executed before processing uploaded file (before moving file from temporary into target directory). Possible applications: changing target folder depending on a file extension
Description
This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to select records from the database. Possible applications: Modifying Select parameters Changing component properties
Description
This event occurs before a component is rendered to the page. Possible applications: Assigning custom template variables 182
Altering data for populating the template Changing structure of the template Modifying component properties and visibility Change Control Value Changing Text Color Dynamic Login Field in a Registration Form Hiding a Grid If No Records are Found Hiding a Record Form Control Dynamically Modify the "List Of Values" of a ListBox Lookup Single Field Value in a Database Retrieve Multiple Field Values from a Database Dynamically Set the Default Value of a ListBox Add Custom HTML to a Page Utilize MySQL Enum Field Type Examine Form's Mode Working with Custom Template Blocks
Examples
Description
This event occurs before each top level category is displayed. Possible applications: Altering the data to be displayed in each category Assigning custom template variables
Description
This event occurs before each row in the form is displayed. Possible applications: Altering the data to be displayed in each row Assigning custom template variables
Examples
Changing Table Cell Color, Dynamically Modify a Hyperlink, Create a Grid Column with a Calculated Value, Simple Report With Group Headers, Simple Report with Total, 183
Description
This event occurs before showing a subcategory. Possible application: Altering the data to be displayed in each subcategory Assigning custom template variables
Description
This event occurs before any database operations are performed with the submitted data. Possible applications: Checking update rights Preventing row from updating Setting custom query parameters
Description
This event occurs before disposing page components and after the page has been composed. Possible applications: Freeing custom resources and other structures
See also
Dynamically Redirect Users to Another Page
Description
This event occurs at the onset of the operations performed to update a database record. Possible applications: Checking update rights Preventing a row from updating Setting custom query parameters
Examples
184
On Cache Event
Applies to
Page
Description
This event occurs before adding an object into Cache or retrieving an objectfrom Cache. Possible applications: Disabling cache operation Handling custom cache parameters
On Calculate Event
Applies to
ReportSection
Description
This event occurs after the totals of all function-based controls in the current section are calculated. Possible applications: Custom calculations. Change the total control value.
On Click Event
Applies to
Button
Description
This event occurs when a forms button has been clicked but before any other operations have been performed as a result of the submission. Possible applications: Performing custom actions in response to button clicks.
Examples
Create Custom Session Variables, Dynamically Redirect Users to Another Page
On Initialized Event
Applies to
ReportSection
Description
This event occurs on initialization of section instance. Possible applications: Dynamically change the height of the current section.
Applies to
Page
Description
This event occurs after handling submitted data and before loading templates for displaying the page. Possible applications: Altering the file name of the loaded template Changing the content type
On Validate Event
Applies to
Check Box List, Editable Grid, Hidden, List Box, Radio Button, Record, Text Area, Text Box
Description
This event occurs after standard validation operations have been performed as a result of submitting values, but before any database operations have been performed with the submitted values. Possible applications: Performing custom validation Altering the validation result
Examples
Using the Control Validation Event, Using the Form Validation Event
Actions
Client Side Actions
Attach FCKeditor
This action can be assigned to the On Load client event of a TextArea control to replace it with FCKeditor (rich text editor). For this action to work properly the FCKeditor must be installed on the server and "FCKeditor base Path" must be specified in Project Settings. The following action settings are available:
Parameter
Width Height Config Parameters
Description
Width of the editing area in pixels or percent. If left blank, FCKeditor will use it's default value of 100%. The height of the editing area in pixels or percent. If left blank, FCKeditor will use it's default value of 200 pixels. Opens the FCKeditor configuration dialog that allows configuring additional properties available in FCKeditor. These values are not related to CodeCharge Studio and are provided for convenience of configuring FCKeditor itself. Please 186
refer to FCKeditor documentation for more information about FCKeditor configuration. Note: for this feature to work properly it is required that you enable the "Config" option in your FCKeditor configuration file (FCKeditor\editor\filemanager\browser\default\connectors\ext\Config.asp for ASP and .NET, or Config.php for PHP), and uncomment proper connector lines in FCKeditor\fckconfig.js Please note that YesSoftware does not support FCKeditor itself. The documentation, configuration parameters and FCKeditor feature list can be found on FCKeditor Website at FCKeditor.net.
Properties
Property
Command Options
Description
The name of the executable program which will perform the HTML conversion. Provides option values for the conversion program. It is assumed that the conversion program would have options to specify the input HTML file and output PDF file names. These file names are generated dynamically by the action and passed to the conversion program. You specify option values in a template format, by replacing the input file name with {InputFile} and the output file name with {ResultFile}. You can also specify {Root} as one of the options, in which case the action will also provide to the conversion program the server path used for resolving relative URLs in the input file to the absolute ones. Sample syntax specified in the Options property:
{InputFile} -f {ResultFile} -root {Root}
Parameter Name The name of the URL parameter which will activate the conversion action. Temporary Folder The path to be used for storing the temporary HTML and converted files. This parameter specifies the full server path, or the path relative folder to the current page folder. If the property value begins with "%" the environment variable will 187
be used to specify the temporary folder path. For example specifying "%TEMP" would set the temporary folder to the Windows environment variable named "TEMP".
Custom Code
This action allows you to enter your own code to be executed when the event occurs.
//Custom Code @41-2A29BDB7 // ------------------------// Write your own code here. // ------------------------//End Custom Code
Confirmation Message
This action is used to confirm different operations. To perform this action the JavaScript's Confirm function is applied. For instance, this action can be placed in the On Click event of a Delete button withint a Record form so as to confirm the deletion.
Property Description
Message Specify the message to be shown in the confirmation dialog.
Property
Control Name Regular Expression Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Regular expression to be used for validation. Error message to be displayed if the control value does not match the regular expression.
Set Focus
This action is used to set focus to a particular object in the window. For a input field, focus means that anything typed by the user will be entered into the field. For a button, focus means that pressing the enter key is equivalent to clicking the button. Use this action to set focus to a particular field for the convenience of the user or in cases where you want input to begin at a particular field. When you add this action there are two properties you have to provide.
Property Description
Form Control Name of the form that the control to be focused on is located. Name of the control to receive focus.
Submit Form
You can use this action to submit a form whose name is specified in the Form Name property. The action can also be used to submit one form from another form or from elsewhere within the page. 188
Property
Description
Validate Entry
This action is used to setup one or more validation conditions for a field. Multiple fields within a form can have their own Validate Entry actions. After the Validate Entry actions have been setup, the Validate Form action is used to execute all the validations.
Property
Required Minimum Length Maximum Length Input Mask
Description
Specify whether a field value is required or not. Minimum acceptable field value size. Maximum acceptable field value size. Input mask to be used to determine the validity of the field value. The following symbols can be used for the mask: 0 - any digit, L - any character in the lower or upper case. All other symbols should be the same as in the mask string. For example, mask (000) 000-00-00 will allow entering the telephone in format (123) 123-45-67. Mask LLLL-LL00 will allow outputting the alphanumeric code with the sign in the middle, for example: ABCD-EF35.
Regular expression to be used to determine the validity of the field value. Error message to be displayed if an invalid entry is made. Name of a custom validation function to be executed.
Validate Form
This action makes use of the built-in CodeCharge Studio validation functionality contained in a Jscript include file called functions.js. A function is called in the file to validate any conditions that have been set for the fields within the forms using the Validate Entry action. The possible conditions are: Required field value Minimum field value Maximum Field value Check against a regular expression Call a custom function to validate the field If any of the conditions are not satisfied, the function displays an appropriate error message.
many places including the On Click event of a button in the form or the On Change event of the field being validated. The following are the properties that need to be configured for the action.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Error message to be displayed if the maximum length is exceeded.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Error message to be displayed if the input value exceeds the maximum value.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Error message to be displayed if the input is less than the minimum length.
Property
Control Name
Description
Name of the control to be validated.
Minimum Value Minimum allowable input value. Error Message Error message to be displayed if the input value exceeds the maximum value. 190
Property
Description
Control Name Name of the control to be validated. Error Message Error message to be displayed if the control has no value.
Property Description
Expression A code expression which returns the number of columns to be displayed in the Directory form.
Properties
Property
Command Options
Description
The name of the executable program which will perform the HTML conversion. Provides option values for the conversion program. It is assumed that the conversion program would have options to specify the input HTML file and output PDF file names. These file names are generated dynamically by the action and passed to the conversion program. You specify option values in a template format, by replacing the input file name with {InputFile} and the output file name with {ResultFile}. You can also specify {Root} as one of the options, in which case the action will also provide to the 191
conversion program the server path used for resolving relative URLs in the input file to the absolute ones. Sample syntax specified in the Options property:
{InputFile} -f {ResultFile} -root {Root}
Parameter Name The name of the URL parameter which will activate the conversion action. Temporary Folder The path to be used for storing the temporary HTML and converted files. This parameter specifies the full server path, or the path relative folder to the current page folder. If the property value begins with "%" the environment variable will be used to specify the temporary folder path. For example specifying "%TEMP" would set the temporary folder to the Windows environment variable named "TEMP".
Custom Code
This action allows you to enter your own code to be executed when the event occurs.
//Custom Code @41-2A29BDB7 // ------------------------// Write your own code here. // ------------------------//End Custom Code
Declare Variable
The Declare variable action is used to create and initialize a new variable of the specified type.
Property Description
Name Name of the variable. The name should conform to the variable naming conventions of the language used. If PHP or Perl is used, the "$" sign will automatically be added to the name of the variable in the code. Type property is ignored for type less languages: ASP, PHP, etc. If the exact type of the variable is not known, you can use the standard CodeCharge Studio data type which will be converted to the closest type for the language used. Value or expression which will evaluate to a value to be assigned to the variable.
Type
Initial value
DLookup
Use this action to retrieve the value of a single database field or expression. The retrieved database value is then used to set the value of a target variable.
Property
Expression Domain Criteria Connection
Description
Field or expression to be used in the SELECT clause of the SQL statement to be executed. Table or view name to be used in the FROM clause of the SQL statement to be executed. Criteria to be used in the WHERE clause of the SQL statement to be executed. Connection from which the database value will be retrieved. 192
Convert result to
Data type to which the retrieved value should be converted. The type specified must comply with the nature of the value to be retrieved i.e. a string cannot be converted to an integer. The possible data types are Text, Integer, Float, Date, Boolean and Memo. Type of variable which will receive the retrieved database value [Control, variable, expression, session, application, cookie]. Name of the variable which will receive the retrieved database value.
Gallery Layout
This action is added into the Before Show Row event by the Gallery Builder and is used to control visibility of 'RowOpenTag', RowComponents' and 'RowCloseTag' panels. These panels are also automatically created by the Gallery Builder and allow for properly opening and closing table cells. Gallery Layout action uses the value of "numberOfColumns" attribute, which is created by the Gallery Builder as well, and later can be found in the "Attributes" property of the gallery grid. The Gallery Layout action extends the functionality of a standard grid, so that it can display rows horizontally. It is recommended to use the Gallery Builder to create proper grid that utilizes this action and related elements.
Hide-Show Component
You can use this action to manage the visibility of the component based on the specified condition.
Property
Component Name Hide/Show Condition Type Condition Compare As Parameter1(2) Name Source Type Format
Description
The name of the component. Performed Action. The default value is 'Hide'. Specify the Type of calculated expression for the Action to be performed. Valid values: Parameter, Expression. The default value is 'Parameter'. Comparison Condition. If 'true' the specified action will be performed. Data type of compared parameters. This property is valid if the Condition Type is 'Parameter'. The default value is 'Text'. Comparison parameters. Parameter name or expression. Parameter source. This property is valid if the Condition Type is 'Parameter'. Format used for parameter parsing and formatting before comparison.
Login
The Login action is used to authenticate users after they submit their username and password. Upon successful verification of user login credentials the action redirects the user to the return 193
page provided in the URL (if enabled in the action properties and the user was redirected here from another page), or to the destination page specified in the "Return Page" property of the login form. Additionally, when the Remember Me option is enabled included on the login form, and selected by a user, the action also stores the encrypted user credentials in a cookie so that the login process can be skipped in the future. When building a login form, CodeCharge Studio automatically assigns the Login action to the On Click (Server) event of the login button. Login action properties:
Property
Login Control Password Control Auto Login Control
Description
Name of the input field (textbox control) where the user will enter their username. Name of the input field (textbox control) where the user will enter their password. Name of the checkbox control that enables the "remember me" option.
Redirect To Prev Specifies whether the user should be redirected back to the page they wanted Page to view before they were directed to the Login page.
See also
Logout action
Logout
This action works opposite of the Login action as it terminates the currently authenticated user session. The action does this by clearing the values of session variables and the optional autologin cookie that hold details of the authenticated user. The Logout action can be assigned to the After Initialize event of any page, either manually or by invoking the "Authentication Builder". You can then execute the action and logout a user by calling the page with a non-empty parameter specified in the action properties. For example if the Parameter Name is set to "Logout" and the action is placed on the Login.php page, you'd logout users by redirecting them to http://www.mywebsite.com/Login.php?Logout=true or http://www.mywebsite.com/Login.php?Logout=yes, etc. You can also create a "Logout" link on any page by configuring it to execute such URL. Logout action properties:
Property
Parameter Name
Description
Name of a URL parameter which indicates that the Logout action should be performed. If the parameter name is set, the Logout action is performed only if this parameter is received. Note: If there is no value entered into this property, then the redirect will not be performed after logout.
Return Page Page to which the user is redirected after logging out.
Page Redirect
If set to False the redirect is performed in this Action to the Return Page. If set to True the redirect is performed after closing all connections and clearing the memory on the page level. Note for .NET users: As the .NET has an improved Garbage Collection Mechamism all redirects are performed directly. Setting this property to True has no 194
redirect effect.
See also
Login action
Print Text
Use this action to print out some variable or literal text to the screen.
Property Description
Expression Enter the variable or literal to be printed out. Literals such as strings must be properly specified, i.e. within quotation marks in the case of a string literal.
Property
Control Name Regular Expression Error Message
Description
Name of the control whose value is to be validated. If empty then the current control is used. Regular expression to be used for validation. Error message to be displayed if an invalid entry is made.
Property
Control Name
Description
The name of the control for which the value is specified.
195
Source Type The type of the source from which the value is retrieved. Possible values: Variable Expression URL Form Session Application Cookie Translation Source Name The name of the source variable which contains the value to be assigned to the form control.
For example if the URL contains "abc=123" then the value "123" can be retrieved by specifying the "Source Name" = "abc". The value can be then assigned to a control (field) on the page.
See also
Using Action to Dynamically Translate Control Value
Property
Variable Name
Description
Name of the variable whose value will be set.
Source Type Type of source from where the variable value will be retrieved [Expression, URL, form, application, session or cookie]. Source Name Actual name of the source variable containing the value to be assigned to the variable.
Property
Control Name
Description
Name of the control whose value is to be saved.
Destination Type Type of the variable which will receive the value of the control. Destination Name Actual name of the variable where the control value will be saved.
Property
Description
196
Variable Name
Destination Type Type of the variable which will receive the value of variable being saved. Destination Name Actual name of the variable where the value will be saved.
Send Email
The Send Email action is used in a Record form to send information based on the value of fields within the form.
Property
From
Description
Name of a control which will provide the 'From' field of the email. If the value starts with '=', then the expression coming after this symbol is used in it's literal form. For example, the expression ="someone@somecompany.com" will strictly define the value of the 'From' field as someone@somecompany.com. Name of a control that will provide the 'To' field of the email. If the value starts with '=', then the expression coming after this symbol is used in it's literal form. Name of a control that will provide the 'Subject' field of the email. If the value starts with '=', then the expression coming after this symbol is used in it's literal form. Name of a control which will provide the email's body. If the value starts with '=', then the expression coming after this symbol is used in it's literal form. Format in which to send the email. If set to True, the massage is sent in HTML format, otherwise it is sent as plain text.
SMTP Server Address of a SMTP server which will be used to send the email. Messagebox Full path to the pickup directories for the SMTP service. Path
Property Description
Expression Expression which returns the page number to be set.
Property
Download Folder
Description
The path to the image folder on the server, either absolute or relative to the current folder. A dynamic path can be specified in the form of the equal sign followed by a function or variable, for example: =$FolderName
197
This action can be used in the Before Show event of a link component to specify the location of the destination file to be opened or downloaded via the link. Although the download folder is usually specified in the HTML, this action can be helpful to dynamically point to files in different folders.
Property
Destination Folder
Description
The path to the link's destination folder on the server, either absolute or relative to the current folder. A dynamic path can be specified in the form of the equal sign followed by a function or variable, for example: =$FolderName
Property Description
Expression Expression that returns the number of empty rows to be used for adding new records.
Property Description
Expression Expression that returns the number of records per page to be displayed in the Grid or Editable Grid. This should be a positive integer or -1 if all records should be shown on one page.
Property
Attribute name Row Styles
Description
Name of grid's attribute that will be used for applying the style. Open the property dialog to maintain a list of alternating style classes or inline css 198
styles. The 'Row Styles' list can contain names of classes, style expressions or style attributes. Additionally: A Row Style that doesn't contain symbols ":" and "=" is interpreted as a style class and the corresponding attribute will be set to "class='[specifiedClassName]'". A Row Style that doesn't contain the symbol "=" but contains ":" is interpreted as a style expression and the corresponding attribute will be set to "style='[specifiedStyleExpression]'". A Row Style that contains the symbol "=" will be assigned to the attribute as is. Sample list of Row Styles: 1. Row 2. AltRow 3. style="color: red" 4. font-weight: bold The above example defines four alternating styles that will be applied to grid rows as follows: Row #1 will use CSS class 'Row'. Row #2 will use CSS class 'AltRow'. Row #3 will use CSS style 'style="color: red"'. Row #4 will use CSS style 'style="font-weight: bold"'. Row #5 will use CSS class 'Row'. Etc.
Set Tag
The Set Tag action is used to set the value of a template variable. This action cannot be used in the non-template languages such as C#, JSP and ColdFusion without Templates.
Property Description
Tag Name Name of the template variable whose value is to be set. Expression Expression that will be used to set the value of the tag.
Validate Email
This action is typically used in conjunction with input fields that receive text values. The action ensures that the value entered is in the valid format of an email address. This action can only be used in the On Validate event.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control that will contain the email address. Error message to be displayed if the input value does not correspond with the format of an email address.
This action is typically used in conjunction with input fields and serves to ensure that the value entered in a field does not exceed a specified number of characters. This action can be used only in the On Validate event.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Error message to be displayed if the maximum length is exceeded.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Error message to be displayed if the input value exceeds the maximum value.
Property
Control Name Error Message
Description
Name of the control to be validated. Error message to be displayed if the input is less than the minimum length.
Property
Control Name
Description
Name of the control to be validated.
Minimum Value Minimum allowable input value. Error Message Error message to be displayed if the input value is less than the minimum value.
Validate Phone
This action is typically used in conjunction with input fields that receive text values. The action ensures that the value entered corresponds with the specified phone number format. This action can only be used in the On Validate event.
Property
Description
200
Control Name Name of the control to be validated. Format Error Message Phone number format used for validation. Default value is (000) 000-0000. Error message to be displayed if the input value does not match the phone number format.
Property
Description
Control Name Name of the control to be validated. Error Message Error message to be displayed if the control has no value.
Validate ZIP
This action ensures that the value entered in an input control corresponds with a specified ZIP code format. This action can only be used in the On Validate event.
Property
Format
Description
Format used for the validation. Default value is 00000.
Control Name Name of the control to be validated. Error Message Error message to be displayed if the input value does not match the ZIP format.
Programming Reference
ASP
Functions
CCAddParam Function (ASP)
Description
Add the parameter with specified value into the GET query string. If the parameter with given name exist its value will be changed for ParameterValue.
Syntax
CCAddParam(QueryString, ParameterName, ParameterValue)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
QueryString
Type
String
Description
Required
ParameterName String
Yes Yes
See also:
CCRemoveParam function CCDLookUp Function (ASP)
Description
Looks up a value from the database by executing a database query against a connection. It queries a database table based on a specified filter and returns the value of the first retrieved field.
Syntax
CCDLookUp(ColumnName, TableName, Where, Connection)
Return value
variant
Parameters
Name Type Description
Database expression to evaluate. In most cases a field name. Name of the database table or view to query. WHERE clause to filter the returned records. Connection object to use for executing the query.
Required
Yes Yes Yes Yes
Example 1
This code would usually be placed in the Before Show event of a Record form.
if tasks.EditMode then tasks.user_id_assign_by.Value = CCDLookUp("emp_name", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(tasks.user_id_assign_by.Value, ccsInteger) , DBIntranetDB) else tasks.user_id_assign_by.Value = CCDLookUp("emp_name", "employees", "emp_id=" &)_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(), ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) end if
Example 2
The following code uses the CCDLookUp function to lookup the sender's name and email address, and the receiver's email address for sending an email using the ASPEmail component. This code would usually be placed in the After Insert event of a Record form.
Dim Mailer
202
Set Mailer = Server.CreateObject("Persits.MailSender") Mailer.From = CCDLookUp("email", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(), ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) Mailer.FromName = CCDLookUp("emp_name", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(), ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) Mailer.AddAddress = CCDLookUp("email", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(tasks.user_id_assign_to.Value, ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) Mailer.Host = "mysmtphost.com" Mailer.IsHTML = True Mailer.Subject = "New task for you" Mailer.Body = "A new task was assigned to you. " Mailer.Send set Mailer = Nothing
Description
Formats a date value according to the specified format mask.
Syntax
CCFormatDate(DateToFormat,FormatMask)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
FormatMask
Type
Array of strings
Description
Date value to format. Each string is one of the following components (all other components are left unchanged when building formatted value): d day w m q y h H n s dd ww week month quarter day of the year hour in 12-hour format hour in 24-hour format minute second zero-filled day week of year
Required
Yes Yes
DateToFormat Date
203
mm yy hh HH nn ss ddd mmm A/P a/p dddd mmmm yyyy AM/PM am/pm LongDate LongTime ShortDate ShortTime
zero-filled month two-digit year zero-filled hour in 12-hour format zero-filled hour in 24-hour format zero-filled minute zero-filled second short weekday name short month name A or P according to AM/PM a or p according to AM/PM weekday name month name year AM or PM am or pm long date format long time format short date format short time format
Example
CCFormatDate(CDate("2002-05-01"),array("LongDate")) -> "May 1, 2002" CCFormatDate(CDate("2002-05-01 20:12"),array("mmm"," ","d",", time is ","hh",":","nn","","AM/PM")) -> "May 1, time is 8:12 PM"
Description
Retrieves a value of the GET input parameter. If there is no value returned, the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetFromGet(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
DefaulfValue
Type
Description
Name of the parameter to retrieve.
Required
Yes
ParameterName String
See also:
CCGetParam function, CCGetFromPost function CCGetFromPost Function (ASP)
Description
Retrieves a value of the POST input parameter. If there is no value returned, the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetFromPost(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
DefaulfValue
Type
Description
Name of the parameter to retrieve.
Required
Yes
ParameterName String
See also:
CCGetParam function, CCGetFromGet function CCGetGroupID Function (ASP)
Description
Retrieves the security group ID value of the currently logged in user.
Syntax
CCGetGroupID()
Return Value
Integer CCGetParam Function (ASP)
Description
Retrieves a value of the GET or POST input parameter. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the GET query string and if no value is returned, then the function checks for a POST input parameter with the same name. If no value is returned by a GET or POST input parameter, the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetParam(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name Type Description
205
Required
Yes
Example 1
This code would usually be placed in the After Initialize event of a Page.
Example 2
The following code disables record updates if a task is not assigned to the current user. CCGetParam function is used to retrieve the current task id from the GET or POST data being submitted. This code would usually be placed in the Before Update event of a Record form.
Dim current_task Dim assigned_user current_task = CCGetParam("task_id", Empty)
CCDLookUp("user_id_assign_to", "tasks", "task_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(current_task, ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) if current_task <> 0 and CCGetUserID <> assigned_user Then
assigned_user = tasks.UpdateAllowed = False end if
See also:
CCGetFromGet function, CCGetFromPost function CCGetUserID Function (ASP)
Description
Retrieves the primary key value that uniquely identifies the currently logged in user.
Syntax
CCGetUserID()
Return Value
String
Example 1
This code would usually be placed in the Before Show event of a Record form.
If tasks.EditMode Then tasks.user_id_assign_by.Value = &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(tasks.user_id_assign_by.Value, ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB)
206
Example 2
The following code uses the CCGetUserID function to lookup the current user's name and email address which is then used for sending an email using the ASPEmail component. This code would usually be placed in the After Insert event of a Record form.
Dim Mailer Set Mailer = Server.CreateObject("Persits.MailSender")
CCDLookUp("email", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(), ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) Mailer.FromName = CCDLookUp("emp_name", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(), ccsInteger), DBIntranetDB) Mailer.AddAddress = CCDLookUp("email", "employees", "emp_id=" &_ DBIntranetDB.ToSQL(tasks.user_id_assign_to.Value, ccsInteger) ,
Mailer.From = DBIntranetDB) Mailer.Host = "mysmtphost.com" Mailer.IsHTML = True Mailer.Subject = "New task for you" Mailer.Body Mailer.Send set Mailer = Nothing = "A new task was assigned to you. "
Description
Retrieves the specified field value from the current row of a recordset.
Syntax
CCGetValue(RecordSet,FieldName)
Return Value
String
Parameters
Name Type Description
Field name or field index whose value is to be retrieved.
Required
Yes Yes
RecordSet ADODB.Recordset Recordset to retrieve the value from. FieldName String or Integer CCOpenRS Function (ASP)
Description
Opens a new recordset based on a specified SQL query. 207
Syntax
CCOpenRS(RecordSet,SQL, Connection,ShowError)
Parameters
String (error message)
Parameters
Name Type Description
Variable in which the recordset will be returned. The SQL query to be used to select records for the recordset. Connection object to execute the query against.
Required
Yes Yes Yes
Description
Parses the specified date string into a date value according to the specified date format.
Syntax
CCParseDate(ParsingDate,FormatMask)
Return value
Date
Parameters
Name Type Description
Date to parse. Format mask to parse the date with.
Required
Yes Yes
ParsingDate String FormatMask Array of strings (see CCFormatDate for available patterns)
Example
CCParseDate("2002 May 1",array("yyyy"," ","mmm"," ","d")) -> #2002-05-01#
Description
Returns a text description of the last error for the current connection or 'Empty' if the error collection is empty.
Syntax
CCProcessError(Connection)
Return value
208
String
Parameters
Name Type Description
Connection object to get the errors.
Required
Yes
Description
Removes a parameter from the GET query string.
Syntax
CCRemoveParam(QueryString, ParameterName)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
QueryString
Type Description
Required
Yes
See also:
CCAddParam function IIf Function (ASP)
Description
Evaluates an expression and returns one of two results, depending on whether the expression is True or False.
Syntax
IIf(Expression,TrueResult,FalseResult)
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
Yes Expression Boolean Expression to be evaluated.
TrueResult Variant Result to be returned if the expression is True. Yes FalseResult Variant Result to be returned if the expression is False. Yes
Example
IIf(2>1,"yes","no") -> "yes"
Methods
AddComponents Run-Time Method (ASP)
Applies to
Panel 209
Syntax
object.AddComponents(Components)
Parameters
Name
Components
Type
Array
Description
Array contains components.
Required
Yes
Description
This method binds components to the panel object.
Example
Panel1.AddComponents(Array(Label1,TextBox1,Grid1))
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>.Close
Description
This method closes a database connection and releases its resources. This method should always be called after a currently open database connection is no longer needed. However, this should be done with connections that were created manually only or if page processing is finished because of user's redirection for instance.
Examples
This example closes database connection and redirects to a root website URL. This may be used if some fatal page requirement is not met (required parameter for instance). It assumes connection is called Connection1.
DBConnection1.Close Response.Redirect "/" Response.End
See also
Redirect Variable Before Unload Event Execute Method (ASP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>.Execute query Set <recordset> = <connection>.Execute(query)
Return value
ADODB.Recordset
Parameters
Name Type Description
210
Required
String containing an SQL query to be executed against the database or an ADODB.Command object to execute.
Yes
Description
This method executes a specified SQL query against the database connection. The first syntax shown above is used when the query will not return a recordset (e.g. INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE queries). The second syntax is used when the query will return a recordset object (e.g. SELECT query).
Examples
The following example opens a custom recordset to build a list of groups the user belongs to (comma-separated). Recordset is iterated, string built and assigned to record's label control. It assumes groups and group_users tables exist. Connection is called Connection1. UserProfile form and UserGroups label are assumed to exist. This code may be inserted into label's Before Show event.
Dim rsGroups Dim strGroups Dim SQL strGroups = "" SQL = "SELECT group_name FROM group_users gu LEFT JOIN groups g ON gu.group_id = g.group_id "&_ "WHERE gu.user_id = " & DBConnection1.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(),ccsInteger) Set rsGroups = DBConnection1.Execute(SQL) While rsGroups.EOF strGroups = IIf(strGroups = "", rsGroups("group_name"), ", " & rsGroups("group_name")) rsGroups.MoveNext Wend UserProfile.UserGroups.Value = strGroups
See also
DataSource.SQL Property GetEvents Method (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
Set ev =
object.GetEvents DateEvents
Return value
object
Parameters
Name
DateEvents
Type Description
date Specifies the date for which the events should be returned.
Required
Yes
Description
This method returns calendar events for the specified date. 211
Examples
The following example shows how to retrieve events for current date.
Dim DayEvents Set DayEvents = Calendar1.GetEvents(Calendar1.CurrentProcessingDate)) If DayEvents Is Nothing Then Calendar1.label1.Value="" Else Calendar1.label1.Value=DayEvents.Count End If
See also
CalendarSetEvent GetOriginFileName Method (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
object.GetOriginFileName
Description
This method retrieves the original file name of an uploaded file (i.e. without the prefix that is added to ensure that the file name is unique). This function can be used to display the original file name to the user or construct alternative save names.
Examples
The following example constructs an uploaded file download link with a specific label containing original file name and size. It assumes the form is named Form1 and the upload control is named FileUpload1. DownloadLink is a link control.
If Form1.FileUpload1.IsUploaded Then Form1.DownloadLink.Link = Form1.FileUpload1.Value Form1.DownloadLink.Value = "download " & Form1.FileUpload1.GetOriginFileName(Form1.FileUpload1.Value) & " [" & Form1.FileUpload1.FileSize & "]" End If
See also
Value Property FileFolder Property Get Original Filename Action Open Method (ASP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
212
<connection>.Open
Description
This method establishes a database connection. If the user creates a custom connection object, this method should be called to initialize the database connection.
Examples
This example creates a custom connection.
Dim customConn customConn.ConnectionString = "Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;Data Source=" & Server.MapPath("database.mdb") customConn.Open
See also
ConnectionString Property SetEvent Method (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
object.SetEvent DateEvent, CalendarEvent
Parameters
Name
DateEvent CalendarEvent
Type
date object
Description
Specifies the date of the event Specifies a event.
Required
Yes Yes
Description
This method adds a new event to the Calendar events collection.
See also
CalendarEvents SetVar Methods (ASP)
Applies to
Template object
Syntax
<object>.SetVar VariableName,Value
Return value
None
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
Yes Yes VariableName string Specifies the template block or variable name in the template file bound to the template object. Value string Specifies a value that should replace the template block or variable provided as the first argument. 213
Description
This method replaces a template block or a variable defined in the template file with the value provided as the second argument. A template variable is an identifier surrounded by curly braces (i.e. {templ_variable}. A template block is a part of the template file surrounded by two special HTML comments. One that starts the block: <!-- BEGIN block_name --> and the other that ends the block: <!-- END block_name -->. Note: If there are multiple template blocks or variables with the same name, SetVar will replace all of them with the same value. ToSQL Method (ASP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>.ToSQL(Value, DataType)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type
Value any
Description
A value to be converted to SQL compatible format. Desired data type.
Required
Yes
Data Type
The data type the value will be converted to. You can use any of the predefined constants: ccsDate, ccsBoolean, ccsInteger, ccsFloat, ccsText, ccsMemo
Yes
Description
This method converts values to the specified data type in order to make them SQL compatible.
Run-Time Properties
AllowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/rite
Syntax
object.AllowedFileMasks [= value]
Description
Specifies a list of file masks (separated with semicolon) that are allowed by the FileUpload component. If a user tries to upload a file with a mask that matches one of the masks specified in this property, the file will be uploaded (unless the mask is also listed in the DisallowedFileMasks property). Otherwise, the upload will fail and an error message will be displayed. The 214
AllowedFileMasks property corresponds to the "Allowed File Masks" Design-Time property of the FileUpload component.
Example
The AfterInitialize event procedure shown below alters the AllowedFileMasks property for logged and not logged in users. Anonymous users are allowed to upload only text files (txt), logged in users may upload any file.
Function Page_AfterInitialize() If CCGetUserID() = Empty Then attachments.fu.AllowedFileMasks = "*.txt" Else attachments.fu.AllowedFileMasks = "*" End if End Function
See also
DisallowedFileMasks Property CalendarStyles Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
dictionary
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.CalendarStyles
Description
Contains the calendar styles that depend on the builder settings. Note: This property can be modified in the Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to change some styles.
Calendar1.CalendarStyles("Day") = "class = 'CellWithBlackText'"; Calendar1.CalendarStyles("Today") = "class = 'CellWithRedText'";
See also
CurrentStyle property Components Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Panel
Type
dictionary 215
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Components
Description
Contains all children of the current panel. Can be used to iterate through all children.
Example
The following example iterates through panel controls and sets their Visible property to False.
Dim Ctrl, Key For Each Key in Panel1.Components Set Ctrl = Panel1.Components(Key)
Applies to
Connection Object
Type
object (ADODB.Connection)
Access
Read-only
Syntax
object.Connection.<member>...
Description
Retrieves ADO Connection object used to access underlying database. This object can be used to perform some low-level database operations not exposed by wrapping Connection Object. They may include extracting some database-specific settings and attributes or starting and closing transactions for instance. For complete listing of properties and methods for this object refer to ActiveX Data Objects Reference available from Microsoft's website.
Examples
The following ADO Connection object's methods can be used to start transaction, rollback it or commit the results. Transaction is a set of database operations that have to be executed as a whole, if one fails previous ones should be reverted.
DBInternetDB.Connection.BeginTrans DBInternetDB.Connection.RollbackTrans DBInternetDB.Connection.CommitTrans
See also
Execute Method ConnectionString Property 216
Applies to
Connection Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.ConnectionString [=value]
Description
This property contains connection string used to establish database connection. This string includes connection type, user credentials, database name or path and some other parameters. The connection string is passed to ADO Connection object when opening. This property can be modified if some database connection properties are determined during runtime. For complete connection string syntax refer to ActiveX Data Objects Reference available from Microsoft's website. Note: For property change to take effect connection object has to be closed and reopened.
Examples
This example modifies connection's ConnectionString property to use MS Access driver and database path extracted from a session variable.
DBConnection1.ConnectionString = "Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;Data Source=" & Session("DatabasePath") DBConnection1.Close DBConnection1.Open
See also
Connection Property CurrentDate Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.CurrentDate [= value]
Description
Specifies the date shown in the calendar. For example, for the Monthly calendar the date can be any date of this month. Note: The value of this property can be modified in the Page's Before Show event.
Examples
217
The following example shows how to make the calendar always show January 2005.
Calendar1.CurrentDate = DateSerial(2005, 1, 1)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read
Syntax
object.CurrentProcessingDate
Description
Specifies the current processing date. The value of this property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month, and Before Show events.
See also
PrevProcessingDate property, NextProcessingDate property CurrentStyle Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.CurrentStyle [= value]
Description
Contains the calendar style of the currently processed block. Note: The value of this property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month, and Before Show events.
Examples
The following example shows how to change style.
Calendar1.CurrentStyle = "class = 'CellWithBlackText'"
See also
CalendarStyles property DataSource Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
218
Grid Form, ListBox Control, RadioButton Control, CheckboxList Control, Navigator Control, Record Form, EditableGrid Form, Directory Form, Path Form
Type
Data Source Object
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.DataSource [= value]
Description
This property stores reference to data source bound to the specified object. Data source handles all data retrieval and update operations. It serves as an abstraction layer that hides underlying data source details, whether it is a database, a list of values or even a web service. It is common to use this property to access field values from within bound objects. DataSource object provides properties (i.e. SQL, Where, Order) that can be used to modify the SQL query that is executed in order to provide data for the object.
Examples
This example shows how the SQL property of the DataSource object can be modified to alter the list of values extracted from the database. Note: the syntax used to concatenate two fields (firstname and lastname) into the name field is not recognized by the standard of SQL language (here it is used for Access database only).
Function customers_DataSource_BeforeBuildSelect() customers.DataSource.Sql = "SELECT customer_id, (firstname & ' ' & lastname) AS name, city FROM customers" End Function
See also
Connection Property DataSource.SQL DataSource.Where DataSource.Order
Related Examples
Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause DataSource.CountSQL Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
DataSource Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
219
object.DataSource.CountSQL [=value]
Description
Stores the main part of the SQL query that is used to find the number of records fetched by DataSource object. This property does not include the WHERE clause. Before the query is executed, conditions from the Where and WhereParameters properties are used instead. Note: The usual content of this property includes the COUNT aggregate function: SELECT COUNT(*) FROM ...
See Also
DataSource.SQL Property DataSource.Where Property Recordset.RecordCount Property DataSource.Order Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
DataSource object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.DataSource.Order [=value]
Description
This property holds the list of fields that are used in the ORDER BY clause of the SELECT query. CCS initializes this property internally, for example if an order option has been specified in the properties of the form. Modification of this field (before the query is executed) will change the order of the results.
Example
The sample code below assigns default sorting field to the Order property if the property has not been initialized earlier.
Function Page_AfterInitialize() If articles.DataSource.Order = Empty Then articles.DataSource.Order = "date_add" End if End Function
See also
DataSource.SQL property DataSource.Where property
Related Examples
Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause DataSource.SQL Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
DataSource object
Type
220
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.DataSource.SQL [=value]
Description
This property stores the main part of a query that retrieves data for the form. The main part usually includes the actual SQL command (SELECT), list of fields to be retrieved and a list of tables from which the data will be retrieved (FROM). The SQL query is eventually built as concatenation of SQL, Where and Order properties. To modify the SQL property (alter the SQL query), you should use the BeforeBuildSelect event procedure of the form.
Examples
This example shows how the SQL property of the DataSource object can be modified to alter the list of values extracted from the database. Note: The syntax used to concatenate two fields (firstname and lastname) into the name field is not recognized by the standard of SQL language (here it is used for Access database only).
customers.DataSource.SQL = "SELECT customer_id, (firstname & ' ' & lastname) AS name, city FROM customers"
See also
DataSource property DataSource.Where property DataSource.Order property DataSource.Where Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
DataSource Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.DataSource.Where [=value]
Description
This property stores all conditions that are eventually used in the WHERE clause of a query that selects, updates or deletes data from the database. Programmers can add their own conditions (preserving the SQL syntax) in one of the events triggered before the final query is built and executed (i.e. BeforeBuildSelect, BeforeBuildDelete, BeforeBuildUpdate).
See also
DataSource.SQL property DataSource.Order property
Related Examples
221
Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause Retrieve Values From a Multi-Select ListBox DeleteAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.DeleteAllowed [= value]
Description
This property contains a Boolean value that determines if the form has record delete operation enabled. This affects Delete button displaying and database delete operations. If security is configured for the site and the form's Restricted property has been set to "Yes", the default delete operation permission depends on current user's group permissions. If Restricted property is set to No then DeleteAllowed property is set to True unless modified in Before Delete event event. This property may be set according to a custom permissions checking scheme to enable or disable delete record operation. The delete button is hidden only if the value is set before the form's Before Show event (for instance in the parent component). Requested delete operation may be cancelled in Before Delete event if the DeleteAllowed property is set to false.
Examples
The following example checks if the order record that is requested to be removed belongs to the currently logged in user. If it does, the operation is carried out. Otherwise, the delete database operation is not performed. The example assumes DeleteOrder form exists and user_id hidden field to store the owner's identifier is inserted. This code may be inserted into Before Delete event.
If DeleteOrder.user_id.Value = CCGetUserID() Then DeleteOrder.DeleteAllowed = True Else DeleteOrder.DeleteAllowed = False End If
See also
Before Delete Event ReadAllowed Property InsertAllowed Property UpdateAllowed Property DisallowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
222
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.DisallowedFileMasks [= value]
Description
Specifies a list of file masks (separated by semicolons) that are not allowed by the FileUpload component. File mask item may contain * and ? characters for matching any characters. If a user provides a file with a name that matches one of the masks specified in this property, the file will not be uploaded and an error message will be displayed. The verification is performed during control validation, before calling the control's On Validate event. The result of the check may be reset during this event. The DisallowedFileMasks property corresponds to the "Disallowed File Masks" Design-Time property of the FileUpload component. Note: The DisallowedFileMasks property has higher priority than AllowedFileMasks property. In other words, if a mask is mentioned in both properties (AllowedFileMasks and DisallowedFileMasks) the upload will fail.
Examples
The following example resets disallowed file masks if the user's security level is higher than 1. Otherwise, HTML, ASP and ZIP files are restricted.
If CCGetGroupID() > 1 Then Record1.FileUpload1.DisallowedFileMasks = "" Else Record1.FileUpload1.DisallowedFileMasks = "*.html;*.asp;*.zip" End If
See also
OnValidate event AllowedFileMasks property EditMode Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.EditMode
Description
This property determines whether given record form is currently in edit or insert mode. In edit mode all data source parameters need to have values assigned (including row identifier). In insert mode some data items may be empty.
See also
223
Errors property
Example
The following code (placed in the OnValidate event procedure ) checks the state of the modified_by form field and generates an error message if the field is empty. Thanks to the EditMode property, custom verification takes place only if the record is updated (not inserted).
Function articles_OnValidate() If articles.EditMode and IsEmpty(articles.modified_by.Value) Then articles.Errors.AddError("The modified_by field cannot be empty when updating.") End if End Function
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.EmptyRows [=value]
Description
Specifies the number of empty rows displayed at the bottom of the editable grid. Each empty row allows the user to insert a new record into the database. The more empty rows, the more records can be inserted at once. Users may modify this property to change the number of empty rows according to their preferences, or to display a constant number of rows (editable and empty ones) on the form.
Examples
The following code sets the number of empty rows according to session variable that stores the preferred number of insertable rows. This code should be placed in editable grid's Before Show event.
Dim RowsNum RowsNum = Session("NoRowsToInsert") If IsNumeric(RowsNum) AND NOT IsEmpty(RowsNum) Then InvoiceRowsGrid.EmptyRows = RowsNum Else InvoiceRowsGrid.EmptyRows = 1 End If
Applies to
ReportLabel Control 224
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.EmptyText
Description
Specifies the text to be output when the label value is empty.
Example
ReportLabel1.EmptyText = "xxx"
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Type
array of strings
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.ErrorMessages(<index>) [=value]
Description
This property is used to collect error messages from all rows of the editable grid. The index of the ErrorMessages array corresponds to the row number in the editable grid (on the given page). Messages are inserted to the table while each row values are validated. If the validation is successful (all data is correct) - the property is empty, otherwise its content is used to display error messages above the rows that did not pass the validation. Users may modify this array by either resetting existing messages or replacing the existing with custom ones. Either grid's Before Show or On Validate events can be used for this modification.
Examples
The following code replaces all specific validation error messages in the editable grid with plain "This line needs to be corrected".
Dim i For i = 1 To UBound(OrderItems.ErrorMessages) If Not IsEmpty(OrderItems.ErrorMessages(i)) Then OrderItems.ErrorMessages(i) = "This line needs to be corrected" End If Next
See also
Errors property OnValidate event Errors Run-Time Property (ASP) 225
Applies to
Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Connection Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Control, FileUpload Control
Type
object (clsErrors)
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.Errors.<member>...
Description
This property keeps the reference to the object's errors collection. This collection is used to collect error messages generated during the object's execution. Errors collection exposes three important members:
Member
Errors.Count
Description
This property returns the number of errors the collection contains. It can be used for testing if the collection is empty or contains any error messages.
Errors.AddError <message> This method adds specified error message to the collection. It can be used to insert error messages when performing custom validation. Errors.Clear This method resets the collection removing all previously added error messages. It can be used to force successful form submit processing despite validation errors or to clear error messages before replacing them with custom ones.
Examples
The following code checks if the errors collection is empty. If there are any error messages, all of them are replaced with a customized one. The code assumes OrderForm form exists on the page. This code may be inserted into On Validate event.
If OrderForm.Errors.Count > 0 Then OrderForm.Errors.Clear OrderForm.Errors.AddError "This order cannot be processed. Please fix it." End If
See also
On Validate event
Related Examples
Using the Control Validation event Using the Form Validation event Retrieve Multiple Field Values from a Database Events Run-Time Property (ASP) 226
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
object
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Events
Description
Contains the calendar events. This value can be manually modified. Note: The value of this property can be also modified in Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to add new event.
Dim CustomEvent, CustomEventDateTime Set CustomEvent = New clsEventCalendar1 CustomEventDateTime = DateSerial(2005, 10, 31) CustomEvent.EventTime = TimeSerial(12, 30, 0) CustomEvent.EventDescription = "Some text" AddEvent CustomEventDateTime, CustomEvent
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.FileFolder [=value]
Description
Specifies a folder on the web server where uploaded files will be eventually stored. The initial value of this property comes from the "File Folder" design-time property of the FileUpload component. This property may be used to specify different target folders for keeping different file types or to sort uploads in different folders for different users. The property should be set in Before Process File event. Note: The property's value is set only if the pointed folder exists. Absolute filesystem paths should be used to avoid context ambiguities. Server.MapPath method can be used to determine the absolute folder path.
Examples
The following example checks if the uploaded file extension is JPG. If so, the file will be saved into images subdirectory. Otherwise, the file will saved into uploads subdirectory. 227
The code assumes Form1 form exists and it contains FileUpload1 control. This code can be inserted into control's Before Process File event.
If UCase(Right(Form1.FileUpload1.Value, 4)) = ".JPG" Then Form1.FileUpload1.FileFolder = Server.MapPath("./images/") Else Form1.FileUpload1.FileFolder = Server.MapPath("./uploads/") End If
See also
TemporaryFolder property Value property Before Process File event FileName Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator
Type
String
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.FileName [=value]
Description
Specifies the URL of the page to which the navigator is linked. Note 1: This property can be used in the Before Show event of the CalendarNavigator or Calendar components. Note 2: The value of this property contains/specifies only the file name (without paramemters). FileSize Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Component
Type
number
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.FileSize
Description
Specifies the size (in bytes) of the file that has been uploaded to the server. Value of this property is set while the file is processed by the server and it is used later on to verify if the size of the file is not greater than the specified file size limit (held in the FileSizeLimit property).
Example
The following AfterProcessFile event procedure adds the file size value (as the GET parameter) to the redirection URL (see the Redirect variable reference): 228
Function attachments_fu_AfterProcessFile() Redirect = Redirect & "filesize=" & attachments.fu.FileSize End Function
See also
FileSizeLimit property FileSizeLimit Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Component
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.FileSizeLimit [=value]
Description
Specifies the maximum size (in bytes) of a file that can be uploaded to the server. If the size of the uploaded file is greater than value of this property, the upload fails and appropriate error message is displayed. Note: the initial value of this property comes from the "File Size Limit" design-time property of the FileUpload component.
Example
The sample code below (inside the AfterInitialize event procedure of the page) sets a new file size limit for the file upload control (fu). The new value of the limit is taken from maxfilesize session variable. (Such variable can be set, for example, in the OnClick server-side event procedure of the Login button, after the user has been successfully authenticated):
Function Page_AfterInitialize() Dim mfs mfs = Session("maxfilesize") If Not IsEmpty(mfs) Then attachments.fu.FileSizeLimit = mfs End if End Function
See also
FileSize property Format Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control,
Type
array of variants 229
Access
read-write
Syntax
object.Format [=value]
Description
Holds constraints used to translate the control's value from its internal state to the required public representation. FormSubmitted Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Record Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.FormSubmitted
Description
This property determines whether record processing is performed in initial show or in postback mode. In show mode, the records fields are assigned data sources value (or none). In postback mode, user provided data is available for processing. Height Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Section Control
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Height
Description
Specifies the height of the section in abstract "line" units.
Example
Report_Footer.Height = 1.2
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write 230
Syntax
object.InsertAllowed [=value]
Description
This property contains a Boolean flag that if true, allows insert database operations. This property should be changed to false in Before Insert (or On Validate) event to prevent a form from creating a new record in the database if the user's custom data verification fails.
See also
UpdateAllowed property DeleteAllowed property ReadAllowed property IsFormSubmitted Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.IsFormSubmitted
Description
This property determines whether editable grid processing is performed in show or in postback mode. In show mode, the grids fields are assigned values from the data source (or none when inserting). In postback mode, user provided data is available for processing. This property may be used to specify different behavior in show and in postback mode. Using this property in combination with EditMode property allows to determine all possible form states. Note: Usually, the browser is redirected (using Return Page property setting) after successful submit processing and any modifications made to form's view depending on IsFormSubmitted = true condition will be visible only if validation fails.
Examples
The following example displays specific warning message when the form is in failed validation mode. If validation succeeds, no visible effects are output and the browser is redirected. The code assumes the grid is called EditableGrid1, the label which will display the error message is called Label1. This code may be used in form's Before Show event.
If EditableGrid1.IsFormSubmitted Then EditableGrid1.Label1.Value = "Please don't use browser's Refresh button.<br>Correct validation errors and resubmit." End If
See also
EditMode property IsPercent Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
231
Report Form,
Type
boolean
Access
read
Syntax
object.IsPercent
Description
Specifies whether the report label value should be output as the percentage of corresponding total value.
Example
If ReportLabel1.IsPercent Then _ ReportLabel1.Text "<b>" & ReportLabel1.Text & "</b>"
See also
TotalFunction property IsUploaded Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
Boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.IsUploaded
Description
This property holds upload control's state. If a file is being processed after submitting the form, or a file has been previously uploaded, this property is set to true. If no file has been uploaded, the property is set to false. This property may be used to handle different file upload component behavior when it is populated and when it is empty. For instance, the FileUpload component may be hidden if a file has been previously uploaded and the user has no permissions to delete it. In case a file exists, additional information may be extracted from the filesystem to be displayed by another control (modification date for instance).
Examples
The following example retrieves the file's creation date and assigns it to a label if upload control is populated. This example assumes Form1 record contains FileUpload1 upload control. Label1 control is assigned a value depending on the file's date.
If Form1.FileUpload1.IsUploaded Then Dim fso Set fso = Server.CreateObject("Scripting.FileSystemObject")
232
See also
FileSize property FileFolder property Value property GetOriginFileName method Link Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Link Control, ImageLink Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Link [=value]
Description
The Link property stores the URL (including the query string) that is assigned to the HREF attribute of the HTML link (<a...> tag). This property is used only by the Link and Image Link controls. When read, the link value is constructed as concatenation of two components: one that holds the bare URL (Page property) and the other one that stores the query string (Parameters property). When written, the new value is split into the URL part and query string part. After the assignment, new URL is available through the Page property and new query string is available through the Parameters property. Important: The assigned value must be a proper link. For example the query string must not include question marks (?). Such corrupt query string will be ignored.
Examples
The following example changes the link's label and hyperlink depending on whether hidden field is set or not. Either link to parent category edit page is provided, or if edited category is top level, the link points to categories listing page. The example assumes EditCategoryForm exists on EditCategory page. There is ParentLink link control inserted and parent_id hidden field. Categories is a page that lists all top-level categories navigated if no parent category is specified in the record.
If Not IsEmpty(EditCategoryForm.parent_id.Value) Then EditCategoryForm.ParentLink.Value = "go to parent category" EditCategoryForm.ParentLink.Link = "EditCategory.asp?parent_id=" & EditCategoryForm.parent_id.Value Else EditCategoryForm.ParentLink.Value = "root category (go to listing)" EditCategoryForm.ParentLink.Link = "Categories.asp" End If
233
Another example changes the link's target address depending on whether the user is logged in or not. Either link to login page or to the user's profile page is given. This example assumes there is WelcomeLink control inserted within common includable page called Header. If the user is logged in, a link to EditProfile page is provided (and the link's label is changed). If the user is not logged in, a login prompt is displayed and Login page link is provided.
If CCGetUserID() Then Header.WelcomeLink.Value = "Welcome " & CCGetUserLogin() Header.WelcomeLink.Link = "EditProfile.asp" Else Header.WelcomeLink.Value = "Please log in" Header.WelcomeLink.Link = "Login.asp" End If
See also
Value property NextProcessingDate Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read
Syntax
object.NextProcessingDate
Description
Specifies the next processing date to the current one. This property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month and Before Show events.
See also
CurrentPrevDate property, CurrentProcessingDate property NumberOfColumns Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Directory Form
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.NumberOfColumns [=value]
Description
This property contains the number of columns the directory should be split into. Depending on the property's value, categories are split into a number of columns containing similar number of categories. 234
This property can be used to enable directory layout selection depending on user's preference or on the total number of categories.
Example
The following example sets the number of columns depending on the number of subcategories listed by the directory. The number of columns is increased with each 50 subcategories listed. Actual number of columns depends on the number of categories. There cannot be more columns than categories. The example assumes Directory1 form exists. The code can be put into directory's Before Show event.
Directory1.NumberOfColumns = Directory1.Recordset.RecordCount \ 50
See also
NumberOfSubCategories Property Recordset.RecordCount Property Change Number Of Columns Action NumberOfSubCategories Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Directory Form
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.NumberOfSubCategories [=value]
Description
This property contains the maximum number of subcategories displayed for each category. If the number of subcategories is greater than the value of this property, the remaining subcategories will be listed only after navigating their parent category. This property can be used to allow directory layout selection depending on user's preference.
See also
NumberOfColumns property Password Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Password [=value]
Description
235
This property contains the password used to authenticate database access together with a user name. In some cases user name and password are included within ConnectionString property.
See also
User property PageNumber Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Report Form,
Type
Number
Access
read
Syntax
object.PageNumber
Description
Retrieves the current page number of the report.
Example
label1.Value = Report1.PageNumber
Applies to
Report Form,
Type
Number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.PageSize
Description
Specifies the page size for the report in print mode.
Example
Report1.PageSize = 100
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
236
object.PressedButton [=value]
Description
This property contains the name of the button pressed to submit the form being processed. This value is only set when operating in postback processing mode (it is not set when navigating page without submit). The name of the button pressed is the same as the records member variable handling button requests (if the button name is Update there is a records member variable Update of type clsButton).
See also
EditMode property PrevProcessingDate Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read
Syntax
object.PrevProcessingDate
Description
Specifies the previous processing date to the current one. The property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month and Before Show events.
See also
CurrentProcessingDate and NextProcessingDate properties ReadAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.ReadAllowed [=value]
Description
This property contains a Boolean flag that if set to true, prevents displaying record's data. If the property is set to true, the form is working in insert mode regardless of the passed parameters. This property may be used to prevent users from viewing particular records. Personal entries can be protected using custom code that resets this property. The property's value has to be set in the form's Before Select event or earlier.
Examples
The following example allows users to browse only their own records. The example assumes DiaryEntry form exists and there is author_id hidden field to keep record's 237
author identifier. This code may be inserted into Before Select event or earlier (form's Before Show is called after property checking).
If DiaryEntry.author_id.Value = CCGetUserID() Then DiaryEntry.ReadAllowed = True Else DiaryEntry.ReadAllowed = False End If
See also
Before Select event UpdateAllowed property DeleteAllowed property InsertAllowed property Recordset Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, EditableGrid Form, Directory Form, Path Form
Type
clsDataSource or ADODB.Recordset
Access
read-only
Syntax
object.Recordset.<member>...
Description
This property contains objects recordset used to iterate rows in the data source result. This property isn't accessed directly. Only its members are useful for retrieving data set information. For complete listing of properties and methods for this object refer to ActiveX Data Objects Reference available from Microsoft's website.
Example
The following example retrieves the number of records of the grid and assigns the value to a pagelevel Label control. The example assumes articles grid and page-level articles_count Label to store the message exist on the page. This code may be used in form's After Execute Select event or in label's Before Show event.
articles_count.Value = "Articles in total: " & articles.Recordset.RecordCount
See also
Recordset.RecordCount property Recordset.RecordCount Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Recordset Object
Type
number 238
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Recordset.RecordCount [=value]
Description
This property provides the total number of records fetched from the database. After the database operation has been performed (for example in the After Execute Select event), the property's value can be modified to limit the number of records displayed on the page. (Assigning value to the property before the database operation is executed gives no effect - the property is overwritten after selecting data from the database).
Example
The following example retrieves the number of records of the grid and assigns the value to a pagelevel Label control. The example assumes articles grid and page-level articles_count label to store the message exist on the page. This code may be used in form's After Execute Select event or in the Label's Before Show event.
articles_count.Value = "Articles in total: " & articles.Recordset.RecordCount
See Also
CountSQL property Recordset property Retrieve Number Of Records action RowNumber Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Report Form,
Type
Number
Access
read
Syntax
object.RowNumber
Description
Retrieves the current row number of the report.
Example
label1.Value = Report1.RowNumber
Applies to
Checkbox Control
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write 239
Syntax
object.State [=value]
Description
This property stores the current state of the control (it may hold one of the two values that correspond to checked and unchecked state of the control).
Examples
The sample code below sets the "checked" state of the control (in the BeforeShow event procedure of the checkbox control) if a new article is edited (no article_id value has been passed to the page):
If not Len(CCGetParam("article_id","")) > 0 Then articles.Verified_cb.State = articles.Verified_cb.CheckedValue End if
See also
Value property TemporaryFolder Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.TemporaryFolder [=value]
Description
This property specifies the temporary directory the uploaded file will be stored into before being moved to the target directory defined in FileFolder property. This property may be changed if some specific conditions happen. For instance, if there is not enough space in the default temporary directory, the alternate location can be used. Note: The value for the property is set only if the pointed folder exists. Absolute filesystem paths should be used to avoid context ambiguities.
Examples
The following example checks if the uploaded file is bigger than 1MB and selects the temporary folder depending on this condition. This code assumes Form1 form exists and it contains FileUpload1 upload control. The code may be inserted into parent form's Before Update or Before Insert events.
If Form1.FileUpload1.FileSize > 1024*1024 Then Form1.FileUpload1.TemporaryFolder = "c:\temp\" Else Form1.FileUpload1.TemporaryFolder = "c:\windows\temp\" End If
See also
FileFolder property 240
Applies to
ReportLabel Control,
Type
string
Access
read
Syntax
object.TotalFunction
Description
Specifies the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated. The default value is empty string.
Type Description
(none) No function will be used. Sum The report label value will be calculated as the sum of previous row values. Count If the Control Source is empty the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows. Otherwise the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows with nonempty values. Min Max Avg The value will be calculated as the minimum of previous row values. The value will be calculated as the maximum of previous row values. The value will be calculated as the average of non-empty values from previous rows.
Example
If ReportLabel1.TotalFunction = "Sum" Then _ ReportLabel1.Text "<b>" & ReportLabel1.Text & "</b>"
See also
IsPercent property UpdateAllowed Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.UpdateAllowed [=value]
Description
This property contains record update permission flag. If set to True, record update operation is permitted. 241
This property is set depending on the user's group permissions if the form's Restricted property is set to Yes during design time. If Restricted property is set to No, UpdateAllowed property is always True unless modified in the Before Update event. This property may be set according to some custom permission checking scheme to enable or disable record update operation. The update button is hidden only if the value is set before form's Before Show event is called (for instance in parent component's or Before Select event). Database update operation may be cancelled if the property is set to false in Before Update event.
Examples
The following example checks if the ad that is edited belongs to the currently logged in user. If it does, the update operation is carried out. Otherwise, the update operation is not performed. The example assumes EditAd form exists and user_id hidden field that stores the owner's identifier is inserted. This code may be inserted into Before Update event.
If EditAd.user_id.Value = CCGetUserID() Then EditAd.UpdateAllowed = True Else EditAd.UpdateAllowed = False End If
See also
InsertAllowed property DeleteAllowed property ReadAllowed property User Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.User [=value]
Description
This property contains a user name used to authenticate database connection access. For some providers both user name and password are included in a connection string.
Examples
The following example opens database connection to the database file located in the current directory using specified user account data. This code may be inserted into the page's After Initialize event to open additional page-specific connection object.
Dim DBConnection1 DBConnection1.ConnectionString = "Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;Data Source=" & Server.MapPath("database.mdb") DBConnection1.User = "admin" DBConnection1.Password = "SeCrEt" DBConnection1.Open
242
See also
ConnectionString property Password property Value Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Form, Hidden Control, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, FileUpload Control
Type
variant
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Value [=value]
Description
Holds the raw value of the control. When written, converts the new value to the data type corresponding to the DataType property. For ccsDate, ccsBoolean, ccsInteger, ccsFloat, ccsText and ccsMemo in ASP, the following VBScript conversion functions are used repectively: CDate, CBool, CLng, CDbl, CStr. Since the checkbox control (ControlType = ccsCheckBox) value is stored in the State variable, special processing is required for this type of control. The checkbox control may store only one of two values defined in CheckedValue and UncheckedValue properties. Any value assigned to the checkbox control that does not match the CheckedValue property is automatically converted to the UncheckedValue value.
Example
This example shows the code placed in the BeforeShowRow event procedure that forces the grid field (income) to display the sum of all fields' values before the currently processed one (including the current one). The sum variable must be declared and initialized as a global variable at the beginning of the script module.
Function freport_BeforeShowRow() sum = sum + freport.income.Value freport.income.Value = sum End Function
See also
Link property
Related Examples
Displaying Output Add Custom HTML to a Page Change Control Value Changing Table Cell Color Create a Grid Column with a Calculated Value ViewMode Run-Time Property (ASP)
Applies to
Report Form, 243
Type
String
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.ViewMode
Description
Retrieves or specifies the report's view mode.
Type Description
Print The report will be displayed in print view mode. Web The report will be displayed in Web view mode.
Example
Report1.ViewMode = "Print"
Applies to
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Form, Hidden Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Form, Directory Form, FileUpload Control, Panel
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object.Visible [=value]
Description
Specifies whether the control is visible. Setting this field to false will prevent the object from being displayed. Note: Property is tested before calling Before Show event. In order for the property change to be taken into consideration it should be set before Before Show event is called, for instance in the parent component's Before Show event. Note: Most of the controls need Extended HTML property checked in order to be hidden. This property is available after selecting Edit ... from the context menu of the control during designtime.
Example
The sample code below (placed in the AfterInitialize event procedure of the page) hides the articles grid if the web page is displayed by an anonymous (not logged in) user.
Function Page_AfterInitialize() If IsEmpty(CCGetUserID()) Then articles.Visible = false
244
Related Examples
Hiding a Grid If No Records are Found Hiding a Record Form Control
Variables
DB<connectionname> Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
object (clsDB<connectionname>)
Access
read-only
Syntax
DB<connectionname>.<member>...
Description
This global variable is declared at the beginning of the page to represent each database connection used within the page. The Connection object encapsulates the implementation details used to establish a database connection (i.e. database name, location, user login/password, etc). The database connection variable can be used to perform custom database operations (e.g. it is used as the fourth argument of the CCDLookUp function). The name of the database connection object is created by prepending the connection name (configured in the CCS environment) with the prefix "DB". (e.g. for a connection called Internet within CodeCharge Studio, the corresponding variable name for the connection object will be DBInternet).
Example
This code executes custom SQL query against the database connection. It inserts a row into logging table with the current user's identifier and a date. This code can be used in any event (such as login form's On Click).
Dim SQL SQL = "INSERT INTO login_log(user_id, login_date) VALUES (" & DBConnection1.ToSQL(CCGetUserID(), ccsInteger) & "," & DBConnection1.ToSQL(Now(), ccsDate) & ")" DBConnection1.Execute (SQL)
See also
Connection Object Execute Method FileName Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string 245
Access
read/write
Syntax
FileName [=value]
Description
This variable contains the name of the current page and is used to create links in the Navigator and Sorter components. For instance, the First, Next, Previous and Last links in the Navigator link to the page specified in this variable. It is also useful for building local links on includable pages.
Examples
The following code builds refresh link pointing to current page with additional parameter attached. It assumes RefreshLink is inserted on Header includable page.
Header.RefreshLink.Page = FileName Header.RefreshLink.Parameters = CCAddParam(Header.RefreshLink.Parameters, "data", "refresh")
See Also
TemplateFileName Variable Link Property HTMLTemplate Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
object (clsTemplate)
Access
read-only
Syntax
HTMLTemplate.<member>...
Description
HTMLTemplate is a global variable that stores a reference to a template object which is an instance of clsTemplate class.
clsTemplate
The template object is responsible for loading the template file related to the current page, building the hierarchical structure of the template blocks/variables and finally replacing the template variables with dynamic values. This variable can be used to set the value of custom template blocks or template variables using the SetVar method.
Examples
The example below shows an extract from an HTML template file with a template variable called user_state.
<input name="user" {user_state}>
246
The following programming code uses the SetVar method of the HTMLTemplate object to set the value of the user_state template variable. When the page is rendered for the browser, the user_state template variable will be replaced by the value disabled and as a result of this, the input control will appear disabled.
HTMLTemplate.SetVar "@user_state","disabled"
See also
TemplateFileName Variable PathToCurrentPage Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
PathToCurrentPage [=value]
Description
This variable contains the relative path from the site's root directory to the location of the current page.
See also
PathToRoot Variable PathToRoot Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
PathToRoot [=value]
Description
This variable contains a relative path to the root directory of the site from the location of the current page. This property is usually used to reference common files generated by CodeCharge Studio in the site's root directory. This includes JavaScript file paths.
See also
FileName Variable TemplateFileName Variable Redirect Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context 247
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
Redirect [=value]
Description
If not empty, the browser is redirected to the URL specified by the contents of this variable.The Redirect variable is declared as a global variable at the top of the page and can therefore be accessed in most of the events that occur later on in the page. Note: The Redirect variable can be modified in the Button's onClick event, if the Return Page property of this Button is empty.
Example
The example below (placed in the After Execute Insert event) redirects the browser using a URL that specifies a URL parameter called article_id.
Dim max_id max_id = CCDLookup("max(article_id)","articles","",DBInternet) Redirect = "articles.asp?article_id=" & max_id
See Also
PathToRoot Variable PathToCurrentPage Variable
Related Examples
Add URL Parameters to a Page Dynamically Redirect Users to Another Page ScriptPath Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
ScriptPath [=value]
Description
This variable contains the absolute file system path to the current page. The variable is used to load the template file for the current page and can be altered to load the template file from a different location.
Examples
The following example sets script path to a site's templates directory. All templates will be loaded from that directory (assuming code is inserted on every page in On Initialize View event).
ScriptPath = Server.MapPath("./templates/")
248
See also
TemplateFileName Variable FileName Variable TemplateFileName Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
TemplateFileName [=value]
Description
Stores the name of the HTML template file used by the current page. This variable can be altered to load an alternate template file (for instance depending on language choice or style preference).
See also
FileName Variable ScriptPath Variable HTMLTemplate Variable Tpl Variable (ASP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
object
Access
read
Syntax
Tpl.<member>...
Description
This variable represents the template file for the current page. It can be used to handle custom template variables ({tag_name}) and template blocks.
See Also
HTMLTemplate Variable
Related Examples
Working with Custom Template Blocks
PHP
Functions
CCAddParam Function (PHP)
Description
249
Adds a parameter with the specified value into the GET query string. If the parameter with the specified name exists then its value is changed for ParameterValue.
Syntax
CCAddParam(QueryString, ParameterName, ParameterValue)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
QueryString
Type Description
Required
Yes Yes
ParameterName String Name of the parameter. ParameterValue String Value of the parameter.
See also:
CCRemoveParam function, CCGetQueryString function CCDLookUp Function (PHP)
Description
Retrieves a single database value which can be a field or an expression. The arguments passed to the function determine the value to be retrieved. Execution of this function causes any previously retrieved records in the connection object to be overwritten with the new recordset.
Syntax
CCDLookUp(field, table, where_clause, connection)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name
field table
Type
string string
Description
Name of the database table field to be retrieved or an SQL expression whose value is to be retrieved. The name of the table from which the value is to be retrieved (SQL JOIN directives are possible).
Required
Yes Yes
SQL WHERE clause: the part of the SQL query that states the Yes criteria for selecting the value. Connection object against which the query will be executed. Yes
Description
Formats a date value according to the specified format mask.
Syntax
CCFormatDate(DateToFormat,FormatMask)
250
Example
CCFormatDate(CCParseDate("2002 May 1",array("yyyy"," ","mmm"," ","d")), array("LongDate")) -> "May 1, 2002" CCFormatDate(CCParseDate("2002-05-01 20:12", array("yyyy", "-", "mm", "-", "dd", " ", "HH", ":", "nn")), array("mmm"," ","d",", time is ","hh",":","nn","","AM/PM")) -> "May 1, time is 8:12 PM"
Return value
None
Parameters
Name
FormatMask
Type
Array of strings
Description
The date value which will be formatted Each string is one of the following components (all other components are left unchanged when building formatted value): d day w m q y h H n s dd ww mm yy hh HH nn ss ddd mmm A/P a/p dddd mmmm yyyy week month quarter day of the year hour in 12-hour format hour in 24-hour format minute second zero-filled day week of year zero-filled month two-digit year zero-filled hour in 12-hour format zero-filled hour in 24-hour format zero-filled minute zero-filled second short weekday name short month name A or P according to AM/PM a or p according to AM/PM weekday name month name year 251
Required
Yes Yes
DateToFormat Array
AM or PM am or pm long date format long time format short date format short time format
Description
Retrieves the value of a specified cookie.
Syntax
CCGetCookie(name)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
name string Name of the cookie whose value is to be returned. Yes
See Also:
CCSetCookie function CCGetFromGet Function (PHP)
Description
Retrieves a value of the GET input parameter. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the GET query string and if no value is returned the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetFromGet(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name
DefaultValue
Type Description
Required
Yes
string The value to be assigned if the given parameter has no value. Yes It can be an empty string.
See also:
CCGetParam function, CCGetFromPost function CCGetFromPost Function (PHP)
Description
252
Retrieves a POST input parameter value. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the POST query string and if no value is returned the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetFromPost(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name
DefaultValue
Type Description
Required
Yes
string The value to be assigned if the given parameter has no value. Yes It can be an empty string.
See also:
CCGetParam, function CCGetFromGet function CCGetGroupID Function (PHP)
Description
Retrieves the security group ID value of the currently logged in user.
Syntax
CCGetGroupID()
Return value
number
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none
See Also:
CCGetUserID function, CCGetUserLogin function, CCLoginUser function, CCLogoutUser function CCGetParam Function (PHP)
Description
Retrieves a value of the GET or POST input parameter. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the GET query string and if no value is returned, the function checks for a POST input parameter with the same name. If no value is returned by the GET or POST input parameter, the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetParam(name, value)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description
name string Name of the GET or POST parameter whose value is to be returned. 253
Required
Yes
value
string The value to be assigned of the given parameter has no value. It can be Yes an empty string.
See also:
CCGetFromGet function, CCGetFromPost function CCGetQueryString Function (PHP)
Description
Retrieves a value from the GET, POST or both (depending on the specified parameter) input parameters value. If the RemoveParameters array contains parameter names then they will be removed from the resulting string.
Syntax
CCGetQueryString(CollectionName, RemoveParameters)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
CollectionName
Type Description
String Name of the parameter to retrieve. Possible values: "Form" Retrieves a POST input parameter value "QueryString" Retrieves a GET input parameter value "All" Retrieves a GET and POST input parameter value
Required
Yes
RemoveParameters Array Array of names which will be removed from the resulting string. CCGetSession Function (PHP)
Yes
Description
Retrieves the value of a specified session variable, or returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetSession(Name [, DefaultValue])
Parameters
Name
Name
Type Description
Required
No
See Also:
CCSetSession function CCGetUserID Function (PHP)
Description
Retrieves the primary key value that uniquely identifies the currently logged-in user. 254
Syntax
CCGetUserID()
Return value
number
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none
See Also:
CCGetUserLogin function, CCLoginUser function, CCLogoutUser function, CCGetGroupID function CCGetUserLogin Function (PHP) Retrieves the login name (or username) of the currently logged in user.
Syntax
CCGetUserLogin()
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none
Description
See Also: CCGetUserID function, CCLoginUser function, CCLogoutUser function, CCGetGroupID function CCLoginUser Function (PHP)
Description
Authenticates a user by comparing the login and password values against the values stored in the database. If a successful match is made, session variables containing the information of the logged in user are created to indicate an authenticated session.
Syntax
CCLoginUser(login, password)
Return value
Boolean
Parameters
Name
login
Type Description
Required
See Also:
CCGetUserID function, CCGetUserLogin function, CCLogoutUser function, CCGetGroupID function 255
Description
This function terminates an authenticated session by clearing the session variables that hold the information of a logged in user. After this function executes, a user must login again in order to access any restricted pages.
Syntax
CCLogoutUser()
Return value
none
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none
See Also:
CCGetUserID function, CCGetUserLogin function, CCLoginUser function, CCGetGroupID function CCParseDate Function (PHP)
Description
Parses the specified date string into an array according to the specified date format.
Syntax
CCParseDate(ParsingDate,FormatMask)
Example
CCParseDate("2002 May 1",array("yyyy"," ","mmm"," ","d")) -> 2002-05-01
Return value
Date
Parameters
Name Type Description
The date which will be parsed.
Required
Yes
ParsingDate String FormatMask Array of strings (see CCFormatDate for available patterns) Return Value Date
The format mask to parse the No date with. The returned date. No
See also
CCFormatDate function CCRemoveParam Function (PHP)
Description
Removes a parameter from the GET query string.
256
Syntax
CCRemoveParam(QueryString, ParameterName)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
QueryString
Type Description
Required
Yes
See also:
CCAddParam function CCSetCookie Function (PHP)
Description
Creates a new cookie and assigns the specified value to it or sets the specified value to the named cookie if it already exists.
Syntax
CCSetCookie(Name, Value[, ExpireTime])
Parameters
Name
Name Value
Type Description
string string Name of the cookie whose value is to be set. The value to be assigned to the cookie.
Required
Yes Yes No
ExpireTime integer The number of seconds before the cookie expires. If the parameter is not specified the cookie will be destroyed after 1 year. CCSetSession Function (PHP)
Description
Creates a session variable and assigns it the specified value or sets the specified value to the session variable if it already exists.
Return value
none
Parameters
Name Type Description
value
Required
name string Name of the session variable to be created or set. Yes string The value to be assigned to the session variable. Yes
257
See Also:
CCGetSession function
Methods
connect Method (PHP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>->connect(database, host, port, user, password)
Return value
link identifier
Parameters
Name
database host port user password
Type Description
string Name of the database instance to connect to. string Address of the host machine where the database resides. string Port to connect to. string User name to authenticate with. string User password to authenticate with.
Required
No No No No No
Description
This method establishes a database connection using the specified parameters. This method can be used to establish a database connection at runtime, for instance when the connection parameters are not known at design-time. f Method (PHP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>->f(field)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type
field string or number
Description
Name of a field to be retrieved from the current record, or its numerical index.
Required
Yes
Description
This method retrieves the value of the specified field from the current connection's recordset.
See also
query Method GetFileName Method (PHP)
Applies to
258
FileUpload Control
Syntax
<control>->GetFileName()
Description
This method extracts the name of an uploaded file (without the unique suffix). It can be used to check the original file extension or construct an alternative filename for saving the file. GetFileSize Method (PHP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
<control>->GetFileSize()
Description
This method retrieves the size of an uploaded file. It can be used to reject or accept files based on their size. GetLink Method (PHP)
Applies to
ImageLink Control, Link Control
Syntax
<control>->GetLink()
Return value
string
Description
This method returns the hyperlink value of a control. The returned value is the actual URL which is used when the Link or Image Link control is clicked.
See also
SetLink Method GetValue Method (PHP)
Applies to
Checkbox Control, CheckboxList Control, FileUpload Control, Hidden Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, Label Control, Link Control, ListBox Control, RadioButton Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control
Syntax
<control>->GetValue()
Return value
Depends on control data type
Description
This method returns the current value of the specified control. The returned value depends on the control's format and data type.
See also
SetValue Method 259
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>->next_record()
Return value
boolean
Description
This method is used to traverse a retrieved recordset by moving the record pointer to the next record.
See also
query Method f Method num_rows Method (PHP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>->num_rows(field)
Return value
number
Description
This method returns the number of rows accessible in the currently active recordset for a particular connection. Note: This method is not applied (it always returns 0) if the the Oracle OCI database library is used.
See also
query Method query Method (PHP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
<connection>->query(query)
Return value
result identifier
Parameters
Name Type Description
query string String containing the SQL query to be executed against the database.
Required
Yes
Description
This method executes a specified SQL query against the database connection. 260
See also
f Method num_rows Method next_record Method SetLink Method (PHP)
Applies to
ImageLink Control, Link Control
Syntax
<control>->SetLink(url)
Parameters
Name Type Description
url string A URL to the target resource which the control should point to.
Required
Yes
Description
This method sets the URL of a Link or Image Link control. This method can be used to change the URL dynamically or to append additional parameters to an existing URL.
See also
GetLink Method SetValue Method (PHP)
Applies to
Checkbox Control, CheckboxList Control, FileUpload Control, Hidden Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, Label Control, Link Control, ListBox Control, RadioButton Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control
Syntax
<control>->SetValue(value)
Parameters
Name Type
value
Description
Required
Yes
Depends on the Data Type of the Control Value to be assigned to the control.
Description
This method sets the value of a control. The value is influenced by the data type as well as format of the control. This method is often used to dynamically assign or alter the value of a control at runtime.
See also
GetValue Method ToSQL Method (PHP)
Applies to
Connection Object
Syntax
261
<connection>->ToSQL(Value, DataType)
Return value
Depends on the specifed Data Type
Parameters
Name
Value
Type
any
Description
Value to be converted to SQL compatible format.
Required
Yes
DataType The data type to which the value will be formatted. Desired data type. You can use any one of the predefined constants: ccsDate, ccsBoolean, ccsInteger, ccsFloat, ccsText, ccsMemo
Yes
Description
This method formats values based on the specified data type in order to make them SQL compatible.
Run-Time Properties
AllowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
FileUpload Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->AllowedFileMasks [= value]
Description
Specifies a list of file masks (separated with semicolon) that are allowed by the FileUpload component. If user specifies a file with a mask that matches one of the masks specified in this property, the file will be uploaded (unless the mask is also listed in the DisallowedFileMasks property). Otherwise, the upload will fail and an error message will be displayed. The AllowedFileMasks property corresponds to the "Allowed File Masks" Design-Time property of the FileUpload component.
See also
DisallowedFileMasks Property CalendarStyles Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
array
Access
read/write 262
Syntax
object->CalendarStyles [= value]
Description
Contains the calendar styles that depend on the builder settings. Note: This property can be modified in the Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to change some styles.
$Calendar1->CalendarStyles["Day"] = "class = 'CellWithBlackText'"; $Calendar1->CalendarStyles["ToDay"] = "class = 'CellWithRedText'";
See also
CurrentStyle property ComponentName Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, FileUpload Control Calendar Form, CalendarNavigator, Includable Page, Link, Navigator, Panel, Report Form, Report Label, Report Section, Panel
Type
String
Access
read
Syntax
object->ComponentName
Description
Specifies Name of object i.e. "TextBox1" Components Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Panel
Type
Array
Access
read
Syntax
object->Components
Description
Contains all children of the current panel. Can be used to iterate through all children. ComponentType Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
263
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, FileUpload Control Calendar Form, CalendarNavigator, Includable Page, Link, Navigator, Panel, Report Form, Report Label, Report Section, Panel
Type
String
Access
read
Syntax
object->ComponentType
Description
Specifies type of an object, such as "TextBox", "Record", etc. CurrentDate Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
array
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->CurrentDate [= value]
Description
Specifies the date shown in the calendar. For example, for the Monthly calendar the date can be any date of this month. Note: The value of this property can be modified in the Page's After Initialize event.
Examples
The following example shows how to make the calendar always show January 2005.
$Format = array("yyyy", "-", "mm", "-", "dd"); $Date = CCParseDate("2005-01-01", $Format); $Calendar1->CurrentDate = $Date;
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
array
Access
read
Syntax
object->CurrentProcessingDate 264
Description
Specifies the currently processed date. The value of this property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month, and Before Show events.
See also
PrevProcessingDate property, NextProcessingDate property CurrentStyle Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->CurrentStyle [= value]
Description
Contains the calendar style of the currently processed block. Note: The value of this property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month, and Before Show events.
Examples
The following example shows how to change style.
$Calendar1->CurrentStyle = "class = 'CellWithBlackText'";
See also
CalendarStyles property DeleteAllowed Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->DeleteAllowed [= value]
Description
This property contains boolean flag that if set, prevents record deletion operation from executing. This property is set automatically by the Record form to True or False if the access to the form is restricted by setting its Restricted property to Yes in the IDE. If Restricted is set to No, then DeleteAllowed property is always True unless modified in the Before Delete event. The value of this property can be changed in the After Initialize event of the Page. Note: Setting this property to 'False' in the On Validate event or the Page's After Initialize event results in hiding of the Delete button. 265
Examples
The following example shows how to prevent a logged in user from deleting an item that does not belong to him/her. Additionally, the form displays an error message.
global $items; if ($items->user_id->GetValue() != { $items->DeleteAllowed = false; $items->Errors->addError("You are not allowed to delete this item."); }
CCGetUserID())
See also
InsertAllowed Property UpdateAllowed Property ReadAllowed Property DisallowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->DisallowedFileMasks [= value]
Description
Stores a regular expression that is used to check if the filename mask is on the list of disallowed filename masks. If the filename mask is included in this property, the upload operation fails and an appropriate error message is displayed. DisallowedMasks property has higher priority than the AllowedFileMasks property. In other words, if a mask is mentioned in both properties (AllowedFileMasks and DisallowedFileMasks) the upload will fail. Note: The initial value of this variable is built based on the contents of the "Disallowed File Masks" design-time property.
See also
AllowedFileMasks Property ds Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Navigator Control, Record Form, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control
Type
object (cls<name>DataSource)
Access
read/write 266
Syntax
object->ds->...
Description
Note: This syntax is retained for compatibility reasons. This property contains a reference to the data source associated with the given object. This data source can be used to perform additional queries and to access query results. The properties of the ds object (SQL, CountSQL, Where, Order) can be changed in the Events code so that the programmer can alter the properties conditionally (e.g. change the SQL query used to retrieve ListBox object's elements). A programmer can instantiate a new ds object by constructing a connection object. Additional queries on this object can be performed in the events code, or the ds object's reference can be passed as the connection reference parameter to CCDLookUp function.
Examples
$db = new clsDB<connection_name>(); $db->query("SELECT article_id,article_title FROM articles"); $articles = array(); while ($db->next_record()) { $a = array(); $a["article_id"] = $db->f("article_id"); $a["article_title"] = $db->f("article_title"); $articles[] = $a; }
where <connection_name> is the name of the connection, e.g. for "Intranet" connection the first line of the example should read:
$db = new clsDBIntranet();
Other examples
Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox, Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause, Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement, Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause
See also
DataSource Property CCDLookUp Function SQL Property CountSQL Property Order Property Where Property ListBox Object Grid Form DataSource->CountSQL Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
267
DataSource Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->ds->CountSQL [=value]
Description
Stores the main part of the SQL query that is used to retrieve the number of records returned by a SELECT database query. This property does not include the WHERE clause, before the query is executed conditions from the Where property are appended. Note: The usual content of this property includes the COUNT aggregate function: SELECT COUNT(*) FROM ...
Examples
Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement, Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox, Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause, Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause
See Also
DataSource Property DataSource->SQL Property DataSource->Where Property DataSource->Order Property DataSource->RecordsCount Property DataSource->Order Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
DataSource Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->DataSource->Order [=value]
Description
This property holds the list of fields that are used in the ORDER BY clause of the SELECT query. CCS initializes this property internally, for example if an order option has been specified in the properties of the form. Modification of this field (before the query is executed) will change the order of the results.
Examples
Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox, Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause, Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement, Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause 268
See Also
DataSource Property DataSource->SQL Property DataSource->CountSQL Property DataSource->Where Property DataSource->RecordsCount Property DataSource->RecordsCount Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
DataSource Object
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->DataSource->RecordsCount [=Value]
Description
Contains the number of records retrieved by DataSource's SELECT SQL query.
Examples
The following example shows how to hide a form if there are no records retrieved from the database.
global $items; if ($items->DataSource->RecordsCount == 0) { $items->Visible = false; }
Other examples
Hiding a Grid If No Records are Found
See Also
DataSource Property DataSource->SQL Property DataSource->CountSQL Property DataSource->Where Property DataSource->Order Property DataSource->SQL Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
DataSource Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
269
object->DataSource->SQL [=value]
Description
This property stores the main part of a query that retrieves, inserts, updates, or removes data for the form. The main part usually includes the actual SQL command (SELECT, INSERT, UPDATE, DELETE), a list of fields to be retrieved, inserted, or updated and a list of tables from which the data will be retrieved or deleted (FROM) or the name of the table the insert or update operations are to be executed against. The SQL query is eventually built as the concatenation of SQL, Where and Order properties. To modify the SQL property (alter the SQL query), you should use the BeforeBuildSelect event procedure of the form.
Examples
Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement, Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox, Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause, Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause
See Also
DataSource Property DataSource->CountSQL Property DataSource->Where Property DataSource->Order Property DataSource->Where Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
DataSource Object
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->DataSource->Where [=value]
Description
This property stores all conditions that are eventually used in the WHERE clause of a query that selects, updates or deletes data from the database. Programmers can add their own conditions (preserving the SQL syntax) in one of the events triggered before the final query is built and executed (i.e. BeforeBuildSelect, BeforeBuildDelete, BeforeBuildUpdate).
Examples
Dynamically Modify the WHERE and ORDER BY Clauses of a ListBox, Dynamically Modify the ORDER BY Clause, Dynamically Modify the SQL Statement, Retrieve Values From a Multi-Select ListBox, Dynamically Modify the WHERE Clause
See Also
DataSource Property DataSource->SQL Property DataSource->CountSQL Property DataSource->Order Property 270
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
object->EditMode
Description
This property determines whether given record form is currently in edit or insert mode. In edit mode all data source parameters need to have values assigned (including row identifier). In insert mode not all have to be assigned values.
Examples
The following example shows how to hide a dependent form on a page when the main form is not in EditMode.
global $items; global $item_prices; if (! $items->EditMode) { $item_prices->Visible = false; }
where $items is the name of the main form, and $item_prices is the name of the form that shows elements that depend on the data in the main form.
Other examples
Examine Form's Mode, Dynamic Login Field in a Registration Form
See also
Errors Property FormSubmitted Property PressedButton Property EmptyRows Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Type
Number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->EmptyRows [= value]
Description
271
Specifies the number of empty rows displayed at the bottom of the editable grid. Each empty row allows the user to insert a new record into the database. EmptyText Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control,
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->EmptyText
Description
Specifies the text to be displayed when label value is empty.
Example
$Report1->ReportLabel1->EmptyText = "xxx";
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
array
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->Events [= value]
Description
Contains the calendar events. This value can be manually modified. Note: The value of this property can be also modified in Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to add new event.
$CustomEventDateStr = "20050101"; $CustomEventTime = CCParseDate("12:00", array("HH", ":", "nn")); $CustomEvent = new clsEventNewCalendar1(); $CustomEvent->_Time = $CustomEventTime; $CustomEvent->EventTime = $CustomEventTime; $CustomEvent->EventDescription = "Some text"; $Calendar1->Events[$CustomEventDateStr][] = $CustomEvent;
Applies to
272
Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Connection Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Control, FileUpload Control
Type
object (clsErrors)
Access
read-only
Syntax
object->Errors-><property>->...
Description
This property keeps the reference to the objects errors collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution.
Examples
The following example shows how to display an error message on the form if the logged in user tries to delete an item that does not belong to him/her.
global $items; if ($items->user_id->GetValue() != { $items->DeleteAllowed = false; $items->Errors->addError("You are not allowed to delete this item."); }
CCGetUserID())
Other examples
Display Custom Error Messages, Using the Control Validation Event, Using the Form Validation Event FileFolder Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->FileFolder [= value]
Description
Stores the name of the folder where the uploaded files will be stored on the web server.
Examples
The following example shows how to change the upload file folder depending on the login name of the logged in user. The form or page with the FileUpload component should be restricted. 273
CCGetUserLogin() . "/";
where $files is the name of the form and file is the name of the FileUpload component.
See also
FileSizeLimit Property TemporaryFolder Property FileSizeLimit Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
FileUpload Component
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->FileSizeLimit [= value]
Description
Specifies the maximum size (in bytes) of a file that can be uploaded to the server. If the size of the file is greater than value of this property, the upload fails and appropriate error message is displayed. Note: the initial value of this property is retrieved from the "File Size Limit" design-time property of the FileUpload component.
See also
GetFileSize Method FirstWeekDay Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
integer
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->FirstWeekDay [= value]
Description
Specifies the weekday shown first in the week. The '0' identifies Sunday, '1' - Monday, etc. Note: The value of this property can be modified in the Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to change property value to Monday.
$Calendar1->FirstWeekDay = 1;
Applies to
Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker, Hidden Control, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control
Type
array of variants
Access
read-write
Syntax
object->Format [= value]
Description
Holds constraints used to translate control's value from its internal state to the required public representation. FormSubmitted Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
object->FormSubmitted
Description
This property determines whether record processing is performed in initial show or in postback mode. In show mode, the records fields are assigned data sources value (or none). In postback mode user provided data is available for processing.
See also
Errors Property PressedButton Property EditMode Property Height Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Section Control
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->Height
Description
Specifies the height of the section in abstract "line" units.
Example
$Report1->Report_Footer->Height = 1.2;
275
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->InsertAllowed [= value]
Description
This property contains a boolean flag that if true, allows insert database operations. This property should be changed in Page AfterInitialize, Form Before Insert (or On Validate) Event to prevent a form from creating a new record in the database. Note: Setting this property to False in the On Validate event or the Page's After Initialize event results in hiding of the Insert button.
Examples
The following example shows how to prevent a user from inserting an item into database if the provided email address can be found in emails table of the database. Additionally, the form displays an error message.
global $items; if (CCDLookUp("email_address","emails","email_address=" . $items->DataSource->ToSQL($items->email_address->GetValue()),$items>DataSource)) { $items->InsertAllowed = false; $items->Errors->addError("Provide another email adress."); }
See also
UpdateAllowed Property DeleteAllowed Property ReadAllowed Property IsPercent Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Report Form,
Type
boolean
Access
read
Syntax
object->IsPercent 276
Description
Specifies whether the report label value should be output as the percentage of corresponding total value.
Example
if ($Report1->ReportLabel1->IsPercent) { $Report1->ReportLabel1->SetText("<b>" . $Report1->ReportLabel1->GetText() . "</b>"); }
See also
TotalFunction property NextProcessingDate Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
array
Access
read
Syntax
object->NextProcessingDate
Description
Specifies the next date to the currently processing one. This property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month and Before Show events.
See also
CurrentPrevDate property, CurrentProcessingDate property NumberOfColumns Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Directory Form
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->NumberOfColumns [= value]
Description
Specifies a number of columns the directory form is split into. Value of this run-time property is initialized from the "No. of columns" design-time property of the directory.
See also
NumberOfSubcategories Property NumberOfSubcategories Run-Time Property (PHP) 277
Applies to
Directory Form
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->NumberOfSubcategories [= value]
Description
This property contains maximum number of subcategories displayed for each category. No more then property value subcategories are displayed. If there are more, they will be listed only after navigating given category (so they become categories). This property can be used to allow directory layout selection depending on user's preference.
See also
NumberOfColumns Property Parent Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, FileUpload Control Calendar Form, CalendarNavigator, Includable Page, Link, Navigator, Panel, Report Form, Report Label, Report Section,
Type
Reference
Access
read
Syntax
object->Parent
Description
Specifies parent container of an object, for example a record form for a textbox that is included within that form. Note: does not apply to panels. PressedButton Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
278
object->PressedButton [= value]
Description
This property contains the name of the button pressed to submit the form being processed. This value is only set when operating in postback processing mode (it is not set when navigating page without submit). The name of the button pressed is the same as records member variable handling button requests (if the button name is Update there is a records member variable Update of type clsButton).
See also
Errors Property FormSubmitted Property EditMode Property PrevProcessingDate Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
array
Access
read
Syntax
object->PrevProcessingDate
Description
Specifies the previous date to the currently processing one. The property can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month and Before Show events.
See also
CurrentProcessingDate and NextProcessingDate properties ReadAllowed Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->ReadAllowed [= value]
Description
This property contains a boolean flag that if set to true, prevents data read operations from executing.
See also
UpdateAllowed Property DeleteAllowed Property InsertAllowed Property 279
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->TemporaryFolder [= value]
Description
This property contains the path used for storing temporary uploaded files before processing and moving into target directory.
See also
AllowedFileMasks Property DisallowedFileMasks Property FileFolder Property FileSizeLimit Property TotalFunction Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control,
Type
string
Access
read
Syntax
object->TotalFunction
Description
Specifies the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated. The default value is empty string.
Type Description
(none) No function will be used. Sum The report label value will be calculated as the sum of previous row values. Count If the Control Source is empty the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows. Otherwise the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows with nonempty values. Min Max Avg The value will be calculated as the minimum of previous row values. The value will be calculated as the maximum of previous row values. The value will be calculated as the average of non-empty values from previous rows.
Example
if ($Report1->ReportLabel1->TotalFunction == "Sum") {
280
See also
IsPercent property Update Allowed Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->UpdateAllowed [= value]
Description
This property contains boolean flag that if set, prevents record update operation from executing. This property is set automatically to False by the Record form if the access to the form is restricted by setting its "Restricted" property to "Yes" in the IDE. If "Restricted" is set to "No", then UpdateAllowed property is always True unless modified in the Before Update event. The value of this property can be changed in the After Initialize event of the Page. Note: Setting this property to False in the On Validate event or the Page's After Initialize event results in hiding of the Update button.
Examples
The following example shows how to prevent a logged in user from updating an item that does not belong to him/her. Additionally, the form displays an error message.
global $items; if ($items->user_id->GetValue() != { $items->UpdateAllowed = false; $items->Errors->addError("You are not allowed to edit this item."); }
CCGetUserID())
See also
InsertAllowed Property DeleteAllowed Property ReadAllowed Property ViewMode Run-Time Property (PHP)
Applies to
Repord Form,
Type
String 281
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->ViewMode
Description
Retrieves or specifies the report's view mode.
Type Description
Print The report will be displayed in print view mode. Web The report will be displayed in Web view mode.
Example
$Report1->ViewMode = "Print";
Applies to
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, FileUpload Control, Panel
Type
boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
object->Visible [= value]
Description
Specifies whether the control is visible. Setting this field to false will prevent the object from being displayed. Note: Property is tested before calling Before Show Event. In order for the property change to be taken into consideration it should be set earlier. For instance in parent component's Before Show Event. Note: Most of the controls need Extended HTML property checked, which allows them to be hidden. This property is available after selecting Edit ... from the context menu of the control during design-time.
Examples
The following example shows how to hide a form if there are no records retrieved from the database.
global $items; if ($items->DataSource->RecordsCount<1) { $items->Visible = false; }
282
Other examples
Hiding a Grid If No Records are Found, Hiding a Record Form Control
Variables
DB<connectionname> Variable (PHP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
object (clsDB<connectionname>)
Access
read-only
Syntax
global $DB<connectionname> $DB<connectionname>->...
Description
This property is a global variable declared at the beginning of the page and represents each database connection used within the page. The connection object encapsulates the implementation details used to establish the connection with the database (i.e. database name, location, user login/password, etc). The database connection variable can be used to perform custom database operations (e.g. it is used as the fourth argument of the CCDLookup function). The name of the database connection object is created by prepending the connection name (configured in the CCS environment) with the prefix "DB" (e.g. for a connection called Internet within CodeCharge Studio, the corresponding variable name for the connection object would be DBInternet).
Examples
Lookup Single Field Value in a Database, Create Custom Session Variables, Execute Custom SQL, Retrieve Multiple Field Values from a Database, Utilize MySQL Enum Field Type
See also
ds Property FileName Variable (PHP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read-only
Syntax
283
Description
This variable contains the name of the current page and is used to create links in the Navigator and Sorter components. For instance, the First, Next, Previous and Last links in the Navigator link to the page specified in this variable.
Examples
Add URL Parameters to a Page PathToRoot Variable (PHP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
global $PathToRoot; $PathToRoot [= value]
Description
This variable contains a relative path to the root directory of the site from the location of the current page. This property is usually used to reference common files generated by CodeCharge Studio in the site's root directory. This includes JavaScript file paths.
See also
FileName Variable TemplateFileName Variable Redirect Variable (PHP)
Applies to
Record Form, Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
global $Redirect; $Redirect [= value]
Description
If not empty, the browser is redirected to the URL specified by the contents of this variable.The Redirect variable is declared as a global variable at the top of the page and can therefore be accessed in most of the events that occur later on in the page. Note: The Redirect variable can be modified in the Button's onClick event, if the Return Page property of this Button is empty.
Examples
Dynamically Redirect Users to Another Page 284
Applies to
Global constant
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
define("RelativePath", [value]) RelativePath
Description
This constant variable contains the relative path of the current file based on its location on the web server. This variable is used when loading the template file for the page and can also be used to specify an alternate template file from a different location. Note: Since this variable is a constant, you can refer to it without declaring it as global in your event code and the dollar sign prefix is not needed.
See also
TemplateFileName Variable FileName Variable TemplateFileName Variable (PHP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
global $TemplateFileName; $TemplateFileName [= value]
Description
Stores the name of the HTML template file used by the current page. This variable can be altered to load an alternate template file (for instance depending on language choice or style preference).
See also
FileName Variable Tpl Variable (PHP)
Applies to
Page Context
Type
object
Access
read-only
Syntax
285
Description
This variable represents the template file for the current page. It can be used to handle custom template variables ({tag_name}) and template blocks.
Examples
global $Tpl; $Tpl->SetVar("tag_name",$value);
Other examples
Working with Custom Template Blocks
Perl
Fuctions
CCAddParam Function (Perl)
Description
Adds a parameter with the specified value into the GET query string. If the parameter exists, its value will be changed for ParameterValue.
Syntax
CCAddParam(QueryString, ParameterName, ParameterValue)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
QueryString
Type Description
Required
Yes Yes
ParameterName String Name of the parameter. ParameterValue String Value of the parameter.
See also:
CCRemoveParam function, CCGetQueryString function CCDLookUp Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves a single database value which can be a field or an expression. The arguments passed to the function determine the value to be retrieved. Execution of this function causes any previously retrieved records in the connection object to be overwritten with the new recordset.
Syntax
CCDLookUp(field, table, where_clause, connection)
286
Return value
string
Parameters
Name
field table
Type
string string
Description
Name of the database table field to be retrieved or an SQL expression whose value is to be retrieved. The name of the table from which the value is to be retrieved (SQL JOIN directives are possible).
Required
Yes Yes
SQL WHERE clause: the part of the SQL query that states the Yes criteria for selecting the value. Connection object against which the query will be executed. Yes
Description
Formats a date value according to the specified format mask.
Syntax
CCFormatDate(DateToFormat,FormatMask)
Specification
Name Type Description
Date value to format. Each string is one of the following components (all other components are left unchanged when building formatted value): d day w m q y h H n s dd ww mm yy week month quarter day of the year hour in 12-hour format hour in 24-hour format minute second zero-filled day week of year zero-filled month two-digit year
Required
Yes Yes
287
hh HH nn ss ddd mmm A/P a/p dddd mmmm yyyy AM/PM am/pm LongDate LongTime ShortDate ShortTime
zero-filled hour in 12-hour format zero-filled hour in 24-hour format zero-filled minute zero-filled second short weekday name short month name A or P according to AM/PM a or p according to AM/PM weekday name month name year AM or PM am or pm long date format long time format short date format short time format
Description
Retrieves a value of the specified cookie.
Syntax
CCGetCookie(name)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
name string Name of the cookie whose value is to be returned. Yes
See Also:
CCSetCookie CCGetFromGet Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves a GET input parameter value. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the GET query string and if no value is returned the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
288
CCGetFromGet(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name
DefaultValue
Type Description
string The value to be assigned of the given parameter has no value. It can be an empty string.
Required
Yes Yes
See also:
CCGetParam function, CCGetFromPost function CCGetFromPost Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves a POST input parameter value. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the POST query string and if no value is returned the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetFromPost(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name
DefaultValue
Type Description
Required
Yes
string The value to be assigned if the given parameter has no value. Yes It can be an empty string.
See also:
CCGetParam function, CCGetFromGet function CCGetGroupID Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves the security group ID value of the currently logged-in user.
Syntax
CCGetGroupID()
Return value
number
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none
289
See Also:
CCGetUserID, CCGetUserLogin CCGetParam Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves a GET or POST input parameter value. The function first attempts to retrieve the parameter from the GET query string and if no value is returned, the function checks for a POST input parameter with the same name. If no value is returned by a GET or POST input parameter, the function returns the default value specified in the function call.
Syntax
CCGetParam(ParameterName, DefaultValue)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
Yes Yes ParameterName string Name of the GET or POST parameter whose value is to be returned. DefaultValue string The value to be assigned of the given parameter has no value. It can be an empty string.
See also:
CCGetFromGet function, CCGetFromPost function CCGetQueryString Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves a GET, POST or both (depending on the first parameter) input parameters value. If the RemoveParameters array contains the names of parameters, then they will be removed from the resulting string.
Syntax
CCGetQueryString(CollectionName, RemoveParameters)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
CollectionName
Type Description
String Name of the parameter to retrieve. Possible values: "Form" Retrieves a POST input parameter value "QueryString" Retrieves a GET input parameter value "All" Retrieves a GET and POST input parameter value
Required
Yes
RemoveParameters Array Array of parameter names which will be removed from the Yes 290
Description
Retrieves a value of the specified session variable.
Syntax
CCGetSession(name)
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
name string Name of the session variable whose value is to be returned. Yes
See Also:
CCSetSession CCGetUserID Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves the primary key value that uniquely identifies the currently logged-in user.
Syntax
CCGetUserID()
Return value
number
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none
See Also:
CCGetUserLogin, CCGetGroupID CCGetUserLogin Function (Perl)
Description
Retrieves the login name of the currently logged-in user.
Syntax
CCGetUserLogin()
Return value
string
Parameters
Name Type Description Required
none See Also: 291
Description
Parses the specified date string into an array according to the specified date format.
Syntax
CCParseDate(ParsingDate,FormatMask)
Specification
ParsingDate Required. Date to parse. Type: string FormatMask Return Value
Optional. Format mask to parse the date with. Type: array of strings (see CCFormatDate for available patterns) Type: date
Example
CCParseDate("2002 May 1",array("yyyy"," ","mmm"," ","d")) -> 2002-05-01
Description
Removes a parameter from the GET query string.
Syntax
CCRemoveParam(QueryString, ParameterName)
Return value
String
Parameters
Name
QueryString
Type Description
Required
Yes
See also:
CCAddParam function CCSetCookie Function (Perl)
Description
Creates a new cookie and assigns it the specified value or sets the specified value to the named cookie if it already exists.
Syntax
CCSetCookie(Name, Value[, ExpireTime])
Return value
292
none
Parameters
Name
Name Value
Type Description
string string Name of the cookie whose value is to be set. The value to be assigned to the cookie.
Required
Yes Yes
ExpireTime integer Number of seconds after which the cookie will be destroyed. If the Optional parameter is not specified, then the cookie time expires after 1 year.
See Also:
CCGetCookie CCSetSession Function (Perl)
Description
Creates a session variable and assigns it the specified value or sets the specified value to the session variable if it already exists.
Syntax
CCSetSession(name, value)
Return value
none
Parameters
Name Type Description
value
Required
name string Name of the session variable to be created or set. Yes string The value to be assigned to the session variable. Yes
See Also:
CCGetSession
ColdFusion
Variables
<control>Item Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Report
Type
structure
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression> = <control>Item.ReportName>
Description
Structure with current report elements. Structure include key for each report control. 293
See also
<control name>Items <control>Items Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Report
Type
array
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfdump var="#<control>Items#">
Description
Array contains report lines. Each array item contains structure connected with current report elements.
See also
<control name>Item <control name>Rows Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid
Type
structure
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=<control>Rows[rPoz].Error>
Description
This variable contains an array of structures for each row in the Editable Grid. The structure is composed of keys such as Error and Operation.
Key
Description
Operation This key specifies the operation which will be performed for the current row. It's value can be Insert, Update or Delete Error This key contains any errors pertaining to a row within the form.
Applies to
ListBox control, CheckboxList control, RadioButton control
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset arr_<control>=<expression>>
294
Description
This variable contains an array of items of a list control (values and descriptions). The first element of the array is the value of the first item, the next element is the item's description.
See also
query<control> Variable blnDeleteAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset blnDeleteAllowed<form>=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=blnDeleteAllowed<form>>
Description
This is a Boolean variable whose value determines whether the delete operation should proceed or not. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Delete event.
See also
InsertAllowed<form> Variable ReadAllowed<form> Variable UpdateAllowed<form> Variable blnEditMode<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid, Record
Type
Boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
<cfset <expression> = blnEditMode<form>> <cfset blnEditMode<form>=<expression>>
Description
This variable specifies the mode in which a form currently is in. A form can either be in Insert mode or Edit mode.
See also
strError variable strOperation variable strPressedButton variable blnFormSubmitted<control name> Run-Time Property (ColdFusion)
Applies to
295
Type
Boolean
Access
read-only
Syntax
<cfset <expression> = blnFormSubmitted&form>
Description
This variable determines how a form is processed based on whether the form is being shown for the first time or has been submitted for postback. In the initial display, the form fields are assigned data values before being displayed. Otherwise if the form has been submitted for postback, the submitted data is processed based on the operation that was initiated upon submission.
See also
strError<form> Variable blnInsertAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=blnInsertAllowed<form>> <cfset blnInsertAllowed<form>=<expression>>
Description
This property determines whether the insert operation can proceed or not.
See also
DeleteAllowed<form> Variable ReadAllowed<form> Variable UpdateAllowed<form> Variable blnReadAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=blnReadAllowed<form>> <cfset blnReadAllowed<form>=<expression>
Description
This property determines whether data read operations can proceed or not. 296
See also
DeleteAllowed<form> Variable InsertAllowed<form> Variable UpdateAllowed<form> Variable blnUpdateAllowed<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset blnUpdateAllowed<form>=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=blnUpdateAllowed<form>>
Description
This is a Boolean variable whose value determines whether the update database operation is permitted. The value of this property is set automatically based on the value of the Restricted property of the form. If the Restricted property is set to No, the value of this property is always True unless it is modified using event code in the Before Update event.
See also
DeleteAllowed<form> Variable InsertAllowed<form> Variable ReadAllowed<form> Variable CalendarEvents Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
object
Access
read/write
Description
Contains the calendar events. This value can be manually modified. Note: The value of this variable can be also modified in Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to add new event.
<CFSET Evnt = StructNew()> <CFSET CalendarEventKey=CreateDateTime(2005, 10, 31, 12, 30, 0)> <CFSET Evnt.Time = CalendarEventKey> <CFSET Evnt.EventTime=CalendarEventKey> <CFSET Evnt.EventDescription = "Some text"> <CFSET StructInsert(CalendarEvents, CalendarEventKey, Evnt)>
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
structure
Access
read/write
Description
Contains the calendar styles that depend on the builder settings. Note: This variable can be modified in the Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to change some styles.
<CFSET CalendarStyles.Day = "class = 'CellWithBlackText'"> <CFSET CalendarStyles.Today = "class = 'CellWithRedText'">
See also
CurrentStyle variable CurrentDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read/write
Syntax
<CFSET CurrentDate [= value]>
Description
Specifies the date shown in the calendar. For example, for the Monthly calendar the date can be any date of this month. Note: The value of this property can be modified in the Page's Before Show event.
Examples
The following example shows how to make the calendar always show January 2005.
<CFSET CurrentDate = CreateDate(2005, 1, 1)>
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read
Description
298
Specifies the currently processed date. The value of this variable can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month, and Before Show events.
See also
PrevProcessingDate variable, NextProcessingDate variable CurrentStyle Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Description
Contains the calendar style of the currently processed block. Note: This value of this variable can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month, and Before Show events.
Examples
The following example shows how to change style.
<CFSET CurrentStyle = "class = 'CellWithBlackText'">
See also
CalendarStyles property DB_<connection name>_DS Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, Directory Form, EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, ListBox Control, Path Form, RadioButton Control, Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset Request.DB_Connection1_DS=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=Request.DB_Connection1_DS>
Description
This variable contains the name of the data source which is used to retrieve data.
See also
DB_<connection name>_USER_PASSWORD variable DB_<connection name>_USER_NAME variable DB_<connection name>_DB_TYPE variable DB_<connection name>_USER_PASSWORD; Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, Directory Form, EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, ListBox Control, Path Form, RadioButton Control, Record Form 299
Type
string
Access
read /write
Syntax
<cfset Request.DB_Connection1_USER_PASSWORD=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=Request.DB_Connection1_USER_PASSWORD>
Description
This variable contains the password specified for the connection
See also
DB_<connection name>_DS variable DB_<connection name>_DB_TYPE variable DB_<connection name>_USER_NAME variable DB_<connection name>_DB_TYPE; Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, Directory Form, EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, ListBox Control, Path Form, RadioButton Control, Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset Request.DB_Connection1_DB_TYPE=<expression>> <cfset <expression=Request.DB_Connection1_DB_TYPE>>
Description
This variable specifies the type of database driver used in the connection.
See also
DB_<connection name>_DS variable DB_<connection name>_USER_PASSWORD variable DB_<connection name>_USER_NAME variable DB_<connection name>_USER_NAME Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, Directory Form, EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, ListBox Control, Path Form, RadioButton Control, Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset Request.DB_Connection1_USER_NAME=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=Request.DB_Connection1_USER_NAME>
Description
300
See also
DB_<connection name>_USER_PASSWORD variable DB_<connection name>_DS variable DB_<connection name>_DB_TYPE variable fld<control name> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Label Control , TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, Hidden Control, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, FileUpload Control
Type
any
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=fld<control>> <cfset fld<control>=<expression>>
Description
Holds the value of the control. For list controls such as CheckBoxList and ListBox, this variable can contain a semicolon separated list of values. For a Link, this is the value that will be displayed as the link label (i.e. between <a> and </a> tags in the HTML code). For an Image, this value is the image path.
See also
fld<control>Link Variable hide<control> Variable fld<control>Link Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
ImageLink control, Link control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset fld<control>Link=<expression>> <cfset <expression>= fld<control>Link>
Description
The Link variable stores the URL (including the query string) that is assigned to the HREF attribute of an HTML link. This variable is used only by the Link and Image Link controls.
See also
fld<control name> variable hide<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
301
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, Navigator Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Form, Directory Form, FileUpload Control, Panel
Type
Boolean
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset hide<control>=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=hide<control>>
Description
This variable determines the visibility of a control. Be default, the value of this variable is False, meaning that the control is visible. However, if the variable is set to True, the control will be hidden.
See also
fld<control> Variable intEmptyRows Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Description
This variable specifies the number of empty rows to be displayed for inserting new data.
See also
intPage Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Report
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset intPageSize = 100>
Description
Specify the page number for the Web View mode.
See also
intPageSize ViewMode 302
Applies to
Report
Type
number
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset intPageSize = 100>
Description
Specify the page size for the print mode of report.
See also
intPage ViewMode intShownRecords Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Grid Form
Type
string
Access
read
Syntax
<<expression>=intShownRecords>
Description
This variable contains the number of records shown on a page. This variable can be used in the Before Show Row event. NextProcessingDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read
Description
Specifies the next date to the currently processing one. This variable can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month and Before Show events.
See also
CurrentPrevDate variable, CurrentProcessingDate variable NumberOfColumns Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
303
Directory Form
Type
integer
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset NumberOfColumns=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=NumberOfColumns>
Description
This variable specifies the number of columns over which a Directory form will display its categories. This property can be used to allow the user to customize the layout of the Directory form by specifying the number of columns they want to see in the Directory form.
See also
NumberOfSubCategories Variable NumberOfSubCategories Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Directory Form
Type
integer
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset NumberOfSubCategories=<expression>> <cfset <expression>= NumberOfSubCategories>
Description
This variable specifies the maximum number of subcategories to be displayed for each top level category of a Directory form.
See also
NumberOfColumns Variable par<control name>.FileFolder Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset par<control>.FileFolder=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=par<control>.FileFolder>
Description
This variable specifies the target folder into which uploaded files will be stored. 304
See also
par<control>.TemporaryFolder Variable par<control>.TemporaryFolder Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset par<control>.TemporaryFolder=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=par<control>.TemporaryFolder>
Description
This variable contains the path used for storing uploaded files temporarily before they are moved into the target folder. The property specifies the full path or the relative path from the page folder to the temporary folder.
See also
par<control>.FileFolder Variable PathToCurrentPage Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Page context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<CFSET <expression>=pathToCurrentPage> <CFSET pathToCurrentPage=<expression>>
Description
This variable contains the path of the current page relative to the root directory of the site.
See also
PathToRoot variable PathToRoot Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Page context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
305
Description
This variable contains a relative path to the root directory of the site from the location of the current page. This property is usually used to reference custom tags and common files generated by CodeCharge Studio in the site's root directory. This includes JavaScript file paths, etc.
See also
PathToCurrentPage variable PrevProcessingDate Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Type
date
Access
read
Description
Specifies the previous date to the currently processing one. The variable can be modified in the Before Show Day, Before Show Week, Before Show Month and Before Show events.
See also
CurrentProcessingDate variable, NextProcessingDate variable query<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, Directory Form, EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, ListBox Control, Path Form, RadioButton Control, Record Form
Type
query
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=query<control>.<variable>>
Description
This variable contains the query associated with a given object. The query can be used to perform additional queries or access query results
See also
strSQL Variable strOrder Variable strWhere Variable strSQL<control> Variable strOrder<control> Variable strWhere<control> Variable FileName Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion) 306
Applies to
Page context
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset value = strFileName> (CF)
Description
This variable contains the name of the target page for the links in the navigator and sorter components. This filename is used to build links (column headers for sorters and next, previous, numbers links for navigators). This variable is declared in the Request scope for ColdFusion and Templates.
See also
strRedirect Variable strErr<form> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset strError<form>=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=strError<form>>
Description
This variable contains error messages pertaining to the form as a result of the form's execution.
See also
strEditModed<form> Variable strRedirect Variable blnFormSubmitted<form> Variable strOperation Variable strPressedButton Variable strOperation Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write 307
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=strOperation> <cfset strOperation=<expression>>
Description
This variable specifies the operation to be performed after one of the submit buttons in a form has been clicked to initiate postback.
See also
strEditModed<form> Variable strError<form> Variable strPressedButton Variable strOrder Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, Directory Form, Path Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset strOrder=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=strOrder>
Description
This variable contains the Order By clause for the SQL query to be executed. This variable can be modified in the Before Build Select event.
See also
strSQL Variable strWhere Variable query<control> Variable strOrder<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, ListBox Control, RadioButton Control Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset strOrder<control>=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=strOrder<control>>
Description
This variable contains the Order By clause for the SQL query to be executed. This variable can be modified in the Before Build Select event.
See also
308
strWhere<control> Variable, strSQL<control> Variable query<control> Variable strPressedButton Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Type
string
Access
read
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=strPressedButton> <cfset strPressedButton=<expression>>
Description
This variable contains the name of the form's submit button which was clicked to initiate postback.
See also
strEditModed<form> variable strError variable strOperation variable strRedirect Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<CFSET strRedirect=<expression>> <CFSET <expression>=strRedirect>
Description
If not empty, the browser is redirected to the URL specified by the contents of this variable.
See also
strFileName Variable strError<form> Variable strSQL Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, Directory Form, Path Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
309
Description
This variable contains the SQL query string to be executed. This variable can be modified in the Before Build Select event.
See also
strOrder Variable strWhere Variable query<control> Variable strSQL<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, ListBox Control, RadioButton Control Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset strSQL<control>=&expression>> <cfset &expression>=strSQL<control>>
Description
This variable contains the SQL query string to be executed to retrieve data for a control. This variable can be modified in the Before Build Select event.
See also
strOrder<control> Variable strWhere<control> Variable query<control> Variable strSQL Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Record
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset <expression>=strSQL> <cfset strSQL=<expression>>
Description
This variable contains the SQL query string to be executed in a cfquery tag in order to perform insert, update or delete operations. This variable can be modified in events like Before Execute Update,Before Execute Delete etc.
See also
strOrder<control> Variable strWhere<control> Variable 310
Applies to
Page context
Type
string
Access Syntax
<cfset <expression> = strTemplateFileName> <cfset strTemplateFileName=<expression>>
Description
This variable contains the name of the template file. The file is parsed to create the final page that is sent to the browser. This applies to ColdFusion and Templates only.
See also
strFileName variable strWhere Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Grid Form, Directory Form, Path Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset strWhere=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=strWhere>
Description
This variable contains the Where clause of the SQL statement to be executed. This variable can be modified in the Before Build Select event.
See also
strOrder Variable strSQL Variable query<control> Variable strWhere<control> Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
CheckboxList Control, ListBox Control, RadioButton Control Record Form
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset strWhere<control>=<expression>> <cfset <expression>=strWhere<control>>
Description
311
This variable contains the Where clause of the SQL statement to be executed. This variable can be modified in the Before Build Select event.
See also
strOrder<control> Variable strSQL<control> Variable query<control> Variable ViewMode Run-Time Variable (ColdFusion)
Applies to
Report
Type
string
Access
read/write
Syntax
<cfset ViewMode = "Print">
Description
Specify the default view mode, which will be used for report.
Type Description
Print The current report displayed in the Print View Mode. Web The current report displayed in the Web View Mode.
Java
Methods
A-G
addError Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public void addError(java.lang.String error); public void addError(com.codecharge.validation.ControlErrorType,java.lang.String);
Parameters
Name Description
error The Error description
Description
This method adds error description to an error collection. 312
Applies to
Data Source
Syntax
public void addError(java.lang.String error);
Parameters
Name Description
error The error message
Description
This method adds the error message to an error collection.
addValue Method (Java)
Applies to
CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control
Syntax
public void addValue(java.lang.Object); public void addValue(java.lang.String value); public void addValue(long); public void addValue(double); public void addValue(boolean);
Parameters
Name Type Description
value String Value to add to selected values list
Description
This method adds a value to selected values list for Multiselect lists.
addParameter Method (Java)
Applies to
Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public void addParameter(com.codecharge.util.LinkParameter param);
Parameters
Name Description
param link parameter
Description
This method adds LinkParameter to Collection of parameters.
closeConnection Method (Java)
313
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public abstract void closeConnection();
Description
This method returns a connection to the pool. It doesn't really close the connection but returns it to the connection pool to be reused in future.
closeStatement Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public void closeStatement(java.sql.CallableStatement cstmt); public void closeStatement(java.sql.Statement);
Parameters
Name Type
cstmt
Description
Description
This method frees a Statement object if it is not needed.
createCallableStatement Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public CallableStatement createCallableStatement(java.lang.String callString);
Return value
CallableStatement - callable statement object
Parameters
Name Type Description
callString String The Query that calls a stored procedure
Description
This method creates CallableStatement by preparing a procedure call provided by a callString parameter.
createPreparedStatement Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public PreparedStatement createPreparedStatement(java.lang.String sql);
314
Return value
PreparedStatement - prepared statement object
Parameters
Name Type Description
sql String SQL query with parameters
Description
This method creates PreparedStatement from SQL indicated by an SQL parameter. PreparedStatement differs from an ordinary Statement by the fact that question marks can be used in the place of query parameters.
createStatement Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public Statement createStatement();
Return value
Statement - statement object.
Description
This method specifies the Statement object that can be used to query a database with SQL (executeQuery).
currentRow Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public HashMap currentRow();
Return value
HashMap - a HashMap of all row controls.
Description
This method returns the current row.
execute Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public boolean execute(java.sql.CallableStatement cstmt);
Return value
boolean - 'true' if operation was successful, 'false' otherwise
Parameters
Name Type Description
315
cstmt
Description
This method executes the Stored Procedure.
executeUpdate Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public int executeUpdate(java.lang.String sql);
Return value
int - either the row count for INSERT, UPDATE or DELETE statements, or 0 for SQL statements that return nothing, or -1 if parameter is null
Parameters
Name Type Description
sql String The SQL query string
Description
This method executes the INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE SQL-query.
getButton Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public Button getButton(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Button - the Button with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The Button name
Description
This method finds a Button in a children collection by name.
getCategoryNumberInColumn Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getCategoryNumberInColumn();
Return value
long - The Number of Categories in a column. 316
Description
This method retrieves the Number of Categories in a column.
getCheckBoxList Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public CheckBoxList getCheckBoxList(java.lang.String);
Return value
CheckBoxList - the CheckBoxList with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The CheckBoxList name
Description
This method finds a CheckBoxList in a children collection by name.
getChild Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public Model getChild(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Model - the Child of the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The Model name
Description
This method finds a Child in a children collection by name.
getChildren Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public Collection getChildren();
Return value
Collection - a collection with all children
Description
This method returns all children as a collection. 317
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public Control getControl(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Control - the Control of the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The Control name
Description
This method finds a Control in a children collection by name.
getComponent Method (Java)
Applies to
Panel
Syntax
public Model getComponent(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Model - the Child with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The Model name
Description
This method finds a Child in a children collection by name.
getComponent Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public Component getComponent(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Component - the Component of the given name or null if no such Component exists
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String the Component name
Description
This method finds Component in a children collection by name. 318
Applies to
Panel
Syntax
public Collection getComponents();
Return value
Collection - a collection with all children
Description
This method returns all children as a collection.
getComputeAt Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public String getComputeAt();
Return value
String - the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated.
Description
Gets the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated.
getComputeAtFunction Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public FunctionHandler getComputeAtFunction();
Return value
FunctionHandler - teh function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated relative value of the another group.
Description
Returns the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated relative value of the another group.
getConnection Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public abstract void getConnection();
Description
319
This method is used to obtain a connection from pool of connections. A new connection is created only if there is no free connections; otherwise connections are reused. You should call closeConnection method if there is no need to return connection to the pool.
getCurrentCategoryId Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getCurrentCategoryId();
Return value
long
Description
This method retrieves the ID of the currently selected Category.
getCurrentCategoryNumber Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getCurrentCategoryNumber();
Return value
long
Description
This method gets the order number of the current category.
getCurrentItem Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public CalendarItem getCurrentItem();
Return value
CalendarItem - the current calendar item if it is available; otherwise - null;
Description
This method returns the current calendar item if it is available.
getCurrentProcessingDate Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public Date getCurrentProcessingDate();
Return value
320
Description
This method returns the currently processed date to be used in events.
getCurrentRow Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public ReportRow getCurrentRow();
Return value
ReportRow - the current Report detail row.
Description
Returns the current Report detail row.
getCurrentStyle Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public String getCurrentStyle();
Return value
String - the style (not style name) applied to the current Calendar section.
Description
This method returns the style (not style name) applied to the current Calendar section.
getCurrentSubCategoryNumber Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getCurrentSubCategoryNumber();
Return value
long
Description
This method gets the order number of the current subcategory.
getDateField Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public String getDateField();
321
Return value
String - the field name pointing to the Event Date.
Description
This method returns field name pointing to the Event Date.
getDatePicker Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public DatePicker getDatePicker(java.lang.String name);
Return value
DatePicker - the DatePicker with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The DatePicker name
Description
This method finds a DatePicker in a children collection by name.
getDirectory Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public Directory getDirectory(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Directory - the Directory of the given name or null if no such Directory exists
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String The Directory name
Description
This method finds a Directory in a children collection by name.
getEditableGrid Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public EditableGrid getEditableGrid(java.lang.String name);
Return value
EditableGrid - the EditableGrid of the given name or null if no such EditableGrid exists
Parameters
322
Description
This method finds an EditableGrid in a children collection by name.
getEmptyText Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public String getEmptyText();
Return value
String - the text to display when the label's value is empty.
Description
Gets the text to display when the label's value is empty.
getErrorsAsString Method (Java)
Applies to
Data Source
Syntax
public String getErrorsAsString();
Return value
String - a String that represents all errors.
Description
This method retrieves all errors as one string.
getErrorsAsString Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public String getErrorsAsString();
Return value
String - the errors description
Description
This method gets and formats all errors as String presenting each error description on a separate line.
getErrorsAsString Method (Java)
Applies to
323
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public String getErrorsAsString();
Return value
String - a String that represents all the errors.
Description
This method gets all errors represented as one string.
getFile Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public UploadedFile getFile(java.lang.String name);
Return value
UploadedFile - a UploadedFile object representing the single file
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String A String specifying the name of the file.
Description
This method returns the UploadedFile object that represents an uploaded file, or null if the file has not been uploaded.
getFileUpload Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public FileUpload getFileUpload(java.lang.String name);
Return value
FileUpload - the FileUpload with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The FileUpload name
Description
This method finds a FileUpload in a children collection by name.
getFormattedOptions Method (Java)
Applies to
CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control
Syntax
324
Return value
Enumeration - Enumeration of String arrays in form {BOUND_COLUMN, TEXT_COLUMN, SELECTED}
Description
This method prepares a collection list for output. It marks list values selected by request.
getFormattedValue Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public String getFormattedValue();
Return value
String - the formatted value of a control
Description
This method gets the value formatted according to the format of a control.
getFunction Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public FunctionHandler getFunction();
Return value
FunctionHandler - the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated.
Description
Returns the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated.
getGrid Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public Grid getGrid(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Grid - the Grid of the given name or null if such Grid does not exist.
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String The Grid name
Description
325
Applies to
ReportSection Control
Syntax
public double getHeight();
Return value
double - the height of section in lines.
Description
Gets the height of section in lines.
getHttpGetParameter Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public String getHttpGetParameter(java.lang.String name);
Return value
String - a String representing the single value of the parameter
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String A String specifying the name of the parameter
Description
This method returns the value of a request GET parameter as a String, or null if parameter does not exist.
getHttpGetParameters Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public RequestParameters getHttpGetParameters();
Return value
RequestParameters
getHttpPostParameter Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public String getHttpPostParameter(java.lang.String name);
326
Return value
String - a String representing the single value of the parameter
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String A String specifying the name of the parameter
Description
This method returns the value of a request POST parameter as a String, or null if parameter does not exist.
getHttpPostParameters Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public RequestParameters getHttpPostParameters();
Return value
RequestParameters
getJDBCConnection Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnectionFactory
Syntax
public static JDBCConnection getJDBCConnection(java.lang.String connectionName); public static JDBCConnection getJDBCConnection(java.lang.String,boolean);
Return value
JDBCConnection - the JDBCConnection of the given name or null if it is impossible
Parameters
Name Type Description
connectionName String The Connection name
Description
This method creates a new JDBCConnection by connection name.
getLink Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public Link getLink(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Link - the Link with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
327
Name Description
name The Link name
Description
This method finds a Link in a children collection by name.
getListBox Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public ListBox getListBox(java.lang.String name);
Return value
ListBox - the ListBox with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The ListBox name
Description
This method finds a ListBox in a children collection by name.
getMonth Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public int getMonth();
Return value
int - the month number to be shown.
Description
This method returns the month number to be shown.
getMonths Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public int getMonths();
Return value
int - the number of months to be shown
Description
This method returns number of months to be shown.
getMonthsInRow Method (Java)
328
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public int getMonthsInRow();
Return value
int - the number of months in the calendar row for the yearly and quarterly calendars.
Description
This method returns the number of months in the calendar row for the yearly and quarterly calendars. If monthsInRows == 0 all months will be shown in one row.
getNavigator Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public Navigator getNavigator(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Navigator - the Navigator of the given name or null if such Navigator does not exist.
Parameters
Name
name
Description
the Navigator name
Description
This method finds a Navigator in a children collection by name.
getNumberOfCategories Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getNumberOfCategories();
Return value
long
Description
This method retrieves the Number of Categories.
getNumberOfColumns Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getNumberOfColumns();
Return value
329
long
Description
This method retrieves the Number of Columns used to display a directory.
getNumberOfRows Method (Java)
Applies to
Data Source
Syntax
public long getNumberOfRows();
Return value
long - the total number of rows.
Description
This method retrieves the total number of rows.
getNumberOfRows Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getNumberOfRows();
Return value
long
Description
This method retrieves the Total Number of Records at the current directory level.
getNumberOfRows Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public long getNumberOfRows();
Return value
long - the total number of rows.
Description
This method gets the total number of rows.
getNumberOfSubCategories Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public long getNumberOfSubCategories();
330
Return value
long
Description
This method retrieves the Number of Subcategories shown for each category.
getOptions Method (Java)
Applies to
CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control
Syntax
public Enumeration getOptions();
Return value
Enumeration - options list in form of Enumeration of HashMaps: {{BOUND_COLUMN,TEXT_COLUMN},...}
Description
This method gets Options list in form of Enumeration of Strings.
getOneRow Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public DbRow getOneRow(java.lang.String sql); public DbRow getOneRow(java.sql.ResultSet);
Return value
DbRow - DbRow containing result or null if recordset is empty.
Parameters
Name Type Description
sql String The SQL query string
Description
This method gets one row from SQL query result.
getOptionsString Method (Java)
Applies to
ListBox Control
Syntax
public String getOptionsString();
Return value
String - HTML representation of ListBox component.
Description
This method prepares the HTML output for ListBox. The output consists of a list of HTML option elements ready for output. 331
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public Page getPage();
Return value
Page
Description
This method retrieves the page containing the control.
getPage Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public int getPage();
Return value
int - Page number
Description
This method retrieves the current page of a Grid.
getPageNumber Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public int getPageNumber();
Return value
int - current Report page number.
Description
Returns the current Report page number.
getPageSize Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public int getPageSize();
Return value
int - number of records per page.
332
Description
This method retrieves number of records per page. It is an equivalent of getFetchSize.
getPageSizeLimit Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public double getPageSizeLimit();
Return value
double - the value of page size limit if viewMode is Report.VIEW_MODE_WEB.
Description
Returns int value of page size limit if viewMode is Report.VIEW_MODE_WEB; otherwise returns zero. Zero means that all records should be displayed. PageSizeLimit is applied to web mode only.
getPageModel Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public Page getPageModel();
Return value
Page - the page of a component
Description
This method retrieves the page where the component is placed.
getParameter Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public String getParameter(java.lang.String name); public String getParameter(java.lang.String name,java.lang.String name);
Return value
String - a String representing the single value of the parameter
Parameters
Name Description
name A String specifying the name of the parameter
Description
This method returns the value of a request parameter as a String, or null if parameter does not exist.
getParameter Method (Java)
333
Applies to
LinkControl, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public LinkParameter getParameter(java.lang.String name);
Return value
LinkParameter
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String The Parameter name
Description
This method finds a LinkParameter in parameters collection by its name.
getParent Method (Java)
Applies to
Button Control, DatePicker Control, Navigator Control, Sorter Control, Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control, Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Form, Path Form, Panel
Syntax
public Component getParent();
Return value
Component - parent component
Description
This method gets the parent component that contains this control or component.
getPath Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public Path getPath(java.lang.String);
Return value
Path - the Path of the given name or null if no such Path exists
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String The Path name
Description
This method finds a Path in a children collection by name.
getPoolName Method (Java)
334
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public String getPoolName();
Return value
String - connection name
Description
This method gets the Pool name. The name corresponds to CCS Connection name.
getPrintPageSize Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public int getPrintPageSize();
Return value
int - the height of Report page in print view mode.
Description
Returns the height of Report page in print view mode.
getRadioButton Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public RadioButton getRadioButton(java.lang.String name);
Return value
RadioButton - the RadioButton with the given name or null if it does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name The Radio Button name
Description
This method finds a Radio Button in a children collection by name.
getRecord Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public Record getRecord(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Record - the Record of the given name or null if such Record does not exist. 335
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String The Record name.
Description
This method finds a Record in a children collection by name.
getRedirectString Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public String getRedirectString();
Return value
String - a String containing the redirection URL.
Description
This method returns the redirection URL string.
getRequest Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public HttpServletRequest getRequest();
Return value
HttpServletRequest - the HttpServletRequest associated with this page.
Description
This method returns the current request associated with this page.
getResetAt Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public String getResetAt();
Return value
String - the name of the report group where the control value should be reset.
Description
Retrieves the name of the report group where the control value should be reset.
getResponse Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object 336
Syntax
public HttpServletResponse getResponse();
Return value
HttpServletResponse - the HttpServletResponse associated with this page.
Description
This method returns the current response associated with this page.
getRowNumber Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public int getRowNumber();
Return value
int - the current report row number starting from one.
Description
Returns the current report row number starting from one.
getRows Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public Enumeration getRows(java.lang.String sql,int start,int max); public Enumeration getRows(java.sql.ResultSet,int,int); public Enumeration getRows(java.lang.String); public Enumeration getRows(java.sql.ResultSet);
Return value
Enumeration - the data produced by the given query in form of Enumeration object
Parameters
Name Type Description
sql start max String The Static SQL SELECT statement unt int The position of first record to read The maximum number of records to read
Description
This method returns Enumeration of DbRows representing records from the ResultSet
getSection Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
337
Return value
ISection - Report section with specified name.
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String The name of requested Section
Description
Returns the section with given name.
getSorter Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public Sorter getSorter(java.lang.String name);
Return value
Sorter - the Sorter of the given name or null if such Sorter does not exist.
Parameters
Name Description
name the Sorter name
Description
This method finds a Sorter in a children collection by name.
getTemplate Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public Template getTemplate();
Return value
Description
This method returns the Template object for the direct usage of the template library or null for JSP.
getTimeField Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public String getTimeField();
338
Return value
String - the field name pointing to the Event Time.
Description
This method returns the field name pointing to the Event Time. If 'null,' the Calendar will obtain the Event Time from the dateField field.
getTotalPages Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public int getTotalPages();
Return value
int - number of the report pages.
Description
Returns number of the report pages.
getValue Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public Object getValue();
Return value
Object - the unformatted control value.
Description
This method retrieves the value of a control before it is formatted.
getViewMode Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public int getViewMode();
Return value
int - the Report view mode
Description
Returns Report view mode. If print view mode is disabled Report.SHOW_MODE_WEB will always be returned.
getVisualStyle Method (Java)
Applies to
339
Calendar Form
Syntax
public String getVisualStyle(String name);
Return value
String - the field name pointing to Event Style.
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String Style with specified name.
Description
This method returns the Style with the specified name.
getVisualStyles Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public Map getVisualStyles();
Return value
java.util.Map - the map containing styles that represent days of months, weeks, etc.
Description
This method returns the map containing styles that represent days of months, weeks, etc.
getWebPageSize Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public int getWebPageSize();
Return value
int - the height of Report page in web view mode.
Description
Returns the height of Report page in web view mode.
getYear Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public int getYear();
Return value
int - year to be shown.
Description
340
Applies to
CalendarNavigator Control
Syntax
public int getYearsRange();
Return value
int - the number of years to be displayed in the Navigator.
Description
This method returns the number of years to be displayed in the Navigator. H-Z
hasErrors Method (Java)
Applies to
Data Source
Syntax
public boolean hasErrors();
Return value
boolean - 'true' if data source has errors, 'false' otherwise.
Description
This method specifies whether the Data Source has errors.
hasErrors Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public boolean hasErrors();
Return value
boolean - if 'true' there were errors in validation of a control, 'false' otherwise
Description
This method specifies whether the control has validation errors.
hasErrors Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public boolean hasErrors();
341
Return value
boolean - 'true' if the connection has errors, 'false' otherwise
Description
This method specifies whether a connection has errors.
hasNext Method (Java)
Applies to
Data Source
Syntax
public boolean hasNext();
Return value
boolean - 'true' if the Data Source has more data.
Description
This method specifies whether the Data Source has more data.
hasNextItem Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public boolean hasNextItem();
Return value
boolean - 'true' if the next Calendar item is available.
Description
This method indicates if the next Calendar item is available.
hasNextRow Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public boolean hasNextRow();
Return value
boolean - 'true' if the iteration has more elements.
Description
This method returns 'true' if the iteration has more elements.
isDetailControl Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
342
Return value
boolean - true if the specified control belongs to Detail row (Detail section); otherwise - false.
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String Name of control.
Description
Returns true if the specified control belongs to Detail row (Detail section); otherwise - false.
isEnablePrintMode Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public boolean isEnablePrintMode();
Return value
boolean - true if print view mode is enabled for report component; otherwise - false.
Description
Returns true if print view mode is enabled for report component; otherwise - false.
isHideDuplicates Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public boolean isHideDuplicates();
Return value
boolean - sign if the duplicated values will be shown.
Description
Returns if the duplicated values will be shown.
isShowOtherMonthsDays Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public boolean isShowOtherMonthsDays();
Return value
boolean - 'true' if days of the neighbouring months should be shown, otherwise - 'false'.
Description
This method returns 'true' if days of the neighbouring months should be shown, otherwise - 'false'.
343
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Syntax
public boolean isAllowInsert();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method specifies whether Insert is allowed for the component at this moment. This value can be modified using the setAllowInsert method.
See also:
setAllowInsert method
isAllowDelete Method (Java)
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Syntax
public boolean isAllowDelete();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method specifies whether Delete is allowed for the component at this moment. This value can be modified using the setAllowDelete method.
See also:
setAllowDelete method
isAllowRead Method (Java)
Applies to
Editable Grid, Grid, Record
Syntax
public boolean isAllowRead();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method specifies whether Read is allowed for the component at this moment. This value can modified using the setAllowRead method.
See also:
setAllowRead method
isAllowUpdate Method (Java)
344
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Syntax
public boolean isAllowUpdate();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method specifies whether Update is allowed for the component at this moment. This value can modified using the setAllowUpdate method.
See also:
setAllowUpdate method
isEditMode Method (Java)
Applies to
Record Form
Syntax
public boolean isEditMode();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method is used to check whether the Record is in the Edit mode.
isEmpty Method (Java)
Applies to
Data Source
Syntax
public boolean isEmpty();
Return value
boolean - 'true' if the data source is empty, 'false' otherwise.
Description
This method indicates whether the Data Source is empty.
isEmpty Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public boolean isEmpty();
Return value
boolean
Description
345
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public boolean isProcessed();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method indicates that a component is processed. The ccsForm parameter is equal to the Component Name.
isRestricted Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public boolean isRestricted();
Return value
boolean
Description
This method specifies whether users must be logged in before accessing the form.
isShowEmptyRow Method (Java)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public boolean isShowEmptyRow();
Return value
boolean
isVisible Method (Java)
Applies to
Button Control, DatePicker Control, Navigator Control, Sorter Control, Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control, Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Form, Path Form, Panel
Syntax
public boolean isVisible();
Return value
346
Description
This method specifies whether this control will be shown.
nextItem Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public CalendarItem nextItem();
Return value
CalendarItem - the next calendar item if it is available; otherwise - 'null';
Description
This method returns the next calendar item if it is available.
nextReportRow Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public ReportRow nextReportRow();
Return value
ReportRow - the next Report row.
Description
Returns the next Report row.
nextRow Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public HashMap nextRow();
Return value
HashMap - a HashMap of all row controls
Description
This method returns the next row. If a row is not available it returns an empty HashMap. It is never null.
setAllowInsert Method (Java)
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Syntax
public void setAllowInsert(boolean allowInsert);
347
Parameters
Name Description
allowInsert If 'true' the Insert operation is allowed for the component.
Description
This method sets whether the Insert operation is allowed for the component. It may be used to disallow the Insert operation from within the events.
See also:
isAllowInsert method
setAllowDelete Method (Java)
Applies to
Editable Grid, Record
Syntax
public void setAllowDelete(boolean allowDelete);
Parameters
Name Description
allowDelete If 'true' the Delete operation is allowed for this component.
Description
This method sets whether the Delete operation is allowed for the component. It may be used to disallow the Delete operation from within the events.
See also:
isAllowDelete method
setAllowRead Method (Java)
Applies to
Editable Grid, Grid, Record
Syntax
public void setAllowRead(boolean allowRead);
Parameters
Name Description
allowRead If 'true' the Read operation is allowed for the component
Description
This method sets whether the Read operation is allowed for the component. It may be used to disallow the Read operation from within the events.
See also:
isAllowRead method
setAllowUpdate Method (Java)
Applies to
348
Syntax
public void setAllowUpdate(boolean allowUpdate);
Parameters
Name Description
allowUpdate If 'true' the Update operation is allowed for the component.
Description
This method sets whether the Update operation is allowed for the component. It may be used to disallow the Update operation from within the events.
See also:
isAllowUpdate method
setComputeAt Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public void setComputeAt(String string);
Parameters
Name Type Description
string String the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated.
Description
Sets the name of report group, relative to percent value will be calculated.
setComputeAtFunction Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public void setComputeAtFunction(FunctionHandler handler);
Parameters
Name Type Description
handler FunctionHandler the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated relative value of the another group.
Description
Sets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated relative value of the another group.
setCurrentStyle Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form 349
Syntax
public void setCurrentStyle(String style);
Parameters
Name Type Description
style String The Style (not Style Name) that is applied to the current Calendar section.
Description
This method specifies the Style (not Style Name) that is applied to the current Calendar section.
setDateField Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setDateField(String dateField);
Parameters
Name Type Description
dateField String Field name pointing to the Event Date.
Description
This method specifies the Field Name pointing to the Event Date. This field is required if the Data Source is defined and allows to link events to the Calendar days.
setEmptyText Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public void setEmptyText(String string);
Parameters
Name Type Description
string String the text to display when the label's value is empty.
Description
Sets the text to display when the label's value is empty.
setEnablePrintMode Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public void setEnablePrintMode(boolean enablePrintMode);
Parameters
350
Name
Type
Description
Description
Sets enablePrintMode value.
setFormattedValue Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public void setFormattedValue(java.lang.String value);
Parameters
Name Description
value preformatted control value
Description
This method sets the Control Value from String. The value is taken without formatting.
setFunction Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public void setFunction(FunctionHandler handler);
Parameters
Name Type Description
handler FunctionHandler the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated.
Description
Sets the function to be used if the value is to be auto-calculated.
setHeight Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportSection Control
Syntax
public void setHeight(double height);
Parameters
Name Type Description
height double the height of section in lines.
Description
351
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public void setHideDuplicates(boolean b);
Parameters
Name Type
b
Description
Description
Specify if the duplicated values will be shown.
setListOfValues Method (Java)
Applies to
CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control
Syntax
public void setListOfValues(java.lang.String list); public void setListOfValues(java.lang.StringBuffer);
Parameters
Name Type Description
list String Semicolon separated list of values
Description
This method sets list of values to choose from. It is used to populate list values from String.
setLocale Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public void setLocale(java.util.Locale locale);
Parameters
Name Description
locale locale with language and country settings
Description
This method sets the Locale. The locale is used to format data before it is inserted, updated or retrieved from datasources.
setMonths Method (Java)
352
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setMonths(int months);
Parameters
Name Type Description
months int Number of months to be shown.
Description
This method specifies the number of months to be shown.
setMonthsInRow Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setMonthsInRow(int monthsInRow);
Parameters
Name Type Description
Number of months in the calendar row for the yearly and quarterly calendars. monthsInRow int
Description
Specifies the number of months in the calendar row for the yearly and quarterly calendars. If monthsInRows == 0 all months will be shown in one row.
setNumberEmptyRows Method (Java)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public void setNumberEmptyRows(int numberEmptyRows);
Parameters
Name Description
numberEmptyRows The number of rows for new records.
Description
This method specifies the number of rows for adding new records.
setNumberOfColumns Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public void setNumberOfColumns(long numberOfColumns);
353
Parameters
Name Description
numberOfColumns The number of columns
Description
This method sets the Number of Columns used to display a directory.
setNumberOfSubCategories Method (Java)
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
public void setNumberOfSubCategories(long count);
Parameters
Name Description
count The number of subcategories
Description
This method specifies the number of subcategories shown for each category.
setOptions Method (Java)
Applies to
CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control
Syntax
public void setOptions(java.lang.String list); public void setOptions(java.util.Enumeration); public void setOptions(java.util.Enumeration,com.codecharge.db.SqlFormatControl);
Parameters
Name Description
list Semicolon separated list of values
Description
Set list of values to choose from. Used to populate list values from String.
setPage Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public void setPage(java.lang.String page); public void setPage(int);
Parameters
354
Description
This method sets the grid page number to be shown. It specifies the grid page number as a String to in order to set the value from the request parameter.
setPageSize Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
public void setPageSize(int size); public void setPageSize(java.lang.String);
Parameters
Name Type Description
size int number of records per page.
Description
This method sets a number of records per page. It is an equivalent to setFetchSize.
setPageSizeLimit Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public void setPageSizeLimit(int pageSizeLimit);
Parameters
Name Type Description
Maximal allowed size of the Report page in the web view mode. pageSizeLimit int
Description
Sets maximal allowed size of the Report page in the web view mode.
setRedirectString Method (Java)
Applies to
Page Object
Syntax
public void setRedirectString(java.lang.String redirect);
Parameters
Name Type Description
redirect String The URL string for redirect.
Description
355
This method specifies the URL string for redirect. The redirection occurs before the On Initialize View event is called. It is recommended to set variable values in the After Initialize event or any submit processing event of page components.
setResetAt Method (Java)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
public void setResetAt(String string);
Parameters
Name Type Description
string String the name of report group where the control value should be reset.
Description
Sets the name of report group, where the control value should be reset.
setRestricted Method (Java)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Context, Path Control
Syntax
public void setRestricted(boolean flag);
Parameters
Name Description
flag If 'true' the users must be logged in before accessing the form.
Description
This method sets whether users must be logged in before accessing the form.
setShowOtherMonthsDays Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setShowOtherMonthsDays(boolean showOtherMonthsDays);
Parameters
Name Type Description
showOtherMonthsDays boolean Whether days of the neighbouring months should be shown.
Description
This method specifies whether days of the neighbouring months should be shown.
setTimeField Method (Java)
356
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setTimeField(String timeField);
Parameters
Name Type Description
timeField String Field name pointing to the Event Time.
Description
This method specifies the Field Name pointing to the Event Time. If 'null,' the calendar will obtain the Event Time from the dateField field.
setValues Method (Java)
Applies to
CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control
Syntax
public void setValues(java.util.Enumeration records,java.lang.String fieldName);
Parameters
Name
records
Type
Description
Which field holds the values
fieldName String
Description
This method sets list selected values from Enumeration of Strings.
setValue Method (Java)
Applies to
Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control
Syntax
public void setValue(java.lang.Object value); public void setValue(java.lang.String); public void setValue(long); public void setValue(double); public void setValue(boolean);
Parameters
Name Description
value The value to be assigned to the control.
Description
357
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public void setViewMode(int mode);
Parameters
Name Type Description
mode int The requested Report view mode. It can be specified using constants Report.VIEW_MODE_WEB and Report.VIEW_MODE_PRINT.
Description
Set Report view mode.
setVisualStyle Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setVisualStyle(String name, String value);
Parameters
Name Type Description
name String Style Name value String Style
Description
This method specifies the Style with the specified name.
setVisualStyles Method (Java)
Applies to
Calendar Form
Syntax
public void setVisualStyles(Map visualStyles);
Parameters
Name Type Description
visualStyles java.util.Map Map containing Styles that represent days of months, weeks, etc.
Description
This method specifies the map containing Styles that represent days of months, weeks, etc.
setVisible Method (Java)
358
Applies to
Button Control, DatePicker Control, Navigator Control, Sorter Control, Image Control, Label Control, CheckBox Control, FileUpload Control, TextArea Control, TextBox Control, Hidden Control, CheckBoxList Control, RadioButton Control, ListBox Control, Link Control, ImageLink Control, Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Record Form, Directory Form, Page Form, Path Form, Panel
Syntax
public void setVisible(boolean setVisible);
Parameters
Name Type Description
setVisible boolean The visibility boolean state, 'false' means hidden
Description
This method specifies whether this control or component should be shown.
setWebPageSize Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
public void setWebPageSize(int i);
Parameters
Name Type Description
i int height of Report page in web view mode.
Description
Sets the height of Report page in web view mode.
setYearsRange Method (Java)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator Control
Syntax
public void setYearsRange(int yearsRange);
Parameters
Name Type Description
Number of years to be displayed in the Navigator. yearsRange int
Description
This method specifies the number of years to be displayed in the Navigator.
size Method (Java)
Applies to
Report Form 359
Syntax
public double size();
Return value
double - the number of the Report lines or zero if the Report is not populated with data.
Description
Returns the number of the Report lines or zero if the Report is not populated with data.
toSql Method (Java)
Applies to
JDBCConnection Object
Syntax
public String toSql(java.lang.String value,int type); public String toSql(java.lang.String,com.codecharge.components.ControlType); public String toSql(boolean); public String toSql(java.lang.Boolean); public String toSql(java.util.Date);
Return value
String - converted (SQL safe) string
Parameters
Name Type Description
value type String The Element of sql expression int The value type indicating necessary changes
Description
This method converts a String value to an SQL expression by adding quotes and delimiters.
.NET
Common Classes
BooleanParameter Class (.NET) Represents a CodeCharge Data Source Boolean parameter.
Constructors
Constructor
public BooleanParameter(Boolean intValue)
Description
Initializes a new instance of the integer parameter class.
Properties
Property Description
public Boolean Value get or set value of parameter
Methods
Method Description
360
public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public static BooleanParameter GetParam(object param) public static BooleanParameter GetParam(object param, string format)
Convert to string and return Value of the parameter, used mask, specified by format parameter Return the instance of BooleanParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of BooleanParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of BooleanParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. Return the instance of BooleanParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. If param and defaultValue are null (Nothing in VB) values, the null reference will be returned.
public static BooleanParameter GetParam(object param, object defaultValue) public static BooleanParameter GetParam(object param, string format, object defaultValue)
See also
DateParameter Class IntegerParameter Class FloatParameter Class TextParameter Class MemoParameter Class DateParameter Class (.NET) Represents a CodeCharge Data Source Date parameter.
Constructors
Constructor
public DateParameter(DateTime intValue)
Description
Initializes a new instance of the integer parameter class.
Properties
Property Description
public DateTime Value get or set value of parameter
Methods
Method
public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public static DateParameter GetParam(object param) public static DateParameter GetParam(object param, string format)
Description
Convert to string and return Value of the parameter, used mask, specified by format parameter Return the instance of DateParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of DateParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If 361
param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. public static DateParameter GetParam(object param, object defaultValue) public static DateParameter GetParam(object param, string format, object defaultValue) Return the instance of DateParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. Return the instance of DateParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. If param and defaultValue are null (Nothing in VB) values, the null reference will be returned.
See also
BooleanParameter Class IntegerParameter Class FloatParameter Class TextParameter Class MemoParameter Class FieldBase Class (.NET) Serves as the base class that defines the properties, methods, and events common for all types of Field classes (TextField, MemoField, BooleanField, IntegerField, FloatField and DateField).
Constructors
Property
public FieldBase(string format)
Description
Initializes a new instance of the Field class and sets Format property.
public FieldBase(string format, object Initializes a new instance of the Field class and sets Format defaultValue) property and Value property.
Properties
Property
public object Value public string Format
Description
get or set value of field Gets or sets a format mask, which is used in SetValue and Get Formatted Value methods.
Methods
Property
public virtual string GetFormattedValue() public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public virtual void SetValue(object value) public virtual void SetValue(object value,string format)
Description
Convert to string and return Value of object, used mask, specified in Format property Convert to string and return Value of object, used mask, specified by format parameter Sets Value property of a object. If value can not be converted to target type, use Format property mask to parse it. Sets Value property of a object. If value can not be converted to target type, use Format method mask to 362
parse it. FloatParameter Class (.NET) Represents a CodeCharge Data Source Float parameter.
Constructors
Constructor Description
public FloatParameter(Double intValue) Initializes a new instance of the integer parameter class.
Properties
Property Description
public Double Value get or set value of parameter
Methods
Method
public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public static FloatParameter GetParam(object param) public static FloatParameter GetParam(object param, string format)
Description
Convert to string and return Value of the parameter, used mask, specified by format parameter Return the instance of FloatParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of FloatParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of FloatParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. Return the instance of FloatParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. If param and defaultValue are null (Nothing in VB) values, the null reference will be returned.
public static FloatParameter GetParam(object param, object defaultValue) public static FloatParameter GetParam(object param, string format, object defaultValue)
See also
BooleanParameter Class DateParameter Class IntegerParameter Class TextParameter Class MemoParameter Class IntegerParameter Class (.NET) Represents a CodeCharge Data Source integer parameter.
Constructors
Constructor Description
public IntegerParameter(Int64 intValue) Initializes a new instance of the integer parameter class.
Properties
363
Property
Description
Methods
Method
public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public static IntegerParameter GetParam(object param) public static IntegerParameter GetParam(object param, string format)
Description
Convert to string and return Value of the parameter, used mask, specified by format parameter Return the instance of IntegerParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of IntegerParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of IntegerParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. Return the instance of IntegerParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is String value, it will be parsed using mask, specified by format parameter If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. If param and defaultValue are null (Nothing in VB) values, the null reference will be returned.
public static IntegerParameter GetParam(object param, object defaultValue) public static IntegerParameter GetParam(object param, string format, object defaultValue)
See also
BooleanParameter Class DateParameter Class FloatParameter Class TextParameter Class MemoParameter Class public class ItemCollection:NameObjectCollectionBase, ICloneable (.NET) A collection of item objects in a list control.
Properties
Property Description
public ItemValue Gets an Item at the specified index or value in the collection. In C#, this property Item is the indexer for the ItemCollection class
Methods
Property
public void Add(string value,string text,bool selected) public void Add(string value,string text) public void SetSelection(object value)
Description
Appends a item to the end of the collection. Appends a item to the end of the collection. Set selected property to true for a Item from the collection that 364
represents the specified value. public object Clone() Creates a copy of the current collection.
public void Copies the items from the CopyTo(System.Web.UI.WebControls.ListItemCollection col, ItemCollection to the specified bool encode) ListItemCollection, and apply HTML encode to a Item text. public void Copies the items from the CopyTo(System.Web.UI.WebControls.ListItemCollection col) ItemCollection to the specified ListItemCollection. public void Remove(string value) public void Clear() Removes the Item with the specified value from the collection. Removes all Item objects from the collection.
Properties
Property
public object Item
Description
Gets an Item at the specified index or value in the collection. In C#, this property is the indexer for the LinkParameterCollection class
Methods
Property
public void Add(string value,string text) public string ToString(string preserve, string removeList)
Description
Append an item to the end of the collection.
public string ToString() Return the string representation of current collection for using in Uri. Return the string representation of current collection for using in Uri. Preserve parameter from QueryString or Form collection is will added to resulting string. The possible values of preserve parameters: "All","POST" or "GET". The removeList parameter is a semicolon-separated list of parameters, which will be removed from preserved parameters
MemoParameter Class (.NET) Represents a CodeCharge Studio Data Source Memo parameter.
Constructors
Constructor Description
public MemoParameter(String intValue) Initializes a new instance of the integer parameter class.
Properties
Property Description
public String Value get or set value of parameter
Methods
Method Description
365
public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public static MemoParameter GetParam(object param) public static MemoParameter GetParam(object param, string format) public static MemoParameter GetParam(object param, object defaultValue) public static MemoParameter GetParam(object param, string format, object defaultValue)
Convert to string and return Value of the parameter, used mask, specified by format parameter Return the instance of MemoParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of MemoParameter class with value specified by param parameter. The format parameter is ignored. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of MemoParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. Return the instance of MemoParameter class with value specified by param parameter. The format parameter is ignored. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. If param and defaultValue are null (Nothing in VB) values, the null reference will be returned.
See also
BooleanParameter Class DateParameter Class IntegerParameter Class FloatParameter Class TextParameter Class Represents CodeCharge Data Source parameters.
Classes
IntegerParameter FloatParameter TextParameter MemoParameter DateParameter BooleanParameter TextParameter Class (.NET) Represents a CodeCharge Data Source Text parameter.
Constructors
Constructor Description
public TextParameter(String intValue) Initializes a new instance of the integer parameter class.
Properties
Property Description
public String Value get or set value of parameter
Methods
Method Description
366
public virtual string GetFormattedValue(string format) public static TextParameter GetParam(object param) public static TextParameter GetParam(object param, string format) public static TextParameter GetParam(object param, object defaultValue) public static TextParameter GetParam(object param, string format, object defaultValue)
Convert to string and return Value of the parameter, used mask, specified by format parameter Return the instance of TextParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of TextParameter class with value specified by param parameter. The format parameter is ignored. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the null reference will be returned. Return the instance of TextParameter class with value specified by param parameter. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. Return the instance of TextParameter class with value specified by param parameter. The format parameter is ignored. If param is null (Nothing in VB) value, the defaultValue parameter will be used. If param and defaultValue are null (Nothing in VB) values, the null reference will be returned.
See also
BooleanParameter Class DateParameter Class IntegerParameter Class FloatParameter Class MemoParameter Class
Methods
CreateFromHttpRequest Method (.NET)
Applies to
Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public static <control name>Item CreateFromHttpRequest()
VB.NET
Public Shared Function CreateFromHttpRequest() As <control name>Item
Description
Returns the instance of item whose fields are initialized from Http request values. DataBind Method (.NET)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual void DataBind();
367
VB.NET
Overridable Public Sub DataBind()
Description
Binds a data source to the invoked server control and all its child controls. Use this method to bind data from a source to a server control. This method is commonly used after retrieving a data set through a database query. Note: When called on a server control, this method resolves all data-binding expressions in the server control and in any of its child controls. DeleteFile Method (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool DeleteFile()
VB.NET
Public Sub DeleteFile()
Description
Deletes file from disk. DeleteItem Method (.NET)
Applies to
Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public int DeleteItem(<control name>Item item)
VB.NET
Public Function DeleteItem(item As <control name>) As Int32
Description
Deletes data from item specified in item parameter from database. InsertItem Method (.NET)
Applies to
Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public int InsertItem(<control name>Item item)
VB.NET
Public Function InsertItem(item As <control name>) As Int32
Description
368
Inserts the specified item into the database. FillItem Method (.NET)
Applies to
Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public void FillItem(<control name>Item item, ref bool IsInsertMode)
VB.NET
Public Sub FillItem(item As <control name>, ByRef IsInsertMode As Boolean)
Description
Fills the specified item with database data. If database request returns no rows, IsInsertMode parameter will be set to true. GetResultSet Method (.NET)
Applies to
Path Form, Directory Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public <control name>Item[] GetResultSet()
VB.NET
Public GetResultSet() As <control name>Item()
Description
Executes SQL command and returns an array of Items. Use this method to obtain data source for a server control. GetResultSet Method (.NET)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public <control name>Item[] GetResultSet(out int PagesCount)
VB.NET
Public GetResultSet(ByRef PagesCount As Integer) As <control name>Item()
Description
Executes SQL command and returns Items array. The PagesCount parameter contains the number of pages. Use this method to obtain data source for a server control. Update Method (.NET)
Applies to
369
EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public void Update(ArrayList Items)
VB.NET
Public Sub Update(ByVal Items As ArrayList)
Description
Performs update operations for each item in the items array. For each item in ArrayList the state will be checked (IsNew, IsDeleted and so on) and corresponding DB operation will be performed. UpdateItem Method (.NET)
Applies to
Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public int UpdateItem(<control name>Item item)
VB.NET
Public Function UpdateItem(item As <control name>) As Int32
Description
Updates the specified item in the database. SaveFile Method (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool SaveFile()
VB.NET
Public Sub SaveFile()
Description
Saves the processed file into the FileFolder. Validate Method (.NET)
Applies to
Record Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public void Validate(<control name>DataProvider provider)
VB.NET 370
Description
Performs item validation and populates the item errors collection if validation fails. Use this method to validate the item. ValidateFile Method (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool ValidateFile()
VB.NET
Public Sub ValidateFile()
Description
Performs item validation and saves the file into TemporaryFolder. Returns true if the validation is successful, otherwise returns false.
Run-Time Properties
AllowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string AllowedFileMasks{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property AllowedFileMasks() As String
Description
Gets or sets the semicolon-separated list of the allowed file masks. The default value is '*' (all allowed).
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.AllowedFileMasks="*.gif;*.jpg";
VB.NET
FileUpload1.AllowedFileMasks="*.gif;*.jpg"
See also
DisallowedFileMasks Property FileSizeLimit Property BoolFormat Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
371
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
C#.NET
public string BoolFormat{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property BoolFormat() As String
Description
Gets or sets the database format for work with Boolean values.
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.BoolFormat="true;false";
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.BoolFormat="true;false"
See also
DateFormat Property ConnectionCommands Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
C#.NET
public System.Collections.Specialized.NameValueCollection ConnectionCommands{get;}
VB.NET
Public Readonly Property ConnectionCommands() As System.Collections.Specialized.NameValueCollection
Description
Gets the collection of the SQL commands, which will be executed each time the connection is opened. These commands are usually used for setting client session variables or changing database server defaults.
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.ConnectionCommands.Add("ANSI","SET ANSI_DEFAULTS ON");
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.ConnectionCommands.Add("ANSI","SET ANSI_DEFAULTS ON")
Applies to
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
372
C#.NET
public string ConnectionString{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property ConnectionString() As String
Description
A connection string that includes the source database name and other parameters needed to establish the initial connection. The default value is an empty string. The format of the string depends on the Type property.
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.ConnectionString = @"Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;User ID=Admin;Data Source=c:\Program Files\CodeChargeStudio4\Examples\Internet\Internet.mdb ;Persist Security Info=False";
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.ConnectionString = "Provider=Microsoft.Jet.OLEDB.4.0;User ID=Admin;Data Source=c:\Program Files\CodeChargeStudio4\Examples\Internet\Internet.mdb ;Persist Security Info=False"
See also
Type Property ContentType Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ReportLabel control
Syntax
C#.NET
public ContentType ContentType{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property ContentType() As ContentType
Description
Retrieves or sets content type of the report label. This property defines whether the text output by the ReportLabel will be HTML encoded. The default value is Text.
Type Description
Text The text will be encoded during rendering. HTML The text will be rendered as is.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.ContentType = ContentType.HTML;
VB.NET
Report1Label.ContentType = ContentType.HTML
373
See also
Text Property CurrentDate Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public DateTime CurrentDate{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property CurrentDate() As DateTime
Description
Retrieves or specifies the current date for Calendar control. The default value is DateTime.Now.
Examples
C#.NET
Calendar1.CurrentDate = DateTime.Now;
VB.NET
Calendar1.CurrentDate = DateTime.Now
See also
Date Property CurrentDate Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string EmptyText{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property EmptyText() As String
Description
Retrives or specifies the text that will be rendered in case when Text property will contain null or empty string value.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.EmptyText = "N/A";
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.EmptyText = "N/A"
See also
Text Property
374
Applies to
Calendar Form, Grid Form, EditableGrid Form, Report Form, Path Control, Directory Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public System.Collections.IEnumerable DataSource{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property DataSource() As System.Collections.IEnumerable
Description
Gets or sets the data source that provides data for populating the list.
Examples
C#.NET
Directory1.DataSource = Directory1Data.GetResultSet(); Directory1.DataBind();
VB.NET
Directory1.DataSource = Directory1Data.GetResultSet() Directory1.DataBind()
See also
DataBind Property DataType Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ReportLabel control
Syntax
C#.NET
public FieldType DataType{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property DataType() As FieldType
Description
Retrieves or sets the data type of the ReportLabel control.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.DataType = FieldType.Integer;
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.DataType = FieldType._Integer
Applies to
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
375
C#.NET
public string DateFormat{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property DateFormat() As String
Description
Gets or sets the database format of DateTime values.
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.DateFormat="yyyy-MM-dd HH:mm:ss";
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.DateFormat="yyyy-MM-dd HH:mm:ss"
See also
BoolFormat Property Date Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public DateTime Date{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Date() As DateTime
Description
Retrives or specifies the active date for Calendar control.
Examples
C#.NET
Calendar1.Date = new DateTime(2005,1,10);
VB.NET
Calendar1.Date = New DateTime(2005,1,10)
See also
CurrentDate Property, Year Property, Month Property, Day Property Date Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator control
Syntax
C#.NET
public DateTime Date{get}
VB.NET 376
Description
Retrives the selected date for CalendarNavigator control.
Examples
C#.NET
DateTime selected = CalendarNavigator1.Date;
VB.NET
Dim selected as DateTime = CalendarNavigator1.Date
See also
Year Property, Month Property, Day Property DateLeftDelim Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
C#.NET
public string DateLeftDelim{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property DateLeftDelim() As String
Description
Gets or sets the left date delimiter in SQL command (for example '#' for MS Access)
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.DateLeftDelim="#";
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.DateLeftDelim="#"
See also
DateRightDelim Property DateRightDelim Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
C#.NET
public string DateRightDelim{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property DateRightDelim() As String
Description
Gets or sets the right date delimiter in SQL command (for example '#' for MS Access) 377
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.DateRightDelim="#";
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.DateRightDelim="#"
See also
DateLeftDelim Property Day Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int Day{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Day() As Integer
Description
Retrives or specifies the day component of Date property.
Examples
C#.NET
Calendar1.Day = 10;
VB.NET
Calendar1.Day = 10
See also
Date Property, Year Property, Month Property Day Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int Day{get}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property Day() As Integer
Description
Retrives the day component of Date property.
Examples
C#.NET
int selectedDay = CalendarNavigator1.Day;
378
VB.NET
Dim selectedDay As Integer = CalendarNavigator1.Day
See also
Date Property, Year Property, Month Property, Quarter Property DisallowedFileMasks Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string DisallowedFileMasks{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property DisallowedFileMasks() As String
Description
Gets or sets the semicolon-separated list of the disallowed file masks. The default value is an empty string.
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.DisallowedFileMasks="*.gif;*.jpg";
VB.NET
FileUpload1.DisallowedFileMasks="*.gif;*.jpg"
See also
AllowedFileMasks Property FileSizeLimit Property EmptyText Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ReportLabel control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string EmptyText{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property EmptyText() As String
Description
Retrieves or sets the text that will be output when the Text property of the report label contains null or an empty string value.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.EmptyText = "N/A";
VB.NET 379
ReportLabel1.EmptyText = "N/A"
See also
Text Property errors Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar Form, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, Record Form, Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public System.Collections.Specialized.NameValueCollection errors{get;}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property Errors() As System.Collections.Specialized.NameValueCollection
Description
This property keeps the reference to the objects errors collection. It is used to collect error messages generated during the objects execution.
Examples
C#.NET
item.errors.Add("TextBox1","The value in field TextBox1 is required.");
VB.NET
item.errors.Add("TextBox1","The value in field TextBox1 is required.")
Applies to
Sorter Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string Field{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Field() As String
Description
The name of field which will be passed into OnItemCommand event.
Examples
C#.NET
Sorter1.Field = "user_name";
VB.NET
Sorter1.Field = "user_name"
Applies to
380
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string FileFolder{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property FileFolder() As String
Description
Gets or sets the destination folder for uploaded files. The default value is blank (application working folder)
Exceptions
Exception
System.Security.SecurityException
Condition
The working process does not have write permissions onto the specified folder.
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.FileFolder="c:\MyApp\UploadedFiles";
VB.NET
FileUpload1.FileFolder="c:\MyApp\UploadedFiles"
See also
TemporaryFolder Property FileSizeLimit Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public long FileSizeLimit{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property FileSizeLimit() As Int64
Description
Gets or sets the limit of the file size for uploading files. the default is -1 (no limit)
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.FileSizeLimit = 100000;
VB.NET
FileUpload1.FileSizeLimit = 100000
See also
381
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public string Format{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Format() As String
Description
Retrieves or sets the format that will be applied to the output produced by the report label.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.Format = "#.##0";
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.Format = "#.##0"
See also
Text Property Function Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public TotalFunction Function{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Function() As TotalFunction
Description
Retrieves or sets the function to be used if the value of the report label is to be auto-calculated. The default value is "None".
Type Description
None Sum No function will be used. The report label value will be calculated as the sum of previous row values.
Count If the Source is empty the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows. Otherwise the value will be calculated as the count of previous data rows with non-empty values. Min Max The value will be calculated as the minimum of previous row values. The value will be calculated as the maximum of previous row values. 382
Avg
The value will be calculated as the average of non-empty values from previous rows.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.Function = TotalFunction.Sum;
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.Function = TotalFunction.Sum
See also
ResetAt Property,PercentOf Property Groups Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual Groups Groups{get;}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property Groups() As NameValueCollection
Description
Gets the collections of report groups. The collection contains a key-value pairs, where key is a group name and value is a grouping field name.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.Groups.Add("Users","user_id");
VB.NET
Report1.Groups.Add("Users","user_id")
Applies to
Section Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public float Height{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Height() As Single
Description
Retrieves or sets the height of the current control in abstract "line" units.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportSection1.Height = 1.5;
383
VB.NET
ReportSection1.Height = 1.5
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool IsDeleted{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property IsDeleted() As Boolean
Description
This property indicates if the item should be deleted.
Examples
C#.NET
item.IsDeleted = true;
VB.NET
item.IsDeleted = True
See also
IsNew Property IsUpdated Property IsEmptyItem Property IsEmptyItem Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool IsEmptyItem{get;}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property IsEmptyItem() As Boolean
Description
Indicates that the item does not contain any data.
Examples
C#.NET
if(!item.IsEmptyItem) item.Validate();
VB.NET
If Not item.IsEmptyItem Then item.Validate()
See also
384
IsNew Property IsUpdated Property IsDeleted Property IsNew Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form, Record Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool IsNew{get;}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property IsNew() As Boolean
Description
Indicates that the item is new and Update method has not been called.
Examples
C#.NET
if(!item.IsNew) Record1Data.Update(item);
VB.NET
If Not item.IsNew Then Record1Data.Update(item)
See also
IsEmptyItem Property IsUpdated Property IsDeleted Property IsUpdated Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool IsUpdated{get;}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property IsUpdated() As Boolean
Description
This property indicates that the Update method of the Data Provider successfully performed database operation (insert, update or delete) for the item.
Examples
C#.NET
if(!item.IsUpdated) EditableGrid1Data.Update();
VB.NET
If Not item.IsUpdated Then EditableGrid1Data.Update()
385
See also
IsEmptyItem Property IsNew Property IsDeleted Property MaxPage Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Navigator Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int MaxPage{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property MaxPage() As Integer
Description
The maximum number of pages. Use this property to set the number of pages that the navigator can display.
Examples
C#.NET
Navigator.MaxPage = 10;
VB.NET
Navigator.MaxPage = 10
See also
PageMumber Property PagerSize Property Style Property Mode Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public CalendarMode Mode{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Mode() As CalendarMode
Description
Retrives or specifies the calendar type.
Type
Full Quarter
Description
The calendar will display 12 months of the given year. The calendar will display 3 months of the quarter to which the selected date belongs.
ThreeMonth The calendar will display 3 months of a quarter: the selected, next and previous months. 386
OneMonth
Examples
C#.NET
Calendar1.Mode = CalendarMode.Quarter;
VB.NET
Calendar1.Mode = CalendarMode.Quarter
See also
Text Property Month Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int Month{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Month() As Integer
Description
Retrives or specifies the month component of Date property.
Examples
C#.NET
Calendar1.Month = 10;
VB.NET
Calendar1.Month = 10
See also
Date Property, Year Property, Day Property MonthsInRow Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int MonthsInRow{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property MonthsInRow() As Integer
Description
Retrives or specifies the number of calendar columns. An annual calendar can have between 1 and 12 columns, while quarterly and 3-months calendars can have between 1 and 3 columns.
Examples
387
C#.NET
Calendar1.MonthsInRow = 2;
VB.NET
Calendar1.MonthsInRow = 2
Applies to
Section Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string name{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Name() As String
Description
Gets or sets the name of the Section control.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportSection1.Name = "Detail";
VB.NET
ReportSection1.Name = "Detail"
Applies to
Directory Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public int NumberOfColumns{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property NumberOfColumns() As Integer
Description
The number of columns the categories in the directory form are displayed in.
Examples
C#.NET
Directory1.NumberOfColumns = 2;
VB.NET
Directory1.NumberOfColumns = 2
Applies to
388
Directory Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public int NumberOfSubCategories{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property NumberOfSubCategories() As Integer
Description
The maximum number of subcategories to be displayed per category.
Examples
C#.NET
Directory1.NumberOfSubCategories = 3;
VB.NET
Directory1.NumberOfSubCategories = 3
Applies to
CalendarNavigator control
Syntax
C#.NET
public CalendarNavigatorOrder Order{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Order() As CalendarNavigatorOrder
Description
Retrives or specifies the order of showing calendar navigator navigation parts.
Type
Description
YearsQuartersMonths The calendar navigator will show year, then quarter, then month navigation parts. YearsMonthsQuarters The calendar navigator will show year, then month, then quarter navigation parts. MonthsQuartersYears The calendar navigator will show month, then quarter, then year navigation parts. MonthsYearsQuarters The calendar navigator will show month, then year, then quarter navigation parts. QuartersYearsMonths The calendar navigator will show quarter, then year, then month navigation parts. QuartersMonthsYears The calendar navigator will show quarter, then month, then year navigation parts.
Examples
C#.NET 389
CalendarNavigator1.Order = CalendarNavigatorOrder.MonthsQuartersYears;
VB.NET
CalendarNavigator1.Order = CalendarNavigatorOrder.MonthsQuartersYears
Applies to
Navigator Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int PageNumber{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property PageNumber() As Integer
Description
The number of the currently displayed page. Use this property to retrieve the number of the page the navigator is currently displaying.
Examples
C#.NET
Navigator.PageNumber = 6;
VB.NET
Navigator.PageNumber = 6
See also
MaxPage Property PagerSize Property Style Property PagerSize Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Navigator Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int PagerSize{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property PagerSize() As Integer
Description
The number of pages that are displayed simultaneously by the pager.
Examples
C#.NET
Navigator.PagerSize = 10;
VB.NET 390
Navigator.PagerSize = 10
See also
MaxPage Property PageNumber Property Style Property PageSize Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual float PageSize{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable Property PageSize() As Single
Description
Retrieves or sets the number of lines per page to be output in Print view mode.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.PageSize = 100;
VB.NET
Report1.PageSize = 100
See also
PageSizeLimit Property,WebPageSize Property,ViewMode Property PageSizeLimit Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual float PageSizeLimit{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable Property PageSizeLimit() As Single
Description
Retrieves or sets the maximum number of lines per page to be output in Web view mode.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.PageSizeLimit = 100;
VB.NET
Report1.PageSizeLimit = 100
391
See also
PageSize Property,WebPageSize Property,ViewMode Property PageNumber Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public int PageNumber{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property PageNumber() As Integer
Description
Retrieves or sets the number of displayed page.
Examples
C#.NET
Grid1Data.PageNumber = 6;
VB.NET
Grid1Data.PageNumber = 6
See also
RecordPerPage Property PercentOf Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ReportLabel control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string PercentOf{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property PercentOf() As String
Description
Retrieves or sets the name of the report group of which the percent value will be calculated. The possible values are "Report" or the name of any defined report group.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.PercentOf = "Report";
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.PercentOf = "Report"
See also
Function Property
392
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual uint PreviewPageNumber{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable Property PreviewPageNumber() As Integer
Description
Retrieves or sets the page number in the Web view mode.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.PreviewPageNumber = 100;
VB.NET
Report1.PreviewPageNumber = 100
See also
WebPageSize Property,ViewMode Property Quarter Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int Quarter{get}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property Quarter() As Integer
Description
Retrives the quarter of Date property.
Examples
C#.NET
int selectedQuarter = CalendarNavigator1.Quarter;
VB.NET
Dim selectedQuarter As Integer = CalendarNavigator1.Quarter
See also
Date Property, Month Property, Day Property, Year Property RecordPerPage Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form 393
Syntax
C#.NET
public int RecordPerPage{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property RecordPerPage() As Integer
Description
Retrieves or sets the number of records displayed on a page.
Examples
C#.NET
Grid1Data.RecordPerPage = 10;
VB.NET
Grid1Data.RecordPerPage = 10
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool Required{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property Required() As Boolean
Description
If this property is set to true, the user will not be able to delete an already uploaded file.
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.Required = true;
VB.NET
FileUpload1.Required = True
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string ResetAt{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property ResetAt() As String
Description
394
Retrieves or sets the name of the section where the corresponding control's value should be reset. Possible values are "Report", "Page" or name of any defined report group.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.ResetAt = "Page";
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.ResetAt = "Page"
See also
Function Property,PercentOf Property RowNumber Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual uint RowNumber{get;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable ReadOnly Property RowNumber() As Integer
Description
Retrieves the number of the currently processed report row.
Examples
C#.NET
int currentRow = Report1.RowNumber;
VB.NET
Dim CurrentRow As Integer = Report1.RowNumber
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool ShowOtherMonthsDays{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property ShowOtherMonthsDays() As Boolean
Description
Retrives or specifies whether to show days of the surrounding months if the 1st or last week of the month includes days of other months.
Examples
C#.NET 395
Calendar1.ShowOtherMonthsDays = true;
VB.NET
Calendar1.ShowOtherMonthsDays = True
Applies to
Grid Form, EditableGrid Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public <control name>DataProvider.SortFields SortField{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property SortField() As <control name>DataProvider.SortFields
Description
Gets or sets the sort column for the Select command. The default value is <control name>DataProvider.SortFields.Default
Examples
C#.NET
Grid1Data.SortField = Grid1DataProvider.SortFields.UserId;
VB.NET
Grid1Data.SortField = Grid1DataProvider.SortFields.UserId
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string Source{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable Property Source() As Single
Description
Retrieves or sets the data source for the control. The value may be different depending on the SourceType property. If SourceType is set to DBColumn then the value should be the name of a database column. If SourceType is set to SpecialValue then the value should be one of the following: RowNumber, PageNumber, CurrentDate, CurrentDateTime, CurrentTime.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.Source = "user_name";
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.Source = "user_name"
See also
SourceType Property 396
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public ReportLabelSourceType SourceType{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property SourceType() As ReportLabelSourceType
Description
Retrieves or sets the source type of the report label.
Type
DBColumn
Description
The source of report label is a database column.
Examples
C#.NET
ReportLabel1.SourceType = ReportLabelSourceType.DBColumn;
VB.NET
ReportLabel1.SourceType = ReportLabelSourceType.DBColumn
See also
Source Property
Applies to
Sorter Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public SorterState State{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property State() As SorterState
Description
The state of the sorter control.
Type
Ascending None
Description
The sorter in Ascending state. The sorter is inactive.
Examples
C#.NET 397
Sorter1.State = SorterState.Ascending;
VB.NET
Sorter1.State = SorterState.Ascending
Applies to
Navigator Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public PagerStyle Style{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Style() As PagerStyle
Description
The display style of the navigator.
Type
Moving
Description
The current page moving in the pager.
Examples
C#.NET
Navigator.Style = PageStyle.Centered;
VB.NET
Navigator.Style = PageStyle.Centered;
See also
MaxPage Property PageNumber Property PagerSize Property TemporaryFolder Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string TemporaryFolder{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property TemporaryFolder() As String
Description
Retrieves or sets the temporary folder for uploaded files. This folder is used for storing files during form validation. Values starting with the "%" character will be interpreted as system environment variable name.
Exceptions
398
Exception
System.Security.SecurityException
Condition
The working process does not have write permissions for the specified folder.
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.TemporaryFolder="%TEMP";
VB.NET
FileUpload1.TemporaryFolder="%TEMP"
See also
FileFolder Property Text Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
FileUpload Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public string Text{get;set}
VB.NET
Public Property Text() As String
Description
This property contains the name of the uploaded file.
Exceptions
Exception Condition
System.IO.FileNotFoundException The specified file does not exist.
Examples
C#.NET
FileUpload1.Text = @"c:\MyApp\UploadedFiles\image1.jpg";
VB.NET
FileUpload1.Text = @"c:\MyApp\UploadedFiles\image1.jpg"
Applies to
ReportLabel Control
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual string Text{get;set;}
VB.NET 399
Description
Retrieves or sets the text to be output by the report label control.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.Text = "Hello world";
VB.NET
Report1.Text = "Hello world"
See also
ContentType Property TotalPages Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual uint TotalPages{get;}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property TotalPages() As Integer
Description
Retrieves total number of pages of the current report.
Examples
C#.NET
int totalPages = Report1.TotalPages;
VB.NET
Dim TotalPages As Integer = Report1.TotalPages
See also
PageSizeLimit Property, PageSize Property,WebPageSize Property,ViewMode Property Type Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
ConnectionString Object
Syntax
C#.NET
public ConnectionStringType Type{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Type() As ConnectionStringType
Description
400
The type of .NET Managed Provider, which will be used for the connection. The following table lists the different types.
Type
Sql Odbc
Description
SQL Server .NET Data Provider. ODBC .NET Data Provider.
Examples
C#.NET
ConnectionString1.Type = ConnectionStringType.OleDb;
VB.NET
ConnectionString1.Type = ConnectionStringType._OleDb
See also
ConnectionString Property ViewMode Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual ReportViewMode ViewMode{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable Property ViewMode() As ReportViewMode
Description
Retrieves or sets the current view mode of the report.
Type Description
Print The report will be displayed in Print mode. Web The report will be displayed in Web view mode.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.ViewMode = ReportViewMode.Print;
VB.NET
Report1.ViewMode = ReportViewMode.Print
See also
PageSizeLimit Property,PageSize Property,WebPageSize Property Visible Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
401
Button Control, Label Control, TextBox Control, TextArea Control, Checkbox Control, Image Control, ImageLink Control, DatePicker Control, Hidden Control, Grid Form, ListBox Control, CheckboxList Control, RadioButton Control, Record Form, Sorter Control, EditableGrid Form, Path Control, Directory Form, FileUpload Control, Panel, Calendar
Syntax
C#.NET
public bool Visible{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property Visible() As Boolean
Description
If this property is false, the server control is not rendered.
Examples
C#.NET
Grid1Repeater.Visible = false;
VB.NET
Grid1Repeater.Visible = False
Applies to
Report Form
Syntax
C#.NET
public virtual float WebPageSize{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Overridable Property WebPageSize() As Single
Description
Retrieves or sets the number of lines per page to be output in Web view mode.
Examples
C#.NET
Report1.WebPageSize = 100;
VB.NET
Report1.WebPageSize = 100
See also
PageSizeLimit Property,PageSize Property,ViewMode Property Year Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
Calendar control
Syntax
C#.NET 402
VB.NET
Public Property Year() As Integer
Description
Retrives or specifies the year component of Date property.
Examples
C#.NET
Calendar1.Year = 10;
VB.NET
Calendar1.Year = 10
See also
Date Property, Month Property, Day Property Year Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int Year{get}
VB.NET
Public ReadOnly Property Year() As Integer
Description
Retrives the year component of Date property.
Examples
C#.NET
int selectedYear = CalendarNavigator1.Year;
VB.NET
Dim selectedYear As Integer = CalendarNavigator1.Year
See also
Date Property, Month Property, Day Property, Quarter Property YearsRange Run-Time Property (.NET)
Applies to
CalendarNavigator control
Syntax
C#.NET
public int YearsRange{get;set;}
VB.NET
Public Property YearsRange() As Integer
403
Description
Retrives or specifies the number of years to display in the navigator..
Examples
C#.NET
CalendarNavigator1.YearsRange = 10;
VB.NET
CalendarNavigator1.YearsRange = 10
404